INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORP
PRES14A, 1996-06-18
ELECTRONIC PARTS & EQUIPMENT, NEC
Previous: URANIUM RESOURCES INC /DE/, S-8 POS, 1996-06-18
Next: LEAR SEATING CORP, SC 14D1/A, 1996-06-18



<PAGE>
                            SCHEDULE 14A INFORMATION
 
                  Proxy Statement Pursuant to Section 14(a) of
            the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Amendment No.    )
 
    Filed by the Registrant /X/
    Filed by a Party other than the Registrant / /
 
    Check the appropriate box:
    /X/  Preliminary Proxy Statement
    / /  Confidential, for Use of the Commission Only (as permitted by Rule
         14a-6(e)(2))
    / /  Definitive Proxy Statement
    / /  Definitive Additional Materials
    / /  Soliciting  Material  Pursuant  to  Section  240.14a-11(c)  or  Section
         240.14a-12
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                (Name of Registrant as Specified In Its Charter)
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
    (Name of Person(s) Filing Proxy Statement, if other than the Registrant)
 
Payment of Filing Fee (Check the appropriate box):
 
/X/  $125 per  Exchange Act  Rules 0-11(c)(1)(ii),  14a-6(i)(1), 14a-6(i)(2)  or
     Item 22(a)(2) of Schedule 14A.
/ /  $500  per  each party  to  the controversy  pursuant  to Exchange  Act Rule
     14a-6(i)(3).
/ /  Fee  computed  on   table  below   per  Exchange   Act  Rules   14a-6(i)(4)
     and 0-11.
     1) Title of each class of securities to which transaction applies:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     2) Aggregate number of securities to which transaction applies:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     3) Per unit price or other underlying value of transaction computed
        pursuant to Exchange Act Rule 0-11 (Set forth the amount on which the
        filing fee is calculated and state how it was determined):
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     4) Proposed maximum aggregate value of transaction:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     5) Total fee paid:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
/ /  Fee paid previously with preliminary materials.
/ /  Check box if any part of the fee is offset as provided by Exchange Act Rule
     0-11(a)(2)  and identify the  filing for which the  offsetting fee was paid
     previously. Identify the previous filing by registration statement  number,
     or the Form or Schedule and the date of its filing.
     1) Amount Previously Paid:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     2) Form, Schedule or Registration Statement No.:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     3) Filing Party:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
     4) Date Filed:
        ------------------------------------------------------------------------
<PAGE>

                       INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                      7100 EAST BELLEVIEW AVENUE, SUITE 201
                       GREENWOOD VILLAGE, COLORADO  80111
                           TELEPHONE - (303) 770-7600

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                    NOTICE OF SPECIAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS
                           TO BE HELD ON JULY 31, 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

TO THE SHAREHOLDERS OF INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION:

     A Special Meeting of Shareholders of Internet Communications Corporation, a
Colorado corporation (the "Company"), will be held at the Company's offices at
7100 East Belleview Avenue, Suite 201, Greenwood Village, Colorado  80111, on
July 31, 1996 at 1:00 p.m., Mountain Daylight Time, to consider and take action
on:

     1.   A proposal to adopt the 1995 Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan.

     2.   A proposal to adopt the 1996 Incentive Stock Plan.

     3.   A proposal to approve the Share Exchange Agreement between the Company
and Interwest Group, Inc. and certain transactions related thereto pursuant to
which the Company will acquire from Interwest Group, Inc. all the outstanding
shares of capital stock of Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation in exchange
for a number of shares of the Company's Common Stock that will in general be
equal to 49% of the number of shares of the Company's Common Stock that will be
issued and outstanding after giving effect to the closing of the transaction.

     4.   A proposal to amend the Articles of Incorporation to increase the
number of authorized shares of the Company's Common Stock, no par value, from
4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 shares.

     5.   A proposal to amend the Articles of Incorporation to divide the Board
of Directors into three (3) Classes, each of which, after an interim
arrangement, will serve for staggered three (3) year terms.

     6.   A proposal to amend the Articles of Incorporation to provide for
increased voting requirements for certain corporate actions including the sale
of the Company's assets and mergers.

     7.   A proposal to elect five (5) Directors.

     8.   Such other business as may properly come before the meeting, or any
adjournment or adjournments thereof.

<PAGE>

     The discussion of the proposals of the Board of Directors set forth above
is intended only as a summary, and is qualified in its entirety by the
information relating to the proposals set forth in the accompanying Proxy
Statement.

     Only shareholders of record at the close of business on June 24, 1996, will
be entitled to notice of and to vote at this special meeting, or any adjournment
or adjournments thereof.

     Date:  June 28, 1996                    By Order of the Board of
                                   Directors:


                                   Thomas C. Galley, President

     YOU ARE URGED TO DATE, SIGN AND PROMPTLY RETURN YOUR PROXY SO THAT YOUR
SHARES MAY BE VOTED IN ACCORDANCE WITH YOUR WISHES.  THE GIVING OF SUCH PROXY
DOES NOT AFFECT YOUR RIGHT TO VOTE IN PERSON IN THE EVENT YOU ATTEND THE
MEETING.

                             YOUR VOTE IS IMPORTANT


                                       -2-
<PAGE>

                       INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

                                 PROXY STATEMENT
                       FOR SPECIAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS
                           TO BE HELD ON JULY 31, 1996


     THIS PROXY STATEMENT IS FURNISHED IN CONNECTION WITH A SOLICITATION OF
PROXIES (IN THE FORM ENCLOSED) BY THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS OF INTERNET
COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION (THE "COMPANY") TO BE USED AT THE SPECIAL MEETING OF
SHAREHOLDERS (THE "SPECIAL MEETING") AT 1:00 P.M. (MOUNTAIN DAYLIGHT TIME), ON
JULY 31, 1996 AT THE COMPANY'S OFFICES AT 7100 E. BELLEVIEW AVE., SUITE 201,
GREENWOOD VILLAGE, COLORADO 80111. THE PROXY AND PROXY STATEMENT WILL BE MAILED
TO SHAREHOLDERS ON OR ABOUT JUNE 28, 1996.

                              REVOCABILITY OF PROXY

     If the enclosed Proxy is executed and returned, it will be voted on the
proposals as indicated by the shareholder.  The Proxy may be revoked by the
shareholder at any time prior to its use by notice in writing to the Secretary
of the Company, by executing a later dated proxy and delivering it to the
Company prior to the meeting or by voting in person at the meeting.

                                  SOLICITATION

     The cost of preparing, assembling and mailing the Notice of Meeting, Proxy
Statement and Proxy (the "Proxy Materials"), miscellaneous costs with respect to
the Proxy Materials and solicitation of the Proxies will be paid by the Company.
The Company also may use the services of its directors, officers and employees
to solicit Proxies, personally or by telephone and telegraph, but at no
additional salary or compensation.  The Company intends to request banks,
brokerage houses and other custodians, nominees and fiduciaries to forward
copies of the Proxy Materials to those persons for whom they hold such shares
and request authority for the execution of the Proxies.  The Company will
reimburse them for the reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in so
doing.

                  VOTING SECURITIES AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS

     Shareholders of record at the close of business on July 24, 1996 will be
entitled to vote on all matters.  On the record date the Company had 2,400,686
shares of Common Stock, no par value (the "Common Stock"), outstanding.  The
holders of the Common Stock are entitled to one vote per share.  The Company has
no class of voting securities outstanding other than its Common Stock. One half
of the issued and outstanding shares of the Company's Common Stock entitled to
vote, represented in person or by proxy, constitutes a quorum at any
shareholders' meeting.  The failure to return a properly executed proxy card or
to vote in person at the Special Meeting will have the same effect as a vote
against the proposal.  Similarly, "broker non-votes" (referring to instances
where a broker or other nominee physically indicates on the proxy that, because
it has not received instructions from beneficial owners, it does not have
discretionary authority as to certain shares of Common Stock to vote on the
proposal) will have the same effect as a vote against the proposal.  The proxies
named in the enclosed proxy card may, at the direction of the Board, vote to
adjourn or postpone the Special Meeting to another time or place for the purpose
of soliciting additional proxies necessary for approval of a proposal or
otherwise.


                                       -3-
<PAGE>


     The following table sets forth certain information as of June 24, 1996 with
respect to each Officer and Director and each person known by the Company to be
the beneficial owner of more than five percent of the Company's Common Stock.

                                                AMOUNT OF
NAME AND ADDRESS                                BENEFICIAL          PERCENT
OF BENEFICIAL OWNER                             OWNERSHIP           OF CLASS
- -------------------                             -----------         --------

Thomas C. Galley                                677,178 (1)           26.4%
7100 E. Belleview Avenue
Suite 201
Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111

Arnell J. Galley                                677,178 (2)           26.4%
7100 E. Belleview Avenue
Suite 201
Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111

Dale R. Morrison                                118,000                4.6%
7100 E. Belleview Avenue
Suite 201
Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111

Peter A. Guglielmi (3)                            3,333                0.0%
4951 Indiana Avenue
Lisle, Illinois 60532

William J. Maxwell                                    0                0.0%
9605 East Maroon Circle
Suite 100
Englewood, Colorado 80112

Benjamin T. Kelly (4)                             7,500                0.0%
7100 E. Belleview Avenue
Suite 201
Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111

All Directors and                               806,011               31.4%
Officers as a Group (6 Persons)

- -------------------------------

(1)  Includes 476,320 shares of Common Stock owned beneficially and of record,
     132,358 shares owned beneficially by virtue of his wife's ownership of said
     shares, 29,000 shares owned beneficially and of record in joint tenancy
     with his wife, presently exercisable options to purchase 25,000 shares
     owned beneficially and options to purchase 14,500 shares owned beneficially
     by virtue of wife's ownership of said options.  These do not include 75,000
     options owned beneficially and 43,500 options owned beneficially by virtue
     of his wife's ownership, which will vest over the next three years.
(2)  Includes 132,358 shares of Common Stock owned beneficially and of record,
     476,320 shares owned beneficially by virtue of her husband's ownership of
     said shares, 29,000 shares owned beneficially and of record in joint
     tenancy with her husband, presently exercisable options to purchase 14,500
     shares owned beneficially and options to purchase 25,000 shares owned
     beneficially by virtue of her husband's ownership


                                       -4-
<PAGE>


     of said options.  These do not include 43,500 options owned beneficially
     and 75,000 options owned beneficially by virtue of her husband's ownership,
     which will vest over the next three years.
(3)  Mr. Guglielmi has an option to purchase 10,000 shares of which 3,333 will
     be exercisable in July 1996, 1997 and 1998.
(4)  Includes options presently exercisable to purchase 7,500 shares
     beneficially owned.  Excludes 22,500 options beneficially owned which will
     vest over the next three years.

     Except with respect to the share exchange transaction described in Proposal
Three below, there is no arrangement, known to the Company, including any pledge
by any person of securities of the Company, the operation of which may at a
subsequent date result in a change in control of the Company.

DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE COMPANY

     The Directors and Executive Officers of the Company are as follows:

NAME                AGE   POSITIONS AND OFFICES HELD
- ----                ---   --------------------------

Thomas C. Galley     40   President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

Arnell J. Galley     40   Secretary, Director of Corporate Services and Director

Peter A. Guglielmi   53   Director

Dale R. Morrison     40   Director

William J. Maxwell   54   Director

Benjamin T. Kelly    49   Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer

     The following sets forth biographical information as to the business
experience of each Officer and Director of the Company for at least the past
five years.

     THOMAS C. GALLEY - PRESIDENT, CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER AND DIRECTOR.   In
1986, Mr. Galley co-founded Internet Datacomm, Inc., which was subsequently
acquired and merged into the Company, and since February 1990, has served as the
Company's President, Chief Executive Officer and member of  its Board of
Directors.

     ARNELL J. GALLEY - SECRETARY, DIRECTOR OF CORPORATE SERVICES AND DIRECTOR.
Ms. Galley co-founded Internet Datacomm, Inc. in 1986 which was subsequently
acquired and merged into the Company.  Since February 1990, Ms. Galley has
served as the Company's Secretary and a member of its Board of Directors, and
previously held the positions of Secretary, Treasurer and Vice President of IDI.
She currently holds the position of Director of Corporate Services.

     PETER A. GUGLIELMI - DIRECTOR.  Mr. Guglielmi was appointed to the
Company's Board of Directors on July 24, 1995.  Currently and for the past five
years, Mr. Guglielmi has served as President of Tellabs International, Inc., a
major supplier of hardware products to the telecommunications industry.
Previously, he was Executive Vice President of Finance and Operations for
Tellabs International.

     DALE R. MORRISON - DIRECTOR.  Mr. Morrison became associated with Internet
Datacomm, Inc. in July 1986 in the position of Vice President.  Since February
1990, Mr. Morrison has served as the Company's Vice President and Director.  He
resigned as Vice President and left the employment of the


                                       -5-
<PAGE>


Company on June 30, 1994.  Mr. Morrison remains as a member of the Board of
Directors. Mr. Morrison holds a Bachelor of Science Degree in Business
Management from the University of Northern Colorado.

     WILLIAM J. MAXWELL - DIRECTOR.  Mr. Maxwell was elected to the Company's
Board of Directors on June 12, 1996.  Mr. Maxwell is an executive vice president
of IntelCom Group and president and chief executive officer of ICG Telecom
Group, Inc., which is one of the country's leading competitive local exchange
carriers.  Prior to joining ICG in December 1992, Mr. Maxwell was senior
marketing executive of WilTel Inc. in Tulsa, Oklahoma (now a subsidiary of
WorldCom, Inc.), a full-service telecommunications company providing voice,
video and data products and services nationwide.

     BENJAMIN T. KELLY - TREASURER AND CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER.  Mr. Kelly
became associated with the Company in August, 1995 in the position of Chief
Financial Officer and on September 16, 1995, was appointed the Company's
Treasurer.  Prior to joining the Company, Mr. Kelly was President of BenchMark
Consulting Group and served as Executive Vice President or Chief Financial
Officer in two high technology firms. He holds a Bachelor of Science in Business
Administration from Creighton University and a MBA from the University of
Denver. He is also licensed as a Certified Public Accountant in the State of
Colorado.

     If Proposal Three described below in this Proxy Statement is approved by
the Company's Shareholders at the Special Meeting, the Company expects to close
the share exchange transaction described in Proposal Three (the "Transaction")
promptly thereafter, as the result of which Interwest Communications C.S.
Corporation ("Interwest") would become a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company.
The Board of Directors would then increase the number of directors from five (5)
directors to eight (8) directors and fill the vacancies created thereby by
electing three (3) persons designated by Interwest Group, Inc. ("Group"), which
is the sole shareholder of Interwest as of the date of this Proxy Statement.
Group has advised the Company that Group currently expects to designate for
election John M. Couzens, Robert L. Smith and Craig D. Slater.  Mr. Couzens has
been President and Chief Executive Officer of Interwest since April, 1996.  Mr.
Couzens has also been serving as Vice President, Chief Financial Officer and
Treasurer of Group since 1994.  Prior to joining Group, Mr. Couzens was Vice
President and Division Manager at The Northern Trust Company.  Mr. Couzens is a
director of Interwest.  Mr. Smith joined Interwest in 1980 as General Manger.
Mr. Smith was appointed President of Interwest in 1987.  In April 1996, Mr.
Smith became the Executive Vice President of Network Systems for Interwest.  Mr.
Smith is a director of Interwest.  Mr. Slater was elected to the Board of
Directors of Group in July 1994 in conjunction with the acquisition of Group by
Anschutz Company.  Mr. Slater serves as Vice President of Investments at
Anschutz Company, a holding company with investments in a variety of industries,
including telecommunications, transportation, energy and real estate.  Mr.
Slater has been an employee of Anschutz Company and/or the Anschutz Corporation
since 1988.  Mr. Slater also serves as a member of the Board of Directors of
Forest Oil Corporation, to which he was elected in 1995.

     COMPENSATION.  The members of the Board of Directors do not receive
compensation for serving as members of the Board except that of Messrs.
Guglielmi and Maxwell each receive $6,000 per year and $1,500 per meeting.

DIRECTORS' MEETINGS AND STANDING COMMITTEES

     During 1996, four (4) meetings of the Board of Directors were held.  With
the exception of Mr. Morrison, all Directors attended 100% of the aggregate
number of meetings of the Board.  The Company currently has no audit or
compensation committees.


                                       -6-
<PAGE>


EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENTS

     On May 1, 1994, the Company entered into an employment agreement with its
president, Thomas C. Galley, which extends until January 31, 1999.  Under the
agreement, Mr. Galley is to receive a base salary of $180,000 which increases by
15% per year on February 1st of each subsequent year.  Mr. Galley is also to
receive a bonus of between 4% to 6% of earnings before taxes and bonus based on
the following:

     Before Tax Net Profit                           Bonus Percentage of
     as Percentage of Sales                          Before Tax Net Profits
     ----------------------                          ----------------------

     3% or less of gross sales                       4% of before tax net profit

     More than 3% but less than 5% of gross sales    5% of before tax net profit

     More than 5% of gross sales                     6% of before tax net profit

     The agreement is cancelable for cause, and may be terminated by the Company
for reasons other than cause. Should either of these events occur, Mr. Galley
shall receive as his severance compensation an amount equal to his annual base
salary payable over thirty-six months.

     Each of the other executive officers has signed a non-compete agreement
with the Company.  There are non-compete and confidentiality agreements with
sales account executives and engineers.  Such agreements generally provide that
in the event of the employee's termination the employee will not (i) compete
with the Company for a period of two years after the termination of employment
within a radius of 100 miles of any office of the Company or any subsidiary of
the Company; (ii) solicit, directly or indirectly, any customer of the Company
or any subsidiary of the Company for a period of three years; (iii) release
Company trade secrets and proprietary information; and (iv) if terminated by the
Company, without cause, the employee is entitled to 10 days' severance
compensation.  Executive compensation for officers other than the President, is
determined on an annual basis by the Board of Directors and is based upon
operating results and department budgets for the upcoming fiscal year.

     Except for the fact that Thomas C. Galley and Arnell J. Galley, who are
husband and wife, there is no family relationship between any Director or
Executive Officer of the Company.

     Officers of the Company are currently elected annually by, and serve at the
discretion of, the Board of Directors.

COMPLIANCE WITH SECTION 16(A) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

     Section 16(a) of the Securities Act of 1934 requires the Company's
directors and executive officers, and persons who own more than ten percent of a
registered class of the Company's equity securities, if any, to file with the
Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") initial reports of ownership and
reports of changes in ownership of equity securities of the Company.  Such
persons are required by SEC regulations to furnish the Company with copies of
all Section 16(a) forms they file.

     To the Company's knowledge, all of the Company's Officers and Directors
have complied with all applicable Section 16(a) filing requirements.  This
statement is based solely on a review of the copies of such reports furnished to
the Company by its Officers and Directors and their written representations that
such reports accurately reflect all reportable transactions and holdings.


                                       -7-
<PAGE>


                     PRICE RANGE OF THE COMPANY COMMON STOCK

     The Company's Common Stock is traded on the NASDAQ Small-Cap Market under
the symbol "INCC".  In the previous years and prior to June 13, 1994, Warrants
to purchase Common Stock were traded under the symbol, "INCCW".  All Warrants
not exercised by June 13, 1994 expired under their own terms on that date.

     The following table represents the range of high and low bid prices in
dollars for the Common Stock and Warrants for the eight fiscal quarters ended
January 31, 1996:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                         Quarter Ended
            --------------------------------------------------------------------
               Apr. 30, 94       Jul. 31, 94       Oct. 31, 94      Jan. 31, 95
               -----------       -----------       -----------      -----------
<S>           <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>     <C>      <C>
Security      High      Low     High      Low     High      Low    High      Low
Common        9.88     5.63     6.00     3.13      6.3     3.88    8.25     3.63
Warrants      4.13      .44      .63      .03      N/A      N/A     N/A      N/A

<CAPTION>

                                         Quarter Ended
            --------------------------------------------------------------------
               Apr. 30, 95       Jul. 31, 95       Oct. 31, 95      Jan. 31, 96
               -----------       -----------       -----------      -----------
<S>           <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>     <C>      <C>
Security      High      Low     High      Low     High      Low    High      Low
Common        6.75     4.25     6.50     3.90     7.75     4.12    6.50     3.50
Warrants       N/A      N/A      N/A      N/A      N/A      N/A     N/A      N/A
</TABLE>


                             EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

The following table sets forth the total remuneration paid during the Company's
last fiscal year ended January 31, 1996 and the prior two years to the Chief
Executive Officer, the only executive officer whose total cash and non-cash
compensation exceeded $100,000.

        SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                            Annual Compensation                              Long Term Compensation Awards
                   ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                               Other                                                         All
       Name                                                    Annual          Restricted                      LTIP        Other
       and                                                     Compen-           Stock       Options/          Pay-        Compen-
     Principal                  Salary          Bonus          sation           Award(s)       SARs            outs        sation
     Position        Year (1)     ($)            ($)             ($)              ($)         (#)(2)           ($)        ($)(3)
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                  <C>        <C>             <C>            <C>              <C>           <C>              <C>
Thomas C. Galley,      1996     $156,000        $     0        $     0            N/A           None            N/A        $9,000
President              1995     $175,816        $     0        $     0              -           None              -        $9,000
                       1994     $145,000        $25,460        $     0              -         50,000              -        $9,000

- --------------------
</TABLE>
     (1)  Periods presented are for the years ended January 31.
     (2)  Number of shares of Common Stock subject to options granted during the
          year indicated.
     (3)  Represents personal use of company car and other benefits valued at
          $750 per month  (1996, 1995, and 1994)  per month.


                                       -8-
<PAGE>


STOCK OPTION GRANTS IN FISCAL YEAR ENDED JANUARY 31, 1996.

     In April 1996, the Board of Directors authorized the exchange of the
Company's then outstanding non-qualified options for new options, which are
expected to be approved as incentive stock options.  The old options were to
expire at the end of April 1996.  The new options will expire in April 2006.  In
connection with this exchange, Mr. Galley exchanged 50,000 options, which were
fully vested and exercisable at $2.00 per share for 100,000 options exercisable
at $4.125 (110% of the market price of unrestricted Common Stock on the date of
grant), of which 25% were immediately vested and 25% will become vested in each
of the next three years.  The Board of Directors granted the new options as the
prior granted options were to expire and to provide all employees the benefits
of an incentive stock option plan.  However, if the incentive stock option plan
is not approved, the new options will remain outstanding as non-qualified stock
options.

AGGREGATE OPTIONS EXERCISED DURING 1995 AND OPTION VALUES AT JANUARY 31, 1996

     The following table sets forth certain information regarding options to
purchase shares of Common Stock exercised during the Company's fiscal year ended
January 31, 1996 and the number and value of exercisable and unexercisable
options to purchase shares of Common Stock held as of the end of the Company's
fiscal year by the Executive Officer of the Company named in the Summary
Compensation Table:

 AGGREGATE OPTIONS EXERCISED DURING 1995 AND OPTION VALUES AT JANUARY 31, 1996
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                  Value of
                                               Number of         Unexercised
                                              Unexercised       In-the-Money
                                               Options at        Options at
                     Shares                     1/31/96           1/31/96
                    Acquired       Value      Exercisable/      Exercisable/
       Name        on Exercise    Realized   Unexercisable   Unexercisable(1)(2)
       ----        -----------    --------   -------------   -------------------
  <S>              <C>            <C>        <C>             <C>
  Thomas C. Galley     None          --      50,000/50,000     $75,000/$75,000
- ------------------
</TABLE>

(1)  Value of exercisable/unexercisable in-the-money options is equal to the
     difference between the fair market value per share of Common Stock of $3.50
     at January 31, 1996, and the option exercise price per share multiplied by
     the number of shares subject to options.
(2)  On April 17, 1996, the Company initiated a program under which all
     employees holding unexercised non-qualified stock options would allow the
     unexercised non-qualified stock options to expire and would be issued new
     incentive stock options at fair market value in accordance with the
     incentive stock plan to be submitted for shareholder approval at the Annual
     Meeting.  Under this program, Mr. Galley surrendered 50,000 non-qualified
     stock options, which were exercisable at $2.00 per share and was issued
     100,000 shares of incentive stock options at 110% of the fair market value,
     or $4.125 per share.

                               PROPOSAL NUMBER ONE

ADOPTION OF 1995 NON-EMPLOYEE  DIRECTOR STOCK OPTION PLAN

     The Board of Directors intends to present at the Special Meeting a proposal
to approve the adoption of the Company's 1995 Non-Employee Director Stock Option
Plan (the "1995 Plan") and to reserve an aggregate of 40,000 shares of Common
Stock for future issuance thereunder to non-employee Directors of the Company.
Three (3) persons are currently eligible to participate in the 1995 Plan.


                                       -9-
<PAGE>


     The Board of Directors adopted the 1995 Plan on July 24, 1995, subject to
its approval by the shareholders of the Company at the Annual or a Special
Meeting.  A copy of the 1995 Plan is attached as Appendix A to this Proxy
Statement.

     The 1995 Plan is intended to provide incentives to non-employee Directors
who contribute to the success of the Company by offering them the opportunity to
acquire an ownership interest in the Company.  The Board of Directors believes
that this will help to align the interests of the Company's Directors with the
interests of the Company's Shareholders.  Only non-employee Directors of the
Company are eligible to receive options under the 1995 Plan.  An option under
which a total of 10,000 shares of Common Stock may be purchased shall be
automatically granted to each non-employee Director upon his or her election to
the Board, subject to the following vesting schedule:

          Board Membership
          Years After Grant Date             Exercisable Percentage of Shares
          ----------------------             --------------------------------

          One Year                                     33 1/3%
          Two Years                                    66 2/3%
          Three Years                                  100%

     Options granted under the 1995 Plan are not transferable (except by the
laws of descent and distribution) and, with certain exceptions, may be exercised
by the optionee only during the period of his or her tenure as a Director or
within three months after termination of service on the Board of Directors.  Any
shares subject to options that expire or otherwise terminate without having been
exercised in full are available for future grant under the 1995 Plan.

     ADMINISTRATION OF THE PLAN.  The 1995 Plan is administered by the Board of
Directors.   The Board also has the power to interpret the 1995 Plan and the
provisions in the instruments evidencing grants made under the 1995 Plan, and is
empowered to make all other determinations deemed necessary or advisable for the
administration of the 1995 Plan.  Unless sooner terminated by the Company, the
1995 Plan will terminate on July 24, 2005.  No options can be granted after that
date, although options granted before the 1995 Plan terminates will expire in
accordance with their terms, even if after the 1995 Plan termination date.

     ADJUSTMENT.  In the event a change, such as a stock split, is made in the
Company's capitalization which results in an exchange or other adjustment of
each share of Common Stock for or into a greater or lesser number of shares,
appropriate adjustments will be made to unexercised options and in the exercise
price and in the number of shares subject to each outstanding option.  The Board
of Directors also may make provisions for adjusting the number of underlying
outstanding options in the event the Company effects one or more
reorganizations, recapitalizations, right offerings, or other increases or
reductions of shares of the Company's outstanding Common Stock.  Options may
provide that in the event of the dissolution or liquidation of the Company, a
corporate separation or division or the merger or consolidation of the Company,
the holder may exercise the option on such terms as it may have been exercised
immediately prior to such dissolution, corporate separation or division or
merger or consolidation.  The 1995 Plan also provides that in the event of a
tender offer or exchange offer for the Company, certain mergers or
consolidations, or certain changes in control of the Company or of its Board of
Directors, outstanding options previously subject to vesting provisions will
vest immediately.

     TAX MATTERS.  The Company believes that, under the applicable provisions of
the Internal Revenue Code, as amended and the regulations of the United States
Treasury Department currently in effect, all grants to non-employee Directors
will be considered non-qualified stock options and therefore,


                                      -10-
<PAGE>


the recipients are subject to United States Federal income tax upon the exercise
of an option.  The Company may deduct for tax reporting purposes the difference
between the fair market value and the exercise price of the option on the date
of exercise.

     CURRENT MARKET VALUE OF SECURITIES UNDERLYING OPTIONS UNDER GRANT. The
current market value of securities underlying the options outstanding as of June
12, 1996 under the Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan was $7,450, based
upon the difference between the quoted market price of the Company's Common
Stock on that date and the exercise price of all options currently granted,
including those options currently not vested.

     BOARD RECOMMENDATION TO SHAREHOLDERS AND VOTE REQUIRED.  The Board of
Directors recommends that the 1995 Plan be approved and adopted. The affirmative
vote of a majority vote of the shares of Common Stock represented and entitled
to be voted at the Special Meeting is needed to approve the 1995 Plan.  The
Officers and Directors of the Company have advised the Company that they plan to
vote their shares of Common Stock in favor of Proposal One.

                               PROPOSAL NUMBER TWO

                      ADOPTION OF 1996 INCENTIVE STOCK PLAN

     The Board of Directors intends to present at the Special Meeting a proposal
to approve the adoption of the Company's 1996 Incentive Stock Plan (the "1996
Plan") and to reserve up to 625,000 shares of Common Stock for issuance
thereunder to employees and consultants with continuous status as an employee or
consultant of the Company.  The 1996 Plan allows for the issuance of incentive
stock options, non-qualified stock options, and stock purchase rights.
Approximately eighty (80) individuals are eligible to participate in the 1996
plan.

     The Board of Directors adopted the 1996 Plan on March 18, 1996, subject to
its approval by the shareholders of the Company at the Annual or a Special
Meeting.  A copy of the 1996 Plan is attached as Appendix B to this Proxy
Statement.

     The 1996 Plan is intended to provide incentives to Officers, employed
Directors,  key employees and other persons who contribute to the success of the
Company by offering them the opportunity to acquire an ownership interest in the
Company.  The Board of Directors believes that this will help to align the
interests of the Company's employees and management with the interests of the
Company's shareholders.  Only employees and consultants of the Company are
eligible to receive options or stock purchase rights under the 1996 Plan.
Options and stock purchase rights are subject to the following vesting:

          Employment After Grant Date        Exercisable Percentage of Shares
          ---------------------------        --------------------------------

          At Grant Date                           25%
          One Year                                25%
          Two Years                               25%
          Three Years                             25%

     Some options granted under the 1996 Plan may be intended to qualify as
"incentive stock options" within the meaning of the Code.  The exercise price of
such options may not be less than 100% of the fair market value of the Common
Stock on the date of the grant and the term of any such option may not exceed 10
years.  Fair market value is the closing bid price for the Company's shares of
Common Stock


                                      -11-
<PAGE>


as reported by the National Market System of the National Association of
Securities Dealers, Inc. or such national stock exchange on which the stock may
then be traded. Options and stock purchase rights granted under the 1996 Plan
are not transferable (except by the laws of descent and distribution) and, with
certain exceptions, may be exercised by the optionee only during the period of
his or her employment or within three months after termination of employment.
Any shares subject to options that expire or otherwise terminate without having
been exercised in full are available for future grant under the 1996 Plan.

     ADMINISTRATION OF THE PLAN.  The 1996 Plan is administered by the Board of
Directors.   The Board also has the power to interpret the 1996 Plan and the
provisions in the instruments evidencing grants made under the 1996 Plan, and is
empowered to make all other determinations deemed necessary or advisable for the
administration of the 1996 Plan.  The Board is authorized to increase the number
of shares reserved for the plan by a number not to exceed 25% or 125,000 shares,
which is included in the 625,000 shares reserved above. Unless sooner terminated
by the Company, the 1996 Plan will terminate on July 1, 2005.

     ADJUSTMENT.  In the event a change, such as a stock split, is made in the
Company's capitalization which results in an exchange or other adjustment of
each share of Common Stock for or into a greater or lesser number of shares,
appropriate adjustments will be made to unexercised options and stock purchase
rights and in the exercise price and in the number of shares subject to each
outstanding option.  The Board of Directors also may make provisions for
adjusting the number of underlying outstanding options in the event the Company
effects one or more reorganizations, recapitalizations, right offerings, or
other increases or reductions of shares of the Company's outstanding Common
Stock.  Options and stock purchase rights may provide that in the event of the
dissolution or liquidation of the Company, a corporate separation or division or
the merger or consolidation of the Company, the holder may exercise the option
or stock purchase rights on such terms as it may have been exercised immediately
prior to such dissolution, corporate separation or division or merger or
consolidation.  The 1996 Plan also provides that in the event of a tender offer
or exchange offer for the Company, certain mergers or consolidations, or certain
changes in control of the Company or of its Board of Directors, outstanding
options previously subject to vesting provisions will vest immediately.

     TAX MATTERS.  The Company believes that, under the applicable provisions of
Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code, as amended and the regulations of the
United States Treasury Department currently in effect, a grantee will not incur
any United States Federal income tax upon the grant or exercise of an employee
option which is an incentive stock option.  Generally, there are no tax
consequences to the Company for grants or exercise of incentive stock options.

     OPTIONS CURRENTLY OUTSTANDING.  In April 1996, the Board of Directors
authorized the issuance of 488,100 options to be granted as incentive stock
options under The 1996 Plan.  These options were granted at the market price on
the date of grant of $3.75, except for 158,000 options to certain 10%
shareholders, which were granted at $4.125 (110% of the market price).  If the
1996 Plan is not approved, these options will remain outstanding as non-
qualified stock options.

     CURRENT MARKET VALUE OF SECURITIES UNDERLYING OPTIONS UNDER GRANT. The
current market value of securities underlying the options outstanding as of June
12, 1996 under the 1996 Plan was $1,276,497, based upon the difference between
the quoted market price of the Company's Common Stock on that date and the
exercise price of all options granted, including those options currently not
vested.

     BOARD RECOMMENDATION TO SHAREHOLDERS AND VOTE REQUIRED.  The Board of
Directors recommends that the 1996 Plan be approved and adopted. The affirmative
vote of a majority of the shares of Common Stock represented and entitled to be
voted at the Special Meeting is needed to approve the


                                      -12-
<PAGE>

1996 Plan.  The Officers and Directors of the Company have advised the Company
that they plan to vote their shares of Common Stock in favor of Proposal Two.

                              PROPOSAL NUMBER THREE

             A PROPOSAL TO APPROVE THE SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT AND
                              RELATED TRANSACTIONS

     THE SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT.

     Pursuant to a Share Exchange Agreement dated May 29, 1996 as amended (the
"Share Exchange Agreement"), between the Company and Interwest Group, Inc.
("Group"), the Company proposes to acquire all of the issued and outstanding
shares of the capital stock of Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation, a
Colorado corporation and a wholly-owned subsidiary of Group ("Interwest"), in
exchange for a number of shares of the Company's Common Stock that will in
general be equal to 49% of the number of shares of Common Stock that will be
issued and outstanding after giving effect to the closing of the proposed
transaction (the "Transaction").  The Board of Directors intends to present at
the Special meeting a proposal to approve the Share Exchange Agreement and the
transactions (including the Transaction) and other documents contemplated
thereby.  Promptly after the approval by the Shareholders of this Proposal Three
and Proposals Four, Five and Six and the satisfaction of the other conditions
specified in the Share Exchange Agreement, the Company intends to effect the
closing of the Transaction. A copy of the Share Exchange Agreement is attached
as Appendix C to this Proxy Statement.

     Certain information regarding Interwest is set forth below under "Interwest
- - Description of Business", and "Pro Forma and Interwest - Selected Financial
Information" and "Interwest - Management's Discussion and Analysis of Liquidity
and Results of Operations".

     THE TRANSACTION.

     On May 29, 1996, the Company and Group entered into the Share Exchange
Agreement which provides for the matters summarized below.  Such summary is
qualified by reference to the Share Exchange Agreement.

     Pursuant to the Share Exchange Agreement, on May 29, 1996 the Company
issued to Group at par and for cash, a promissory note of the Company (the
"Note") in the principal amount of $900,000 and having a maturity on December
31, 1996, or, if earlier, the date that is 30 days after the earlier to occur of
(i) the failure of the shareholders of the Company to approve the Share Exchange
Agreement at the Special Meeting or (ii) the termination of the Share Exchange
Agreement by Group pursuant to the terms thereof, including, without limitation,
upon the breach by the Company of any representation or warranty in the Share
Exchange Agreement, any modification, amendment or withdrawal of the
recommendation by the Board of Directors of the Company that the Shareholders
approve Proposals Three and Four in any respect materially adverse to Group, or
the acquisition by any person other than Group of 30% or more of the outstanding
shares of Common Stock or any other event referred to in the Share Exchange
Agreement as a Subsequent Event with respect to the Company.  The Note bears
interest at a rate of 8.0% per annum from May 29, 1996 to and including July 28,
1996 or, if the Second Closing (as defined below) shall then have occurred,
August 27, 1996, and the rate of 12.5% per annum thereafter, payable monthly in
arrears or, upon the occurrence and during the continuation of a default under
the Note, at a rate of interest 3.5% per annum greater than the rate otherwise
applicable.  If the Company fails to pay in full the principal amount of the
Note and all interest accrued there on at the maturity thereof (whether at
scheduled maturity, on the date of any required prepayment or, after the


                                      -13-

<PAGE>

expiration of applicable grace periods and cure periods, upon acceleration),
then, at any time during the period commencing the day after the date of such
maturity of the Note (if the principal amount thereof and all interest accrued
thereon shall then not have been paid in full) and ending on a date that is 45
days after the date of such maturity, Group may elect to convert the Note into
300,000 shares of the Company's Common Stock at a price of $3.00 per share (as
such number of shares and price per share may be adjusted pursuant to the terms
of the Note).

     The Share Exchange Agreement provides that, on August 1, 1996 or, at the
election of Group, on the second business day after the satisfaction or waiver
of the conditions precedent to the respective obligations of the Company and
Group or on such other date of closing  as the Company and Group may agree in
writing, but in no event later than September 30, 1996 (the "Second Closing"),
Group shall assign to the Company all the outstanding shares of capital stock of
Interwest in exchange for shares of the Company's Common Stock such that the
Company's Common Stock issued to Group would equal 49.0% of the shares of
Company's Common Stock issued and outstanding immediately following the closing
of the Transaction, without taking into account any shares issued pursuant to
the 1995 Plan, the 1996 Plan, or pursuant to the conversion of the Note.

     The Share Exchange Agreement contains representations and warranties by
each party regarding corporate existence and power, authorization, approvals and
consents, binding effect, financial information, taxes, litigation, compliance
with laws, subsidiaries, proprietary rights (including, with respect to the
Company, all necessary rights to the use of the name "Internet" in Colorado),
insurance, debt, capitalization, material contracts, misstatements and
omissions, documents filed by the Company with the SEC, the approval of the
Board of Directors, shareholders and creditors of the Company and Group, the
absence of other merger agreements and other agreements with respect to business
combination transactions, the absence of fees for brokers and finders and
continuing representations and warranties.

     The Share Exchange Agreement contains covenants of each party, including:
(a) covenant not to enter into business combination transactions prior to the
Second Closing, (b) additional affirmative covenants of each party, as
applicable, requiring the maintenance of records, maintenance of properties,
conduct of business, maintenance of insurance, compliance with laws, payment of
taxes, reporting of specified information to the other party, reservation by the
Company of a sufficient number of shares of Common Stock to be issued to Group,
qualification by the Company of the shares of Common Stock to be issued to Group
for inclusion in the National Association of Securities Dealers Automated
Quotations/Small Cap Market ("NASDAQ/Small Cap Market"), maintenance of
existence, compliance with laws, use of best efforts to complete the Share
Exchange Agreement, coordination of publicity regarding the Share Exchange
Agreement, maintenance of confidentiality of information and further assurances,
and (c) negative covenants of each party, as applicable and subject to certain
transactions undertaken in the ordinary course of business, with respect to
amendment of charter documents, merger agreements or agreements with respect to
other business combination transactions, settling litigation, or delisting
securities of the Company from NASDAQ/Small Cap Market.

     The Share Exchange Agreement also contains conditions precedent to the
Second Closing  including, without limitation, satisfaction of each party with
the terms and conditions of certain documents contemplated  by the Share
Exchange Agreement (forms of which are included as exhibits to the Share
Exchange Agreement attached as Appendix C) receipt of all necessary approvals
and consents from the shareholders and creditors of the respective parties
(including with respect to the Company, approval by the Shareholders of
Proposals Three, Four, Five and Six below), governmental authorities and other
persons (including, without limitation, all necessary approvals under the Hart-
Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvements Act of 1976, as amended), the absence of
pending or threatened actions that would restrict 


                                     -14-

<PAGE>

in any material respect or prohibit the Second Closing, the determination 
that the share exchange will be characterized as a tax-free reorganization 
under section 368(a)(1)(A) or 368(a)(1)(B) of the Code, the absence of any 
violation or default with respect to any regulation of any governmental body 
by any of the parties or their respective subsidiaries, the continued 
accuracy and correctness of the representations and warranties of each party 
as contained in the Share Exchange Agreement, the performance by each party 
of its obligations under the Share Exchange Agreement, the delivery of 
certificates from appropriate officers of the respective parties and the 
delivery of opinions of counsel for each party acceptable to the other party 
in its sole discretion.

     The Share Exchange Agreement further provides that if the Shareholders of
the Company shall have approved the Share Exchange Agreement and the
transactions and other documents contemplated thereby, the Board of Directors
shall amend the Bylaws to fix the number of directors to eight (8) and to fill
the three vacancies created thereby with persons designated by Group.  See
"Directors and Executive Officers of the Company" above.

     Concurrent with the execution of the Share Exchange Agreement, the Company
and Group entered into a registration rights agreement (the "Registration Rights
Agreement") pursuant to which Group and its successors and assigns will have the
right on five occasions, commencing on May 29, 1998, to cause the Company to
register shares of Common Stock acquired by Group pursuant to the Share Exchange
Agreement (including shares of Common Stock issued to Group in exchange for the
shares of Interwest and shares of Common Stock issued upon conversion of the
Note) for sale under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities
Act"), and, commencing on May 29, 1997, to cause the Company to include Group's
shares in any registration statement filed under the Securities Act offering any
other shares of the Company's Common Stock.

     For financial accounting purposes, this Transaction will be accounted for
as a purchase of Interwest by the Company.  The Company intends the share
exchange transaction to be a tax-free exchange under the Code.  However, no
legal opinion has been obtained, and it is not anticipated that an opinion will
be obtained regarding this, or any other, income tax issues.  In addition, an
opinion of counsel is not binding on the IRS or the courts.  The federal income
tax law is uncertain as to many of the tax issues relevant to "tax-free"
transactions, and it is not possible to predict with certainty how the law will
develop or how the courts will decide various issues if they are litigated. 
Accordingly, there can be no assurances that this will be treated as a tax-free
transaction or that the share exchange transaction will not be challenged by the
IRS and that such challenge will not be sustained by the courts.  The only
entity, however, which would suffer any tax consequences from the share exchange
transaction would be Group and the shareholders of the Company are not subject
to any tax consequences as a result of the share exchange transaction.  The
Company is also not subject to any potential tax consequences other than any
goodwill resulting from the share exchange transaction would not be deductible
for federal income tax purposes if the share exchange transaction is not a tax-
free transaction.

     If the Transaction is not consummated at the Second Closing, the Company
will be faced with a possible loss of liquidity and the inability to repay the
Note.  Should this occur, the Company would seek to expand its existing lines of
credit and/or pursue secondary debt or equity financing.  There can be no
assurance that the Company would be successful in this regard and no discussions
in this regard have occurred.


                                     -15-

<PAGE>

     INTERWEST - DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS.

     GENERAL

     Interwest is engaged in the sale, installation, maintenance and service of
telephone equipment and other  telecommunications hardware, software, and other
specialty low-voltage systems, generally known in the telecommunications
industry is referred to as customer premise equipment ("CPE").  CPE includes all
equipment at the customer location up to the transmission carrier's termination
circuit.

     Principal products distributed by Interwest are multi-featured, digital key
telephone systems, private branch exchange ("PBX") systems, voice processing
products with computer telephone integration ("CTI") and network services. 
Interwest's products also include other peripheral data and telecommunications
products including wide area networking, call accounting, voice and data cable
networks and local area network integrated messaging.  In addition, a subsidiary
of Interwest designs and installs commercial paging systems, school intercom
systems, nurse call, video security and card access security systems.  A
division of Interwest operates in the secondary market for refurbished telephone
and voice mail systems throughout the United States.

     Interwest sells, installs, and services its products through its four
Colorado sales and service centers located in Pueblo, Colorado Springs, Denver,
and Fort Collins.  Each of these locations is a stand-alone profit center with a
sales manager, operations manager, sales and customer service personnel,
technicians, and warehousing operations.  Interwest's business plan calls for
continued growth through increased market penetration and acquisition of other
entities located in the western United States.

     HISTORY

     Interwest was founded in Colorado in 1977 as an independent interconnect
company to provide businesses with an alternative to AT&T for telephone and
related equipment installations, maintenance and service.  Over the years,
Interwest increased revenues and the range of product offerings with geographic
expansion into various cities in the Front Range of Colorado, customer base
acquisitions from smaller firms, and product diversification.  On June 1, 1995
Interwest was acquired from Robert L. Smith by Group, a subsidiary of Anschutz
Company.  Since the acquisition, Mr. Smith has remained on the Interwest Board
of Directors and continues as a key executive of Interwest.  Mr. Smith has been
an employee of Interwest and its subsidiaries since 1979.

     SUBSIDIARIES

     As noted in the financial statement disclosure, Interwest has four
subsidiaries.  The other shareholders of the subsidiaries are the business
managers in the respective subsidiary in which they own stock.  Collectively,
these subsidiaries accounted for 29% of total revenues for the seven months
ended December 31, 1995.

          WORK TELCOM SERVICES, INC. ("WORK TELCOM") - specializes in
          maintenance of existing AT&T and Rolm PBX systems.

          OMEGA BUSINESS COMMUNICATIONS SERVICES, INC. D/B/A INTERWEST SOUND
          COMMUNICATIONS, INC. ("INTERWEST SOUND") - designs, installs,
          maintains and services specialty sound systems, including commercial
          paging, sound systems, school intercom, hospital nurse call, CCTV, and
          card access security systems.


                                     -16-

<PAGE>

          INTERWEST CABLE NETWORK SYSTEMS, INC. ("INTERWEST CABLE") - provides
          outside cable plant construction in Metropolitan Denver for the
          telecom and cable TV industries.

          INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS PUEBLO CORPORATION ("INTERWEST PUEBLO") -
          This is a traditional voice CPE interconnect servicing southern
          Colorado.

     PRODUCTS AND SERVICES

     Interwest's core business is the design, installation, and maintenance of
digital customer premise equipment for voice applications.  Interwest's
traditional flagship product is the NEC line of digital telecommunication
systems.  Interwest is currently one of NEC America's 10 largest dealers in the
U.S. market.  Additional products include Fujitsu, Iwatsu, and the Hitachi line
for the hospitality industry.

     Due to Interwest's market position, it recently secured a dealership for
the full line of products offered by Northern Telecom (Nortel).  The Nortel
product line is the leading telecom line available to independent distributors
in the U.S. market.  The Nortel product line is sold through regional Bell
operating companies, GTE, WilTel, and other national industry leaders.  The
significance of the Nortel dealership is substantial due to the size of the
existing base and the product recognition at the high end of the market.

     Over the past five years, voice processing systems have become firmly
established as an integral component in business telephone systems.  Voice
processing products installed and maintained by Interwest include the Centigram,
Active Voice and Voice Systems Research ("VSR") product lines.  Interwest is one
of Active Voice's "AVID" dealers, designating superior sales and service
performance.  Interwest also represents many specialty peripheral products that
interface with telephone systems to provide complete turnkey business solutions.

     Interwest Sound's product line includes the complete line of Bose
professional audio equipment, Bogen audio and intercom systems, 3M satellite
music and drive-through intercom, and Sony audio and video systems.  Interwest
Sound also represents specialty lines of equipment that are custom engineered to
meet the client's specific needs.

     Critical to the product line offerings is employees' technical
qualifications to properly install and maintain the equipment.  Maintaining
qualifications requires constant training and certification of the technical
staff.

     Below is a summary of revenue for the twelve (12) months ended March 31,
1996, 1995 and 1994.  For 1996, these revenues do not tie directly into the
historical financial statements, due to the acquisition of Interwest by Group on
June 1, 1995, which resulted in a disaggregate year for financial reporting. 
For illustration purposes, revenue for 1996 has been recasted for consistent
presentation with prior periods.


                                     -17-

<PAGE>

REVENUE BREAKDOWN FOR THE THREE YEARS ENDED MARCH 31, 1996

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                               HARDWARE              SERVICE              TOTAL
                                               REVENUES              REVENUES            REVENUES
<S>                                        <C>                   <C>                 <C>
April 1993 - March 1994                     $  5,750,000          $  6,469,000        $ 12,219,000
  % OF TOTAL REVENUES                             47%                   53%                100% 

April 1994 - March 1995                     $  6,552,000          $  5,523,000        $ 12,075,000
  % OF TOTAL REVENUES                             54%                   46%                100% 

April 1995 - March 1996                     $  8,472,000          $  8,437,000        $ 16,909,000
  % OF TOTAL REVENUES                             50%                   50%                100% 

Total                                       $ 20,774,000          $ 20,429,000        $ 41,203,000
  % OF TOTAL REVENUES                             50%                   50%                100%
</TABLE>

     Over the three year period ended March 31, 1996 service revenue has
accounted for between 46% and 53% of total revenue.  Interwest's strategy is to
continue its emphasis on services.  The overall revenue growth for the three
years ended March 31, 1996 is largely attributable to the growth in new
contracts.  The average new contracts booked per month is listed below:


                                                  AVERAGE NUMBER OF
                                                 CONTRACTS PER MONTH

April 1993 - March 1994                                   36 

April 1994 - March 1995                                   57 

April 1995 - March 1996                                   75

     STRATEGY

     Interwest believes that it is the largest independent interconnect company
in Colorado based on annual revenues, with a cumulative installed base of over
5,000 customers on the Front Range.  

     Over the years, Interwest has grown and increased its regional market 
share through a combination of several factors: developing a strong sales 
organization, increasing emphasis on customer service, customer base 
acquisitions from smaller firms, and strategic diversification with 
complementary products and services.  Examples of Interwest's strategic 
diversification are highlighted below:

     -    WORK TELCOM performs maintenance for large CPE platforms not sold
          through Interwest.  This business is strategically important to
          further developing maintenance revenues which are not as susceptible
          to economic cycles as new system sales.

     -    INTERWEST SOUND installs and maintains specialty sound and security
          systems.  This niche in the low voltage systems market helps
          differentiate Interwest and broadens market penetration.

     -    U.S. TELPHONICS is a division of Interwest and deals in the secondary
          market for voice CPE, mostly selling to other interconnects throughout
          the United States.  U.S. Telphonics


                                     -18-

<PAGE>

          makes a market for those telephone systems Interwest is replacing 
          with new installations.  Consequently, Interwest is positioned to 
          offer trade-in allowances for customers' old telephone systems.

     By virtue of its consolidated management support and technical labor pool
at the Colorado Springs headquarters, Interwest management believes it is better
able to compete with smaller independent local firms as well as the large
national companies.

     Interwest's strategy for the future includes the expansion  of its products
and service lines so as to include data network systems products and services,
which will be marketed to Interwest's existing customer base.  Management
believes Interwest customers want full service capabilities for data networking
systems in addition to voice, Interwest's current strength.

     SALES OPERATIONS

     Sales management is functionally under the Vice President of Sales with
accountability to the business unit managers.  This organization structure
ensures consistent market coverage and coordination of team selling.  Each
physical location has a sales manager responsible for the geographic market
coverage.  In addition, the Interwest Sound, Work Telcom, and U.S. Telphonics
profit centers have general managers that provide sales management.  

     A summary of the sales organization is presented in the following table:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                        SALES FORCE DEPLOYMENT 

                           General    Interwest    Work        U.S.       Network
                           Business     Sound     Telcom    Telphonics    Systems    Total
<S>                        <C>        <C>         <C>       <C>           <C>        <C>
Denver                       10           2         2           0            1         15

Colo. Spgs.                   5           2         1           4            3         15

Pueblo                        3           0         0           0            0          3

Ft. Collins                   4           0         0           0            0          4

Total                        22           4         3           4            4         37
</TABLE>

     The General Business sales group focuses on small- to medium-sized users of
commercial grade telephone systems such as businesses and non-profit
organizations.  The Network Systems sales group focuses on high-end PBX systems
and large scale projects that fall out of the scope of the day-to-day business.

     TECHNICAL OPERATIONS

     All operations report to the vice president of operations, the position
responsible for all installations, service, maintenance, customer service,
dispatch, and warehousing.  Interwest's operations department is divided into
three management functions: 


                                     -19-

<PAGE>

     1.   Installation of new systems
     2.   Service, moves, adds and changes
     3.   Purchasing and warehousing.

     Interwest has centralized dispatching at corporate headquarters, which
allows cross-utilization of technicians amongst the various business units. 
Purchasing and warehousing are centralized in the Colorado Springs headquarters,
and materials are distributed to other locations on an as-needed basis. 
Management believes this system generates purchasing economies of scale and
maximizes inventory turns.

     RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT AND PATENTS

     Interwest is not engaged in research and development, nor does it hold any
patents.  Interwest is positioned in the market as a follower of technology. 
Technology changes tend to benefit Interwest since such changes stimulate
customer demand for new installations and upgrades of customer premise
equipment.

     WARRANTY AND MAINTENANCE

     Interwest generally provides customers, for an additional fee, with a
warranty on a purchase basis on equipment and installation for one to five years
after the installation of a new system, subject to a deductible payment from the
customer.  In addition, Interwest generally receives back-to-back warranties
from manufacturers which it passes on to its customers.  In those situations
where Interwest extends warranties beyond those of the manufacturers, warranty
reserves are established, recorded in the financial records, and amortized over
the warranty period.  Interwest charges its customers for all repairs done
subsequent to the warranty period.

     Interwest assists customers in the installation, maintenance and repair of
Interwest's products and provides training to the employees of such customers.

     CUSTOMERS

     No single customer accounted for more than 10% of sales for the seven 
months ended December 31, 1995.  Interwest customers consist of a broad range 
of Colorado businesses, health care providers, educational institutions, banks 
and state and local governmental entities.

     BACKLOG

     Interwest receives orders and is awarded contracts for the sale and
installation of telephone systems and other work to be performed in the future. 
Since contract installations are typically completed within 30 days of contract
execution, Interwest's backlog is not generally indicative of future
performance.  Generally contract payment terms are 40% paid upon contract
execution, 50% paid upon installation completion, and 10% paid upon customer
acceptance.  As of March 31, 1996, there were 86 unfilled orders from various
customers which will account for approximately $2,428,000 in future sales.  The
majority of these orders are expected to be shipped over the subsequent three
months.

     COMPETITION

     The telecommunications equipment industry is characterized by intense
competition and rapid change.  Interwest's products and services compete with
similar products and services offered by a


                                     -20-

<PAGE>

number of telephone equipment distributors, certain telephone operating 
companies and telephone interconnect companies.  Many competitors have 
financial, technical and market resources significantly greater that Interwest.

     Effective January 1, 1984, AT&T was divested of the regional Bell operating
companies ("RBOCs").  The RBOCs were permitted to market, sell, install and
service, but not manufacture, telecommunications products of the type marketed
by Interwest pursuant to the anti-trust decree entered in connection with the
divestiture.  The recently enacted Telecommunications Act of 1996 contains
provisions that permit the RBOCs, subject to satisfying certain conditions
designed to facilitate competition, to manufacture telecommunications equipment.
In light of this provision, it is possible that one or more RBOCs may eventually
decide to manufacture telecommunications equipment or to form alliances with
other manufacturers to design, market, install and service telecommunications
equipment.

     Following the AT&T divestiture, U.S. West, which was the RBOC in the Rocky
Mountain region, maintained a presence in the CPE market, selling both equipment
and services to business communications customers.  Interwest competed against
the perceived reliability of U.S. West and other larger competitors such as
Lucent Technologies, Inc. (formerly known as AT&T) and ROLM, especially with
clients who had never bought communications systems from other independent
providers.  Moreover, pricing against U.S. West and AT&T was difficult due to
differentiated volume-based wholesale pricing which was prevalent in the
industry.  As customer acceptance of independent interconnects has expanded and
the number of independent CPE providers has grown, Interwest has been able to
gain a larger share of the regional market and to realize certain economies of
scale.  Interwest believes this growth is a result of its ability to attract
small and mid-sized customers and to serve them more efficiently and effectively
than its larger competitors.

     In the Front Range middle market, Interwest not only competes against the
large corporate CPE providers noted above, but also smaller dealers which
compete with a price orientation.  Interwest believes it differentiates its
solution from the smaller independents with its technical operations and market
presence described above.

     REGULATION

     The Federal Communications Commission ("FCC") has promulgated regulations
which, among other things, set forth installation and equipment standards for
private telephone systems and require that all interconnect equipment installed
after January 1, 1980, meet standards adopted by the FCC.  Interwest believes
that the suppliers of its interconnect equipment comply with these requirements.

     EMPLOYEES

     On May 31, 1996, Interwest employed 199 full-time employees.  The number of
employees is significantly greater than at May 31, 1995 (165) and May 31, 1994
(94) due to the growth strategies implemented by Interwest over the past two
years.  The 199 employees at May 31, 1996 are broken down into the following
categories:  4 executives, 40 sales and marketing, 141 operations, technical and
warehouse, 13 accounting and administration, and 1 legal.


                                     -21-

<PAGE>

     PROPERTIES

     Interwest and its subsidiaries lease all of their office and warehouse
space and own no real property.  The following table provides information
regarding the total space leased by Interwest and its subsidiaries.


LOCATION                              APPROXIMATE            EXPIRATION
                                      SQUARE FEET           DATE OF LEASE

2150 Naegele Road                        10,000              June 1, 2000
Colorado Springs, CO 80904

2637 Midpoint Drive                       2,400              May 1, 1997
Building A-2, Suite C
Fort Collins, CO 80525

728 North Elizabeth                       2,000              May 1, 2000
Pueblo, CO  81003

3101 East 52nd Avenue                     6,400            August 31, 1998
Unit E
Denver, CO  80216

1114 West 7th Avenue                      9,432             July 31, 2001
Suite 200
Denver, CO  80204

     LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     Interwest is a party to one lawsuit and two unresolved administrative
proceedings alleging various wrongful acts or practices by Interwest.  Each
matter is being vigorously defended and, although the ultimate resolution of
these matters is uncertain, management believes that these actions are without
merit and that their outcome will not have a material adverse effect on
Interwest's financial position or results of operations.  Interwest has not
recorded any liability amounts related to these matters.

     PRO FORMA AND INTERWEST - SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     Presented below is selected pro forma combined financial information.  The
pro forma balance sheet combines the balance sheets of the Company as of April
30, 1996 with Interwest as of March 31, 1996 (their respective quarter end), as
if the Transaction had occurred on the balance sheet dates.  This merger will be
treated for financial accounting purposes as a purchase transaction.

     The pro forma statement of operations combines the Company's and
Interwest's three month interim and year end operations as if the Transaction
had occurred at the beginning of the period presented.  This pro forma
information is not necessarily indicative of future operations or the actual
results that would have occurred had the transaction been consummated at the
beginning of the period indicated.  The pro forma statement of operations and
the pro forma balance sheet do not include the effect of the $900,000 note
issued pursuant to the Share Exchange Agreement.


                                     -22-

<PAGE>

     Also presented is selected financial information of Interwest based upon
its interim and prior fiscal year ends.  Interwest was acquired by Group on June
1, 1995.  Group's year end was December 31, 1995.  Prior to Group's acquisition,
Interwest had a March 31 year end.  The historical financial information of
Interwest is presented for the period subsequent to Group's acquisition (three
months ended March 31, 1996 and the seven months ended December 31, 1995) and
the periods prior to Group's acquisition (the two months ended May 31, 1995 and
the years ended March 31, 1995 and 1994).

     Financial statements of the Company are included in the Company's Form 10-
KSB and Form 10-QSB, which are included as Appendixes E and F, respectively,
attached to this Proxy Statement.  Complete pro forma combined condensed
financial information and financial statements of Interwest are included in
Appendix D attached to this Proxy Statement.

                                                             Interwest
                                         Pro Forma           Historical
                                       April 30, 1996      March 31, 1996
                                       --------------      --------------
BALANCE SHEET:
 Cash                                    $1,908,000            $842,000 
 Working Capital                          1,875,000           1,224,000 
 Long-term debt and other                   639,000             639,000 
 Stockholders' equity                     8,204,000           3,661,000 
 Total Assets                            17,315,000           8,140,000 


                                                      Pro Forma
                                      ---------------------------------------
                                      Three Months Ended        Year Ended
                                        April 30, 1996       January 31, 1996
                                      ------------------     ----------------
OPERATIONS:
 Net Revenue                               $8,273,000            $34,008,000 
 Gross Margin                               2,740,000              9,122,000 
 Income (loss) before income taxes           (292,000)            (1,178,000)
 Net income (loss)                           (292,000)            (1,050,000)

 Net income (loss) per share                     (.06)                  (.22)
 Weighted shares outstanding                4,707,000              4,704,000


                                     -23-

<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       Interwest Historical
                           ---------------------------------------------------------------------
                              Three          Seven            Two
                              Months         Months          Months          Years Ended
                              Ended          Ended           Ended            March 31,
                             March 31,     December 31,      May 31,          ---------
                               1996           1995            1995        1995         1994
                               ----           ----            ----        ----         ----
<S>                        <C>             <C>             <C>          <C>          <C>
OPERATIONS
 Net Revenue               $4,659,000      $10,284,000     $1,966,000   $12,075,000  $12,219,000
 Gross Margin               1,674,000        3,794,000        864,000     5,064,000    5,030,000
 Income (loss) before
   income taxes               (80,000)          42,000         28,000       852,000    1,095,000
 Net income (loss)            (62,000)          (3,000)        10,000       467,000      627,000
</TABLE>

     INTERWEST - MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF LIQUIDITY AND RESULTS
     OF OPERATIONS.

     The following is Interwest's discussion and analysis of certain significant
factors which have affected Interwest's financial condition and results of
operations during the periods included in the accompanying financial statements.

     FINANCIAL CONDITION

     The current ratio (current assets divided by current liabilities) declined
to 1.41 at December 31, 1995 from 1.64 at March 31, 1995.  The current ratio was
1.32 at March 31, 1996.  Accounts receivable balances were $3,034,000 and
$2,922,000 at December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996, respectively.  This increase
from the March 31, 1995 balance of $2,045,000 is due to the overall growth in
revenues, and an increase in progress billings on large installation contracts. 
Average days outstanding for accounts receivable had decreased to 51.3 for the
seven month period ended December 31, 1995 from 59 for the fiscal year ended
March 31, 1995.  This was due to increased collection efforts on trade
receivables and progress payments on installation contracts.  Average days
outstanding for accounts receivable had increased to 57 for the three month
period ended March 31, 1996, due to two large contracts for which most of the
payment will be received at the close of the contract.  Subsequently, one of
those contracts has been completed, and full payment received.

     Inventory increased from $892,000 at March 31, 1995 to $1,169,000 at
December 31, 1995 and decreased to $1,085,000 at March 31, 1996.  The overall
increase in inventory is due to larger inventory balances required to support
the increased sales of Interwest.

     Working capital was $1,308,000 as of December 31, 1995, a decrease of
$181,000 from working capital of $1,489,000 as of March 31, 1995.  Working
capital declined further to $1,224,000 as of March 31, 1996, generally as a
result of loss from operations and purchases of equipment.

     LIQUIDITY AND RESOURCES

     Interwest's cash position decreased by $427,000 during the seven month
period ended December 31, 1995.  This decrease in cash balances was primarily
attributable to capital expenditures of $398,000, repayments of debt of
$219,000, and income tax payments of $427,000.  Cash  was provided through
advances from Group of $422,000, and an increase in the revolving line of credit
of $236,000.  Interwest's cash position increased by $699,000 during the three
month period ended March 31, 1996. 


                                     -24-

<PAGE>

The main source of cash was provided by a subcontractor bond of $850,000, which
was held in a money market account.  Subsequent to March 31, 1996 Interwest
learned that it was not awarded the contract, and the bond was refunded to the
subcontractor.  During the three months ended March 31, 1996, cash was used
primarily for capital expenditures of $100,000, and repayments of debt of
$44,000.  Additional cash was provided through an increase in the revolving line
of credit of $58,000.
     
     The balance of the revolving line of credit with Interwest's bank was
$330,000 at March 31, 1996.  The total revolving line of credit available to
Interwest as of March 31, 1996 was $500,000.  In May, 1996, Group obtained a new
credit facility of $4,300,000 under a two-year revolving line of credit. 
Interwest can draw upon this line of credit jointly with its parent and
affiliates for working capital purposes and general corporate needs and is
obligated to repay all advances jointly and severally with Group and other
affiliates.  Certain assets of Interwest and its subsidiaries also
collateralized this credit facility.  It is expected that this credit facility
will not be available to Interwest after the share exchange with the Company,
and Interwest will be released of its joint obligation after repayment by
Interwest's of its outstanding balance.

     RESULTS FROM OPERATIONS

     During the seven month period ended December 31, 1995, Interwest started up
the Fort Collins business unit utilizing a customer list purchased May, 1995. 
In addition, Interwest continued to build up the Interwest Cable subsidiary,
which was incorporated in January, 1995.
   
     Interwest experienced average monthly revenues of $1,469,000 for the seven
month period ended December 31, 1995.  This represents a 46.0% increase from the
average monthly revenues of $1,006,000 for the twelve month period (prior fiscal
year) ended March 31, 1995.  Of this growth, 5.9% came from incremental revenues
generated by the Fort Collins business unit, 15.6% came from incremental
revenues generated by Interwest Cable, and 24.5% came from growth experienced by
the remaining business units.  Interwest experienced average monthly revenues of
$1,553,000 during the three months ended March 31, 1996.  Interwest has a strong
backlog of orders at approximately $2,428,000 as of March 31, 1996.
   
     The gross profit margin for the seven month period ended December 31, 1995,
and the three month period ended March 31, 1996, was 36.9% and 35.9%
respectively.  This is a decrease from the 41.9% gross profit margin experienced
by Interwest for the fiscal year ended March 31, 1995.  Gross profit margins
have declined due to the increase in large, institutional and government
contracts, which are sold at a lower markup than smaller retail contracts.
   
     Selling, general and administrative expenses and depreciation and
amortization expenses averaged $527,000 per month (35.9% of revenues) for the
seven month period ended December 31, 1995, and $582,000 per month (37.4% of
revenues) for the three month period ended March 31, 1996.  This is an increase
from an average of $351,000 per month (34.8% of revenues) for the fiscal year
ended March 31, 1995.  This increase is due to increased operating expenses
attributable to the addition of the Fort Collins business unit and Interwest
Cable, building up the sales staff to generate revenue growth, and redesigning
the compensation structure for the sales managers.  Rent expenses were increased
due to the addition of new space in Fort Collins and Denver; and amortization
expenses were increased due to the effects of the June 1, 1995 acquisition. 
However, offsetting savings were recognized as Interwest made efforts to
consolidate administrative functions.


                                      -25-


<PAGE>

     RISKS RELATING TO INTERWEST'S BUSINESS

     The following are risks related to the Interwest's business and the
telecommunications industry in general.  Should the Transaction be consummated,
the following risks will apply to the Company's ownership and operation of
Interwest.

     LOSS FROM OPERATIONS.  For the seven months ended December 31, 1995 and for
the three months ended March 31, 1996, Interwest's results from operations in
both periods included net losses in the income statement.  Interwest may
continue to incur operating losses in the future. 

     DEPENDENCE ON MANAGEMENT.  Interwest is dependent on certain key managers. 
There is no assurance that these key managers will remain with Interwest, except
for Robert L. Smith, who has an employment contact.  Mr. Smith's employment
contract requires him to remain as an employee of Interwest until June 1, 1997.

     COMPETITION.  For the first ten years of deregulation after the AT&T break-
up, U.S. West focused on the interconnect market, just like many of the other
RBOCs.  Interwest had to compete against the perceived reliability of an RBOC,
but with less sophisticated clients.  Moreover, pricing against U.S. West and
AT&T was difficult due to differentiated volume-based wholesale pricing. 
Equipment pricing differentials were offset by Interwest's more economical
technical operation and service responsiveness.  Over the past three years U.S.
West has withdrawn from the Front Range middle market with its recast strategy
on broadband commercial opportunities, cable TV and the new telecommunications
legislation.  U.S. West still wins an important share of the large deals,
especially with its Northern Telecom dealership.  Although the NEC NEAX 2400
effectively competes against Northern Telecom's largest switches, early in the
second quarter of 1996, Interwest received a Northern Telecom dealership.  In
addition to U.S. West, AT&T and Rolm are significant competitors.

     PENDING LEGISLATION.  Congress has recently passed, and the President
approved, a  major telecommunications bill and various state legislatures have
under consideration or have passed various proposals that would allow the local
exchange carriers and large competitors such as U.S. West to enter into the
inter-LATA long distance market.  Congress and numerous state legislatures have
also adopted proposals which would open up the local access market currently
dominated by the RBOCs.  Interwest is unable to predict the impact of the
various legislation; however, it does believe competition will increase in its
markets.  Interwest also views the new legislation favorably as it believes new
opportunities may develop in the local markets to date controlled by the RBOCS. 
See "Business - Governmental Regulation."

     OBSOLESCENCE DUE TO TECHNOLOGICAL CHANGE AND NEW SERVICES.  The
telecommunications industry has been characterized by steady technological
change, frequent new service introductions and evolving industry standards. 
Interwest believes that its future success will depend on its ability to
anticipate such changes and to offer on a timely basis services that meet these
evolving industry standards.  There can be no assurance that Interwest will have
sufficient resources to make the investments necessary to acquire new technology
or to introduce new services that would satisfy an expanded range of customer
needs.

     NO DIVIDENDS.  Interwest has paid no cash dividends on its common stock and
has no present intention of paying cash dividends in the foreseeable future.  It
is the present policy of the Board of Directors to retain all earnings to
provide for the growth of Interwest.  Payment of cash dividends in the future
will depend, among other things, upon Interwest's future earnings, requirements
for capital improvements, the operating and financial conditions of Interwest
and other factors deemed relevant by the Board of Directors.

                                      -26-


<PAGE>


     INTEREST OF MANAGEMENT IN MATTERS TO BE VOTED UPON.

     The management of the Company have no material interest in the approval by
Shareholders of Proposal Three.

     EFFECTS OF ADOPTION OF PROPOSAL THREE.

     ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS; CHANGE OF CONTROL

     Group will have a substantial ownership position in the Company and may
designate three of the Company's directors at the Second Closing.  Pursuant to
the Share Exchange Agreement, based upon the number of shares of Common Stock
outstanding on June 24, 1996, the Company will issue to Group 2,306,541 shares
of Common Stock, or 49% of the 4,707,228 shares of Common Stock that would be
outstanding after giving effect to such issuance of shares upon the consummation
of the Transaction at the Second Closing.  If the Company were then to default
on the payment of the Note (whether at scheduled maturity, on the date of any
required prepayment, or after the expiration of applicable grace periods and
cure periods, upon acceleration) and Group were to elect to convert the Note,
the Company would be required to issue to Group 300,000 shares of Common Stock
at the price of $3.00 per share (as such number of shares and price per share
may be adjusted pursuant to the terms of the Note).  If effect were given to the
issuance to Group of these 2,606,541 shares, then Group would own 52.1% of the
5,007,227 shares of Common Stock that would then be outstanding, based upon the
number of shares outstanding on June 24, 1996.  Comparatively, based on such
share ownership by Group, the percentage ownership of the Company's current
shareholders will be reduced to 51% initially, with the potential to be further
reduced to 47.9% if the Company were to default on the payment of the Note. 
Group will also have the right to designate three of the eight directors of the
Company who will hold that position upon the consummation of the Transaction at
the Second Closing.

     As a result, Group will have the ability to exert substantial influence
with respect to matters considered by the Board of Directors and may control the
outcome of matters submitted to the approval of the shareholders of the Company,
including the election of the other directors of the Company, subject to the
staggered terms that are the subject of Proposal Five.  Group could have a veto
power over proposed transactions between the Company and third parties (such as
a merger) that currently require the approval of the holders of at least a
majority of the issued and outstanding shares of Common Stock and, if Proposal
Six is approved and the Company's Articles of Incorporation is so amended, that
would require the approval of the holders of at least two-thirds of the issued
and outstanding shares of Common Stock.  It would be unlikely that control of
the Company would be transferred to a third party without Group's consent and
agreement.  It is also unlikely that a third party would offer to pay a premium
to acquire the Company without the prior agreement of the Group, even if the
Board of Directors were to choose to attempt to sell the Company in the future.

     BOARD RECOMMENDATION TO SHAREHOLDERS AND VOTE REQUIRED.

     The Board of Directors recommends the approval of the Share Exchange
Agreement and the transactions (including the Transaction) and other documents
contemplated thereby.  The Board of directors believes that the combination of
the Company and Interwest will enhance each entity's product lines and overall
customer base; provide for centralized management affording various reductions
in overhead costs; create a combined revenue source of a magnitude capable of
attracting  secondary fund raising opportunities; and afford a combined base for
future business acquisitions and strategic alliances.

                                      -27-


<PAGE>

     On May 29, 1996, the closing sale price of the Common Stock as reported on
NASDAQ was $5.25 per share.  On June 24, 1996, the closing sales price of the
Common Stock was reported on NASDQ was $5.25 per share.  The price of the
Company's Common Stock on the date of the Share Exchange Agreement and
subsequent increase has been considered by the Board of Directors in making its
recommendation set forth above.

     The affirmative vote of a majority of the shares of Common Stock
represented and entitled to be voted at the Special Meeting is required  to
approve Proposal Three.  The Officers and Directors of the Company have advised
the Company that they plan to vote their shares of Common Stock in favor of
Proposal Three.  The Company will not consummate the Transaction if the required
approval of the Shareholders of the Company is not obtained with respect to each
of Proposals Three, Four, Five and Six.


                             PROPOSAL NUMBER FOUR

          PROPOSAL TO AMEND THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION TO INCREASE
            THE NUMBER OF AUTHORIZED SHARES OF COMMON STOCK, NO PAR
                          VALUE, TO 20,000,000 SHARES 

     The Board of Directors intends to present at the Special Meeting a proposal
to approve an amendment to the Company's Articles of Incorporation to increase
the number of authorized shares of no par value Common Stock to 20,000,000
shares of Common Stock.  The presently authorized capital stock of the Company
consists of 4,500,000 shares of Common Stock, no par value, and 100,000,000
shares of Preferred Stock, $.0001 par value.  

     The additional shares of Common Stock for which authorization is sought
would be identical to the shares of Common Stock of the Company now currently
authorized.

     To date no series of Preferred Stock has been established by the Board of
Directors.  The Preferred Stock could have preference over the Common Stock with
respect to the payment of dividends and other preferences as would be determined
by the Board of Directors of the Company at the time of establishment of any
series of Preferred Stock.    Holders of Common Stock do not have preemptive
rights to subscribe to additional securities which may issued by the Company.

     As permitted by the Colorado Business Corporation Act ("CBCA"), the Board
of Directors is empowered to issue the Preferred Stock in series, at any time or
from time to time, and to determine the price or prices, the number of shares
designated for a particular series, and the relative preferences, privileges and
restrictions of the shares so issued.  Among the determinations to be made by
the Board of Directors for each issuance of a series of Preferred Stock are the
following:

     (a)  the rate of dividend, the time of payment of dividends, whether
dividends are cumulative, and the date from which any dividends shall accrue;

     (b)  whether shares may be redeemed and, if so, the redemption price and
the terms and conditions of redemption;

     (c)  the amount payable upon shares in the event of involuntary
liquidation;

     (d)  the amount payable upon shares in the event of voluntary liquidation;

                                      -28-


<PAGE>

     (e)  sinking fund or other provisions, if any, for the redemption or
purchase of shares;

     (f)  the terms and conditions under which shares may be converted, if the
shares of any series are issued with the right of conversion; and

     (g)  voting powers, if any.

Such determinations would be made by the Board of Directors at the time it
designated the particular series of Preferred Stock comprising the series and
would take into account the circumstances pertinent at that time.  No shares of
Preferred Stock are issued and outstanding.

     The Company currently has no plans to issue any additional shares of Common
Stock or any shares of Preferred Stock other than:  (i) the shares of Common
Stock that previously have been reserved for issuance with respect to
outstanding stock options, including the stock option plans discussed in
Proposals One and Two above, and (ii) shares of Common Stock to be issued
pursuant to the Share Exchange Agreement described in Proposal Three (including
shares of Common Stock issued to Group in exchange for the shares of Interwest
and shares of Common Stock issued upon conversion of the Note).

     If this Proposal Four is approved and the Articles of Incorporation are
amended accordingly, the increased number of authorized shares of Common Stock
will be available for issuance from time to time for such purposes and
consideration as the Board of Directors may approve and no further vote of
shareholders of the Company will be required, except as provided under Colorado
law or the rules of any national securities exchange on which shares of the
Company are at the time listed.  The availability of additional shares for
issuance, without the delay and expense of obtaining the approval of
shareholders at a special meeting, will afford the Company greater flexibility
in acting upon proposed transactions.  

     In the event this Proposal Four is approved, the amendment to the Company's
Articles of Incorporation authorizing 20,000,000 shares of Common Stock will
become effective upon the filing with the Secretary of State of the State of
Colorado of a certificate with respect to such amendment.

     INTEREST OF MANAGEMENT IN MATTERS TO BE VOTED UPON.

     The management of the Company and the director nominees do not have an
interest in the approval by shareholders of Proposal Four.

     EFFECTS OF ADOPTION OF PROPOSAL FOUR.

     ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS.  The additional authorized but unissued shares of
Common Stock, for which approval is sought, could be used by incumbent
management to make more difficult a change in control of the Company.  Under
certain circumstances such shares could be used to create voting impediments or
to frustrate persons seeking to effect a takeover or otherwise gain control of
the Company.  For example, such shares could be privately placed with purchasers
who might side with the Board of Directors in opposing a hostile takeover bid.

     Despite such anti-takeover implications, this Proposal Four is not the
result of management's knowledge of any effort to accumulate the Company's
securities or to obtain control of the Company by means of a merger, tender
offer, solicitation in opposition to management or otherwise.

                                      -29-


<PAGE>

     Except as disclosed in this Proxy Statement, the Company's Board of
Directors is not aware of the existence of any provisions in the Articles of
Incorporation or Bylaws or terms of contracts to which it is a party which may
be considered to have an anti-takeover effect.  The Company's Articles of
Incorporation and Bylaws do not contain any provisions which would impose any
burden in excess of requirements imposed by Colorado law upon potential tender
offerors or others seeking a takeover of the Company, other than provisions for
limitation of director liability.

     VOTING AND FUTURE ISSUANCES.  The Articles do not provide for cumulative
voting.  As a result, in order to be ensured of representation on the Board, a
shareholder must control the votes of a majority of the shares present and
voting at a shareholders' meeting at which a quorum is present.  The lack of
cumulative voting requires an entity seeking a takeover to acquire a
substantially greater number of shares to ensure representation on the Board
than would be necessary were cumulative voting available.  Further, because the
Articles deny preemptive rights to the shareholders, any authorized but
unreserved shares of Common Stock, in the event this Proposal Four is passed,
may be issued to parties without first offering such shares to existing
shareholders.  Such issuances, particularly in light of the flexibility which
will be afforded to the Board might be used to reduce the equity ownership of a
tender offeror or other acquiring entity thereby rendering acquisition efforts
more difficult or impossible.

     DILUTIVE EFFECT.  The issuance of additional shares of Common Stock could
have the effect of diluting the interests of the existing holders of the Common
Stock.  Holders of Common Stock do not have preemptive rights to subscribe to
additional securities which may issued by the Company.

     MANAGEMENT RECOMMENDATION AND REQUIRED VOTE. 

     Management recommends the approval of the Amendment to the Articles of
Incorporation to increase the number of authorized shares of its Common Stock
from 4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 shares.  The Board believes the increase
will make available for further expansion additional shares to be issued in an
acquisition or other form of business acquisition and/or secondary financing 

     The affirmative vote of a majority of the shares of Common Stock issued and
outstanding is required to approve Proposal Four.  The Officers and Directors
have advised the Company that they plan to vote their shares of Common Stock in
favor of Proposal Four.

     The approval of Proposal Four is a condition to the obligations of the
Company and Group to consummate the Transaction described in Proposal Three.


                            PROPOSAL NUMBER FIVE

            AMENDMENT TO ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION CONCERNING
       CLASSIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND ELECTION FOR STAGGERED TERMS

     Pursuant to the Share Exchange Agreement, the Board of Directors intends to
present at the Special Meeting a proposal to approve an amendment to the
Company's Articles of Incorporation to divide the Board of Directors into three
classes, each class serving for a three year term.

     The Company's Bylaws presently provide for a Board of Directors of not less
than three (3) or more than seven (7) members who shall hold office until the
next succeeding Annual or Special Meeting of Shareholders or until their
successors shall have been elected and shall qualify. The number of Directors is
currently fixed at five (5) Directors.  Pursuant to the Share Exchange
Agreement, the Board 

                                      -30-


<PAGE>

of Directors will amend the Bylaws of the Company to fix the number of 
Directors of the Company at eight (8) Directors and will cause the three (3) 
vacancies created thereby to be filled by three (3) persons designated by 
Group to be elected as Directors of the Company.

     If this Proposal Five is approved and the Articles of Incorporation are 
amended accordingly, the Board of Directors will be divided into three 
classes, each class serving for a three-year term.  Accordingly, if this 
Proposal Five is approved the Board of Directors elected at the Special 
Meeting on July 31, 1996 will be divided into Class I, Class II and Class III 
Directors promptly following the filing with the Secretary of State of the 
State of Colorado of a certificate with respect to the adoption of the 
amendment.

     The Class I Director or Directors terms of office would expire at the 
first Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held in 1997; the term of office 
for the Class II Directors would expire at the second Annual Meeting of 
Shareholders to be held in 1998; and the terms of the Class III Directors 
would expire at the third Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held in 1999.  
Upon the expiration of the initial staggered terms, Directors would be 
elected for three (3) year terms to succeed those Directors whose terms 
expire.

     If this Proposal Five is not approved, the term of each member of the 
Board of Directors would last until the next Annual Meeting of Shareholders 
and there will be no classification of Directors.

     It is therefore proposed that the Company's Articles of Incorporation be 
amended so that Article IV, Section 2 reads as follows:

                                   ARTICLE IV
                               BOARD OF DIRECTORS

     SECTION 2.  CLASSIFICATION OF DIRECTORS.  The Board of Directors shall 
be divided into three classes on the dates and in the manner set forth below. 
 Each class of Directors shall consist, as nearly as possible, of one-third 
of the total number of Directors.  The Class I Directors term shall expire at 
the first Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held in 1997; the Class II 
Directors term shall expire at the second Annual Meeting of Shareholders to 
be held in 1998; the Class III Directors term shall expire at the third 
Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held in 1999.  Upon expiration of the 
initial staggered terms, Directors will be elected for three (3) years to 
succeed those Directors whose terms expire.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, 
and except as otherwise required by law, whenever the holders of any one or 
more series of Preferred Stock shall have the right, voting separately as a 
class, to elect one or more directors of the Company, the terms of the 
director or directors elected by such holders shall expire at the next 
succeeding annual meeting of shareholders. Vacancies which occur during the 
year may be filled by the Board of Directors to serve for the remainder of 
the initial term of each class.  At the expiration of each initial term, all 
subsequent terms for each Class will be three (3) years.

     In the event this Proposal Five is approved, the amendment to the 
Company's Articles of Incorporation relating to the classification of 
Directors will become effective upon the filing with the Secretary of State 
of the State of Colorado of a certificate with respect to such amendment.


                                      -31-
<PAGE>

     INTEREST OF MANAGEMENT IN MATTERS TO BE VOTED UPON.

     The management of the Company and the director nominees do not have an
interest in the approval by shareholders of Proposal Five.

     EFFECTS OF ADOPTION OF PROPOSAL FIVE.

     ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS.  If adopted, this procedure will avoid the election
of a complete new Board of Directors every year.  The Board of Directors
presently consists of five (5) members.  If the Board of Directors if fixed at
eight (8) members as is proposed by the Share Exchange Agreement, at least two
(2) Directors will be elected each year.  Thus, each year at least two (2) or
three (3) newly elected Directors will join a Board of five (5) existing
Directors.  It would require two (2) Annual or Special Meetings of the
Shareholders to change a majority of the Board of Directors, whereas presently
it requires only one (1) Annual Meeting to do so.

     Because the proposed amendment would require a longer period of time to
change the Board even if a majority of the shareholders desired a change, this
proposal, if adopted, could have the effect of discouraging, or making it more
difficult to effect a merger, tender offer, the assumption of control by a
holder of a large block of the Company's Common Stock, or the removal of
incumbent management.  This effect could occur even if such actions would be
favorable to the interest of the shareholders.  For example, the proposed
amendment might tend to retard the ability of Group to cause the replacement of
the current Directors of the Company after the closing of the Transaction. 
However, except for certain provisions of the Share Exchange Agreement or as set
forth elsewhere in this Proxy Statement, the Board is not aware of any efforts
to obtain control of the Company, and the proposal of this measure is not in
response to any such efforts.

     In addition, the Company's Articles of Incorporation prohibit cumulative
voting in the election of Directors.  The prohibition on cumulative voting, the
proposed separate classification of Directors and the staggered terms of
Directors could have the effect of discouraging possible take-overs of the
Company.

     MANAGEMENT RECOMMENDATION AND REQUIRED VOTE.

     Management recommends approval of Proposal Five.  Management believes the
proposal will help assure continuity and stability in the Board membership. 
Although the Company  has not experienced any problems in the past with lack of
continuity or stability in the Board, the Board of Directors believes that the
classification of the Board of Directors effected by the proposed amendment will
serve the best interests of the Company and its shareholders.

     The affirmative vote of a majority of the shares of Common Stock issued and
outstanding is required to approve Proposal Five.  The Officers and Directors
have advised the Company that they plan to vote their shares of Common Stock in
favor of Proposal Five.

     The approval of Proposal Five is a condition to the obligations of the
Company and Group to consummate the Transaction described in Proposal Three.


                                      -32-

<PAGE>

                           PROPOSAL NUMBER SIX

        PROPOSAL TO AMEND THE ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION TO INCREASE 
          THE VOTING REQUIREMENT BY THE COMPANY'S SHAREHOLDERS IN 
                        CERTAIN CORPORATE ACTIONS

     Pursuant to the Share Exchange Agreement, the Board of Directors intends 
to present at the Special Meeting a proposal to approve an amendment to the 
Company's Articles of Incorporation to increase the number of shares required 
to be voted (i) in favor of the sale, pledge, liquidation, exchange or 
disposal of all or substantially the Company's property or assets or (ii) to 
approve a merger, consolidation or exchange of the issued and outstanding 
shares of the Company with another corporation or entity.

     The current Articles of Incorporation of the Company require only a 
majority vote of the outstanding shares of the Company at a Special Meeting 
of Shareholders to approve either of these types of corporate activity.  The 
proposed amendment which is permitted by the CBCA will raise the voting 
requirement to the affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of the shares 
issued and outstanding to approve a sale of the corporate assets or a merger.

     It is therefore proposed that the Company's Articles of Incorporation be 
amended so that Article VIII, Sections 5(c) and 5(d) read as follows:

                                  ARTICLE VIII

     SECTION 5(c)  to sell, pledge, lease, exchange, liquidate, or otherwise 
dispose of all or substantially all of the property or assets of the 
corporation, including its goodwill, if not in the ordinary course of its 
business, upon such terms and conditions as the Board of Directors may 
determine; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that such transaction shall be authorized or 
ratified by the affirmative vote of the holders of at least two-thirds of the 
shares issued and outstanding and entitled to vote thereon at a shareholders' 
meeting duly called for such purpose, or authorized or ratified by the 
written consent of the holders of all of the shares entitled to vote thereon; 
and PROVIDED, FURTHER, that any such transaction with any substantial 
shareholder or affiliate of the corporation shall be authorized or ratified 
by the affirmative vote of the holders of at least two-thirds of the shares 
entitled to vote thereon at a shareholders' meeting duly called for that 
purpose, unless such transaction is with any subsidiary of the corporation or 
is approved by the affirmative vote of a majority of the continuing directors 
of the corporation, or is authorized or ratified by the written consent of 
the holders of all of the shares entitled to vote thereon;

     SECTION 5(d)  to merge, consolidate, or exchange all of the issued or
outstanding shares of one or more classes of the corporation upon such terms and
conditions as the Board of Directors may authorize; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that such
merger, consolidation, or exchange shall be approved or ratified by the
affirmative vote of the holders of at least two-thirds of the shares entitled to
vote thereon at a shareholders' meeting duly called for that purpose, or
authorized or ratified by the written consent of the holders of all of the
shares entitled to vote thereon; and PROVIDED, FURTHER, that any such merger,
consolidation, or exchange with any substantial shareholder or affiliate of the
corporation shall be authorized or ratified by the affirmative vote of the
holders of at least two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote thereon at a
shareholders' meeting duly called for that purpose, unless such merger,
consolidation, or exchange is with any subsidiary of the corporation or is
approved by the affirmative vote of a majority of the continuing directors of
the corporation, or is authorized or ratified by the written consent of the
holders of all of the shares entitled to vote thereon; and


                                      -33-

<PAGE>

     In the event this Proposal Six is approved, the amendment to the 
Company's Articles of Incorporation relating to increase in voting 
requirements will become effective upon the filing with the Secretary of 
State of the State of Colorado of a certificate with respect to such 
amendment.

     INTEREST OF MANAGEMENT IN MATTERS TO BE VOTED UPON.

     The current management of the Company and the Director nominees do not 
have an interest in the approval by Shareholders of Proposal Six.

     EFFECTS OF ADOPTION OF PROPOSAL SIX.

     ANTI-TAKEOVER EFFECTS.  The increase in the voting requirement for 
approval of the sale of the Company's assets or the merger or consolidation 
of the Company with another corporation or entity will make either of these 
corporate actions more difficult to achieve and may have the result of 
discouraging the liquidation or merger of the Company even if a majority of 
the Company's voting shares are in favor of such proposal.  

     Despite such anti-takeover implications, this Proposal Six is not the 
result of management's knowledge of any effort to accumulate the Company's 
securities or to obtain control of the Company by means of a merger, tender 
offer, or sale of the Company's assets, other than possibly the acquisition 
of shares by Group in The Share Exchange described in Proposal Three.

     Except for certain provisions contained in the Share Exchange Agreement 
or as disclosed elsewhere in this Proxy Statement, the Company's Board of 
Directors is not aware of the existence of any provisions in the Articles of 
Incorporation or Bylaws or terms of contracts to which it is a party which 
may be considered to have an anti-takeover effect.  The Company's Articles of 
Incorporation and Bylaws do not contain any provisions which would impose any 
burden in excess of requirements imposed by Colorado law upon potential 
take-over attempts.

     MANAGEMENT RECOMMENDATION AND REQUIRED VOTE. 

     Management recommends approval of Proposal Six to increase the voting 
requirement by the Company's Shareholders for certain corporation actions.

     The affirmative vote of a majority of the Company's shares issued and 
outstanding is required to approval of Proposal Six.  The Officers and 
Directors have advised the Company that they plan to vote their shares of 
Common Stock in favor of Proposal Six.

     The approval of Proposal Six is a condition to the obligations of the 
Company and Group to consummate the Transaction described in Proposal Three.

                         PROPOSAL NUMBER SEVEN

                         ELECTION OF DIRECTORS

     The Company's Board of Directors intends to recommend the election to 
the Board of the five (5) nominees listed below.  If Proposal Five is 
approved and the Company's Articles of Incorporation are amended to provide 
for a classified Board of Directors with staggered terms, the Directors would 
be assigned to the classes specified and for the terms so indicated, to hold 
office until the Annual Meeting


                                       -34-

<PAGE>

of Shareholders in the year indicated and/or until their successors are 
elected and qualified or until their earlier death, resignation or removal.  
If Proposal Five is not approved, each of the Directors would hold office 
until the next Annual Meeting of Shareholders and/or until their successors 
are elected and qualified or until their earlier death, resignation or 
removal.

     All members of the present Board of Directors have been nominated for re-
election to the Board.  The persons named as "proxies" in the enclosed form of
Proxy, intend to vote for the five (5) nominees for election as Directors unless
otherwise instructed in such proxy.  If at the time of the Special Meeting, any
of the nominees named below should be unable to serve, which event is not
expected to occur, the discretionary authority provided in the Proxy will be
exercised to vote for such substitute nominee and nominees, if any, as shall be
designated by the Board of Directors.  An affirmative vote of a majority of the
shares present at the Special Meeting will be required to elect the following
nominees.  The Officers and Directors have advised the Company that they plan to
vote their shares in favor of each of the nominees set forth below.

     NOMINEES.

     The following table sets forth the name and age of each nominee for
Director, indicating all positions and offices with the Company presently held
by him, the period during which he has served as such, and the class and term
for which he has been nominated, assuming for these purposes the approval by the
shareholders of Proposal Five and the related amendment of the Articles of
Incorporation:

                     Class I Nominee - Terms Expiring at the
                      Annual Shareholders Meeting in 1997
                      -----------------------------------

                                                         Year
Name                   Age        Position          First Director
- ----                   ---        --------          --------------
Dale Morrison          40         Director               1988
William J. Maxwell     54         Director               1996


                  Class II Nominee - Terms Expiring at the
                    Annual Shareholders Meeting in 1998
                    -----------------------------------

                                                         Year
Name                   Age        Position          First Director
- ----                   ---        --------          --------------
Arnell J. Galley       40         Secretary              1988
Peter A. Guglielmi     53         Director               1995



                                      -35-
<PAGE>

                 Class III Nominee - Terms Expiring at the
                   Annual Shareholders Meeting in 1999
                   -----------------------------------

                                                        Year
Name                   Age        Position          First Director
- ----                   ---        --------          --------------
Thomas C. Galley       40         President              1988

     If Proposal Three is approved by the Shareholders and the Transaction
described therein is closed, the Board of Directors will amend the Bylaws to fix
the number of directors at eight (8) directors and the Board of Directors will
elect John M. Couzens, Robert L. Smith and Craig D. Slater, as designees of
Group, to fill the three vacancies created thereby.  The Company currently
expects that Craig D. Slater would be classified as a Class I Director, Robert
L. Smith as a Class II Director and John M. Couzens as a Class III Director.

                        COMPANY'S RELATIONSHIP WITH
                 INDEPENDENT CERTIFIED PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS

     It is expected that a representative of Hein + Associates LLP, Denver, 
Colorado, the Company's independent certified public accountants, will be 
present at the Special Meeting to respond to appropriate questions and to 
make a statement if he so desires.  The Company intends to select Hein + 
Associates LLP as its independent certified public accountants to perform an 
audit of the accounts of the Company for the fiscal year ending January 31, 
1997.

                        FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     A copy of the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-KSB for the fiscal year 
ended January 31, 1996, including Audited Financial Statements, and the 
Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-QSB for the quarter ended April 30, 
1996, are attached hereto as Appendixes E and F, respectively.  Information 
as to the Company's business, property, legal proceedings, supplementary 
financial information, management's discussion and analysis of financial 
condition and results of operations are contained in Appendixes E and F.

     Audited and Unaudited Financial Statements of Interwest and its 
subsidiaries and Pro Forma Financial Information with respect to the 
Transaction are attached to this Proxy Statement as Appendix D.

                             OTHER MATTERS

     Management does not know of any other matters to be brought before the
meeting.  However, if any other matters properly come before the meeting, it is
the intention of the appointees named in the enclosed form of proxy to vote in
accordance with their best judgment on such matters.

                         SHAREHOLDER PROPOSALS

     Any shareholder proposing to have any appropriate matter brought before the
1997 Annual Meeting of Shareholders must submit such proposal in accordance with
the proxy rules of the Commission.  Such proposals should be sent to the
Secretary of the Company not later than February 1, 1997 to be considered for
inclusion in the 1997 Proxy Statement.


                                       -36-

<PAGE>


                               By Order of the Board of Directors:

                               INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION




Date: June 28, 1996            Thomas C. Galley,
                               Chairman of the Board of Directors








                                      -37-
<PAGE>

                                                                APPENDIX A


                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                          1995 STOCK OPTION PLAN FOR
                            NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTORS


1.   PURPOSE OF THE PLAN.

     The purpose of the 1995 Stock Option Plan for Corporate Non-Employee
Directors ("Plan") is to advance the interests of INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS
CORPORATION ("the Corporation") by encouraging and facilitating the acquisition
of a larger personal financial interest in the Corporation by non-employee
corporate directors upon whose judgment and interest the Corporation is heavily
dependent for the successful conduct of its operation.  It is anticipated that
the Plan will encourage such directors to continue to serve as directors and
officers of the Corporation and that the opportunity to obtain such a financial
interest will prove attractive to potential new directors and will assist the
Corporation in attracting such individuals to serve in that capacity.


2.   DEFINITIONS.

     A.   "1934 Act" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.

     B.   "Board" means the Board of Directors of Internet Communications
Corporation, a Colorado corporation.

     C.   "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

     D.   "Common Stock" or "Stock" means the common stock of the Corporation,
no par value per share.

     E.   "Corporation" means Internet Communications Corporation, a Colorado
corporation.

     F.   "Fair Market Value" means an amount equal to the closing price on the
applicable date for sales of shares of Common Stock made and reported through
the National Market System of the National Association of Securities Dealers,
Inc. or such national stock exchange on which the Stock may then be listed and
which constitutes the principal market for the Stock, or, if no sales of Stock
shall have been reported with respect to that date, on the next preceding date
with respect to which sales are reported.

     G.   "Grant Date" means the date on which any Option shall be duly granted
under Article 5 hereof.

     H.   "Grantee" means an individual who has been granted an Option.


<PAGE>

     I.   "Non-Employee Director" means any member of the Board who is not an
officer or full-time employee of the Corporation or any of its subsidiaries.

     J.   "Option" means an option granted under the Plan to purchase shares of
Common Stock.

     K.   "Option Agreement" means the agreement between the Corporation and the
Grantee evidencing the Option granted under the plan and specifying the terms
and conditions of such Option.

     L.   "Rule 16b-3" means Rule 16b-3 or any successor rule or rules
applicable to Options granted under the Plan promulgated by the Securities and
Exchange Commission under Section 16(b) of the 1934 Act.


3.   SHARES SUBJECT TO OPTION.

     Subject to adjustment as provided in Article 12, the number of shares of
Common Stock of the Corporation which may be sold upon the exercise of Options
granted under the Plan, and accordingly the number of shares for which Options
may be granted, shall not exceed 40,000 shares.  Such number of authorized but
unissued shares shall be reserved for this purpose.  The aggregate number of
shares of Common Stock available under the Plan shall be subject to  adjustment
as set forth in Article 12 hereunder.  Shares sold upon the exercise of Options
granted under the Plan may come from  authorized but unissued shares.  If any
unexercised Option for any reason terminates or expires in whole or in part
prior to the termination of the Plan, the unpurchased shares subject thereto
shall become available for the granting of other Options under the Plan.  Any
stock issued as the result of the exercise of the options shall be registered
pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933 at the Corporation's expense.


4.   ADMINISTRATION OF THE PLAN.

     The Plan shall be generally administered by the Board.  Any action of the
Board with respect to the administration of the Plan shall be taken pursuant to
a majority vote or by the written consent of all of its members.

     The Board shall have full authority to interpret the Plan, to determine the
terms and provisions of Option Agreements, to require withholding from or
payment in cash by a Grantee of any federal, state or local taxes and to make
such rules and regulations and establish such procedures as it deems appropriate
for the administration of the Plan.




                                      2


<PAGE>

     All decisions made by the Board in the matters referred to in this Article
4 shall be conclusive and binding.  No member of the Board shall be liable for
any action or determination made in good faith with respect to the Plan or any
Option granted thereunder.


5.   GRANT OF OPTIONS.

          A.   An Option under which a total of 10,000 shares of Common Stock
     shall be automatically granted to each Non-Employee Director upon the date
     of his or her election to the Board, subject to the following vesting
     schedule:
     
                                   EXERCISABLE
          YEARS AFTER              PERCENTAGE
          GRANT DATE                OF SHARES 
          ----------               ----------

          One Year                  33 1/3%
          Two Years                 66 2/3%
          Three Years               100.00%

          B.   On each annual anniversary of the day on which the Non-Employee
     Director was elected to the Board, such Non-Employee Director shall be
     granted an immediately invested option to purchase 2000 shares of Common
     Stock, provided he or she continues to serve as a Non-Employee Director as
     of such anniversary date.
     
          C.   Options shall be automatically granted under the Plan in the
     aforesaid amounts and on said dates without further action or authorization
     by the Corporation or Board.


6.   OPTION AGREEMENTS.

     The officers of the Corporation are authorized and directed, upon receipt
of notice from the Board of the granting of an Option, to sign and deliver on
behalf of the Corporation, by mail or otherwise, to the Grantee an Option upon
the terms and conditions specified under the Plan and in the form of an Option
Agreement.  The Option Agreement shall be dated and signed by an officer of the
Corporation as of the date of approval of the granting of an Option by the
Board.  If the Grantee fails to sign and return the Option Agreement, by
delivery or by mailing, within thirty (30) days after the date of its delivery
or mailing to him, the Option grant shall be deemed withdrawn.



                                      3


<PAGE>


7.   OPTION PRICE.

     The purchase price of each share of Common Stock covered by each Option
shall be not less than the Fair Market Value per share of such Stock on the
Grant Date.


8.   NON-TRANSFERABILITY OF OPTIONS.

     Any Option granted hereunder shall, by its terms, be non-transferable by a
Grantee other than by will or the laws of descent and shall be exercisable
during the Grantee's lifetime solely by the Grantee or the grantee's duly
appointed guardian or personal representative.


9.   EXERCISE AND TERM OF OPTION. 

     Each Option described above shall be exercisable in full upon the earlier
to occur of  (a) the date on which it becomes vested pursuant to Article 5, or
(b) the death, disability (as defined in Section 22(e)(3) of the Code) or
termination of directorship.

     No Option may be exercised if in the determination of the Board the
issuance or sale of Stock or payment of cash by the Corporation, as appropriate,
pursuant to such exercise shall for any reason be unlawful or fail to comply
with any requirements of any national securities exchange on which the Stock is
then listed or any other regulatory body having jurisdiction with respect
thereto.  Further, no Option may be exercised after the expiration of ten (10)
years from the Grant Date.  In no event shall the Corporation be required to
issue fractional shares upon the exercise of an Option.


10.  METHOD OF EXERCISE.

     To the extent that the right to purchase shares pursuant to an Option has
accrued hereunder, such Option shall be exercised as provided in this Article
10.  An Option may be exercised from time to time by written notice to the
Corporation setting the number of shares being purchased and accompanied by the
payment in full of the Option price for such shares.  Such payment shall be made
in cash, outstanding shares of the Common Stock or in combinations thereof.  If
shares of Common Stock are used in part or full payment for the shares to be
acquired upon exercise of the Option, such shares shall be valued for the
purpose of such exchange as of the date of exercise of the Option at the Fair
Market Value of the shares.  Any certificates evidencing shares of Common Stock
used to pay the Option price shall be accompanied by stock powers duly endorsed
in blank by the registered holder of the certificate (with signatures thereon
guaranteed).  In the event the certificates tendered by the Grantee in such
payment cover more shares than are required for such payment, the certificate
shall also be accompanied by instructions from the Grantee to the 



                                      4


<PAGE>

Corporation's transfer agent with regard to the disposition of the balance of 
the shares covered thereby.

11.  EFFECT OF TERMINATION OF DIRECTORSHIP, DISABILITY OR DEATH.

     In the event a Grantee ceases to be a director of the Corporation for any
reason prior to the occurrence of a Change in Control (as described in Article
12), any Option or unexercised portion thereof granted under this Plan may be
exercised, to the extent such Option would have been exercisable by the Grantee
hereunder on the date on which the Grantee ceased to be a director, within three
(3) months of such date, but in no event later than the date of expiration of
the term of the Option.  In the event a Grantee ceases to be a director of the
Corporation for any reason following the occurrence of a Change in Control (as
described in Article 12), any Option or unexercised portion thereof granted
under this Plan may be exercised, to the extent such Option would have been
exercisable by the Grantee hereunder on the date on which the Grantee ceased to
be a director, within seven (7) months of such date, but in no event later than
the date of expiration of the term of the Option.  In the event of the death or
disability (as defined in Section 22(e)(3) of the Code) of the Grantee while a
director of the Corporation or within not more than three (3) months after the
date on which the Grantee ceases to be a director, any Option or unexercised
portion thereof may be exercised, to the extent exercisable at the date of such
death or disability, by the Grantee's personal representatives, heirs or
legatees at any time prior to one (1) year after the date on which the Grantee
ceased to be a director, but in no event later than the date of the expiration
of the term of the Option.


12.  EFFECT OF CHANGE IN STOCK SUBJECT TO PLAN.

     Except as provided below, the Board shall make equitable adjustments in the
number and class  of shares of stock subject to the Plan, and to the Option
rights granted hereunder and the exercise prices of such Option rights, in the
event of a stock dividend, stock split, reverse stock split, recapitalization,
reorganization, merger, consolidation, acquisition, separation or other change
in the capital structure of the Corporation.  Upon the occasion of a liquidation
of the Corporation, or a merger, reorganization or consolidation of the
Corporation in which the Corporation is not the surviving corporation (other
than a merger, reorganization or consolidation of the Corporation with or into a
corporation or corporations owned directly or indirectly by the stockholders of
the Corporation in substantially the same proportions as their ownership of
stock of the Corporation), each Grantee shall have the right immediately prior
to such liquidation, merger, recapitalization or consolidation of the
Corporation to exercise the Grantee's Options in whole or in part. 
Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Article 12, in the event a
Change in Control (as described below) shall occur, each Grantee shall have the
right to exercise his Options in whole or in part.



                                      5


<PAGE>

     For purposes of this Article 12, a "Change in Control" shall be deemed to
occur when and only when the first of the following events occurs:

          A.   any person becomes the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly,
     of securities of the Corporation representing twenty percent (20%) or more
     of the combined voting power of the Corporation's then outstanding voting
     securities and a majority of the Incumbent Board does not approve the
     acquisition before the acquisition occurs; or
     
          B.   members of the Incumbent Board cease to constitute a majority of
     the Board of Directors.
     
Notwithstanding the foregoing, a Change in Control shall not be deemed to have
occurred pursuant to paragraph A. above solely because twenty percent (20%) or
more of the combined voting power of the Corporation's then outstanding
securities is acquired by  (i) one or more employee benefit plans maintained by
the Corporation or any of its subsidiaries, or (ii) any person who, as of the
Effective Date of this Plan, was a beneficial owner of ten percent (10%) or more
of the combined voting power of the Corporation's outstanding securities as of
such Effective Date.  The terms "person" and "beneficial owner" shall have the
same meaning ascribed to such terms in Section 3(a) and 13(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and regulations promulgated thereunder; and
"Incumbent Board" shall mean  (i) the members of the Board on the Effective Date
of this Plan and (ii) any individual who becomes a member of the Board after
such Effective Date, if his or her election or nomination for election as a
director was approved by the affirmative vote of a majority of the then
Incumbent Board.


13.  STOCKHOLDER RIGHTS.

     Grantee shall not, by reason of any Options granted hereunder, have any
rights of a stockholder of the Corporation, except with respect to shares issued
pursuant to the exercise of an Option.



                                      6


<PAGE>

14.  ADDITIONAL RESTRICTIONS.

     Options shall not be exercisable for six (6) months after the Grant Date
unless  (i) the Grantee dies or becomes disabled within such six-month period;
or (ii) in the opinion of counsel for the Corporation, such requirement is
unnecessary to exempt the grant of the Option and the acquisition of Common
Stock upon exercise from Section 16(b) of the 1934 Act.


15.  CONTROLLING LAW.

     The corporate law of the State of Colorado shall govern all issues
concerning the relative rights of the Corporation and the Grantees with respect
to Options granted and Stock issuable under the Plan.  The law of the State of
Colorado, except its law with respect to choice of law, shall be controlling in
all other matters relating to the Plan.


16.  INDEMNIFICATION.

     In addition to such other rights of indemnification as they may have as
members of the Board or as directors or officers generally, the members of the
Board administering the Plan and the members of the Board shall be indemnified
by the Corporation against the reasonable expenses, including attorneys fees
actually and necessarily incurred in connection with the defense of any action,
suit or proceeding, or in connection with any appeal therein, to which they or
any of them may be a party by reason of any action taken or failure to act under
or in connection with the Plan or any Option granted thereunder, and against all
amounts paid by them in settlement thereof (provided such settlement is approved
by independent legal counsel selected by the Corporation) or paid by them in
satisfaction of a judgment in any such action, suit or proceeding, except in
relation to matters as to which it shall be adjudged in such action, suit or
proceeding that such member acted in bad faith in the performance of his or her
duties; provided that within twenty (20) days after institution of any such
action, suit or proceeding, the member shall in writing offer the Corporation
the opportunity, at its own expense, to handle and defend the same.


17.  USE OF PROCEEDS.

     The proceeds from the sale of shares of Common Stock pursuant to Options
granted under the Plan shall constitute general funds of the Corporation.



                                      7


<PAGE>

18.  EFFECTIVE DATE OF PLAN.

     The Plan is effective July 24, 1995, ("Effective Date"), the date it was
originally adopted by the Board of Directors of the Corporation, subject to
approval by shareholders of the Corporation within twelve (12) months of said
date.  Neither the Plan nor any option granted under the Plan shall become
binding until the Plan has been so approved.


19.  AMENDMENT OR TERMINATION OF THE PLAN.

     The Board may from time to time amend the Plan as it shall deem advisable
but not more than once every six months except to comport to changes in the Code
or rules and regulations promulgated thereunder; and, provided further, that
except as provided in Article 12 hereof, no amendment shall, without such
approval thereof by the stockholders of the Corporation as may then be required
by Rule 16b-3, any national securities exchange or system on which the Stock is
then listed or reported, or any regulatory body having jurisdiction with respect
thereto, have the result of:

          (a)  increasing the number of shares of Common Stock reserved for
     Options that may be granted under this Plan;
     
          (b)  changing the manner of determining the Option exercise price;
     
          (c)  increasing the maximum term of the Options provided for herein;
     
          (d)  changing the class of persons eligible to receive Options under
     this Plan; or
     
          (e)  materially increasing in any other fashion the benefits accruing
     to Grantees under the Plan.

     The Plan shall terminate at such time as the Board may determine.

     No amendment or termination of the Plan or any provision hereof shall,
without the written consent of the Grantee, adversely affect any Option
theretofore granted to such Grantee under the Plan.



                                      8


<PAGE>


                                                                  APPENDIX B
                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                              1996 INCENTIVE STOCK PLAN


    1.   PURPOSE OF PLAN.  This Incentive Stock Plan is intended to encourage
ownership of shares of Internet Communications Corporation (the "Corporation")
by key Employees and Consultants of the Corporation, thereby providing
additional incentive for such Employees and Consultants to promote the success
of the business.  Options granted hereunder may be either Incentive Stock
Options or Nonstatutory Stock Options, at the discretion of the Board and as
reflected in the terms of the written option agreement.  The Board also has the
discretion to grant Stock Purchase Rights, or to issue stock to Employees in
consideration of past services.

    2.   DEFINITIONS.  As used herein, the following definitions shall apply:

         (a)  "BOARD" shall mean the Committee, if one has been appointed, or
the Board of Directors of the Corporation, if no Committee is appointed.

         (b)  "CODE" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

         (c)  "CORPORATION" shall mean Internet Communications Corporation, a
Colorado Corporation.

         (d)  "COMMITTEE" shall mean the Committee appointed by the Board of
Directors in accordance with Section 4 of the Plan, if one is appointed.

         (e)  "CONSULTANT" shall mean any person, including directors,
performing services for the benefit of the Corporation as an independent
consultant or advisor.

         (f)  "CONTINUOUS STATUS AS AN EMPLOYEE OR A CONSULTANT" shall mean the
absence of any interruption or termination of service as an Employee or a
Consultant, as applicable.  Continuous Status as an Employee shall not be
considered interrupted in the case of sick leave, military leave, leave of
absence or sabbatical, the "loan" of the Employee or Consultant to another
business or agency, or any other leave of absence approved by the Board.

         (g)  "EMPLOYEE" shall mean any person employed by the Company or any
Parent or Subsidiary of the Corporation in a management position or in a
position requiring specialized training or expertise.  The payment of a
director's fee by the Corporation shall not be sufficient to constitute
"employment" by the Corporation.

         (h)  "INCENTIVE STOCK OPTION" shall mean an Option intended to qualify
as an incentive stock option within the meaning of Section 422 of  the Code.


<PAGE>


         (i)  "NONSTATUTORY STOCK OPTION" shall mean an Option not intended to
qualify as an Incentive Stock Option.

         (j)  "OPTION" shall mean a stock option granted pursuant to the Plan.

         (k)  "OPTIONED STOCK" shall mean the Stock subject to an Option.

         (l)  "OPTIONEE" shall mean an Employee or Consultant who receives an
Option.

         (m)  "PARENT" shall mean a "parent corporation," whether now or
hereafter existing, as  defined in Section 425(e) of the Code.

         (n)  "PLAN" shall mean this Incentive Stock Plan.

         (o)  "PURCHASER" shall mean an Employee or Consultant who exercises a
Stock Purchase Right.

         (p)  "SHARE" shall mean a share of the Stock, as adjusted in
accordance with Section 11 of the Plan.

         (q)  "STOCK" shall mean the Common Stock of the Corporation.

         (r)  "STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT" shall mean the written agreement setting
forth the grant of an Option and terms and conditions relating thereto (which
need not be the same for each Option), in the form attached hereto or such other
form as the Board in its discretion may approve.

         (s)  "STOCK PURCHASE AGREEMENT" shall mean a written agreement (which
need not be the same for each Stock Purchase Right) setting forth the terms and
conditions relating to the purchase of Stock under a Stock Purchase Right, in
such form as the Board in its discretion may approve.

         (t)  "STOCK PURCHASE RIGHT" shall mean a purchase of Stock pursuant to
the Plan.

         (u)  "SUBSIDIARY" shall mean a "subsidiary corporation," whether now
or hereafter existing, as defined in Section 425(f) of the Code.

    3.   SHARES SUBJECT TO PLAN.  There will be reserved for use from time to
time under the Plan, an aggregate of 500,000 shares of Stock of no par value of
the Corporation.  As the Board of Directors of the Corporation shall from time
to time determine, the Shares may be in whole or in part authorized but unissued
Shares or issued Shares which shall have been reacquired by the Corporation.  If
an Option should expire or become unexercisable for any reason without having
been exercised in full, or if any shares of Stock are repurchased by or
forfeited to the Corporation, the unpurchased,

<PAGE>

repurchased, or forfeited Shares which were subject thereto shall become
available for future grant or sale under the Plan unless the Plan shall have
been terminated.

    4.   ADMINISTRATION OF PLAN.

         (a)  COMMITTEE.  The Plan shall be administered by the Board of
Directors of the Corporation; provided that the Board of Directors may appoint a
Committee, which shall consist of not less than three (3) members of the Board
of Directors.  The Board of Directors may from time to time appoint members of
the Committee in substitution for or in addition to members previously appointed
and may fill vacancies, however caused, in the Committee.  The Committee shall
select one of its members as its chairman and shall hold its meetings at such
times and places as it shall deem advisable.  A majority of its members shall
constitute a quorum.  All action of the Committee shall be taken by a majority
of its members.  Any action may be taken by a written instrument signed by a
majority of the members and action so taken shall be fully as effective as if it
had been taken by a vote held.  The Committee may appoint a secretary, shall
keep minutes of its meetings, and shall make such rules and regulations for the
conduct of its obligation to the Corporation, its shareholders, and its option
holders, the Committee's interpretation and construction of any of the
provisions of this Plan, or of any rules promulgated under this Plan, shall be
final and binding on all Optionees, Purchasers, and any other holders of any
Options or Stock Purchase Rights granted under the Plan, unless overturned by
the Board of Directors.  No member of the Committee shall be liable for any
action or determination made in good faith in connection with this Plan.

         (b)  INTERESTED DIRECTORS.  Members of the Board who are either
eligible for Options or have been granted Options may vote on any matters
affecting the administration of the Plan or the grant of any Options pursuant to
the Plan, except that no such member shall act upon the granting of an Option to
himself or herself, but any such member may be counted in determining the
existence of a quorum at any meeting of the Board or Committee during which
action is taken with respect to the granting of Options to said Board or
Committee member.

         (c)  POWER OF THE BOARD.  Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the
Board shall have the authority, in its discretion:  (i)  to grant Incentive
Stock Options, Nonstatutory Stock Options or Stock Purchase Rights;  (ii)  to
determine, upon review of relevant information and in accordance with Section 6
of the Plan, the fair market value of the Stock;  (iii)  to determine the
exercise price per share of Options, or Stock Purchase Rights to be granted,
which exercise price shall be determined in accordance with Section 6 of the
Plan;  (iv)  to determine the Employees and Consultants to whom, and the time or
times at which, Options or Stock Purchase Rights shall be granted and the number
of shares to be represented by each Option or Stock Purchase Right;  (v)  to
interpret the Plan;  (vi)  to prescribe, amend, and rescind rules and
regulations relating to the Plan;  (vii)  to determine the terms and provisions
of each Option or Stock Purchase Right granted (which need not be the same for
each Option or Stock Purchase

<PAGE>

Right granted) and, with the consent of the holder thereof, modify, terminate or
amend each Option or Stock Purchase Right;  (viii)  to accelerate or defer (with
the consent of the Optionee) the exercise date of any Option;  (ix)  to
authorize any person to execute on behalf of the company any instrument required
to effectuate the grant of an Option or Stock Purchase Right previously granted
by the Board; and (x)  to make all other determinations deemed necessary or
advisable for the administration of the Plan.

    5.   ELIGIBILITY.

         (a)  GENERALLY.  Options and Stock Purchase Rights may be granted to
Employees and Consultants, provided that Incentive Stock Options may only be
granted to Employees.  An Employee or Consultant who has been granted an Option
or Stock Purchase Right may, if he is otherwise eligible, be granted additional
Options or Stock Purchase Rights.

         (b)  CRITERIA.  In making any determination as to Employees and
Consultants to whom Options and Stock Purchase Rights shall be granted, the
Committee shall take into account such factors as it shall deem relevant in
accomplishing the purpose of the Plan, including but not limited to the
Employee's or Consultant's loyalty, performance, and experience.

         (c)  ISO LIMITATIONS WITH RESPECT TO PRICE.  In no event shall an
Incentive Stock Option be grained to any person who, at the time such Option is
granted, owns (as defined in Section 422A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954)
shares possessing more than 10% of the total combined voting power of all
classes of shares of the Corporation or of its parent or subsidiary corporation,
unless the option price is at least 110% of the fair market value of the stock
subject to the Option.

         (d)  ISO LIMITATIONS WITH RESPECT TO SHARES.  Moreover, the aggregate
fair market value (determined as of the time that option is granted) of the
Shares with respect to which Incentive Stock Options are exercisable for the
first time by any individual Employee  during any single Calendar Year under
this Plan and all the incentive stock option plans of the Corporation (and its
parent and subsidiary corporations, if any), shall not exceed $100,000.

         (e)  NO EMPLOYEE CONTRACT.  The Plan shall not confer upon any
Optionee or holder of a Stock Purchase Right any right with respect to
continuation of employment by or the rendition of consulting services to the
Corporation, nor shall it interfere in any way with his right or the
Corporation's right to terminate his employment or services at any time.

    6.   PRICES.

         (a)  GENERALLY.   The per share exercise price for the Shares to be
issued pursuant to exercise of an Option or Stock Purchase Right shall be such
price as is

<PAGE>

determined by the Board.  However, the exercise price of the Shares which shall
be covered by each Incentive Stock Option shall be at least 100% of the fair
market value of the Shares at the time of granting the Incentive Stock Option.
For purposes hereof, fair market value means an amount equal to the closing
price on the applicable date for shares of Common Stock made and reported
through the National Market System of the National Association of Securities
Dealers, Inc., or such national stock exchange on which the Stock  may then be
listed and which constitutes the principal market for the Stock, or, if no sales
of the  Stock shall have been reported with respect to that date, on the next
preceding date with respect to which sales are reported. If, however, the stock
is not publicly traded at time of grant of an Incentive Stock Option, the fair
market value at date of grant shall be established by the Board, in good faith,
based on such information as it shall deem necessary.

         (b)  PAYMENT.  The consideration to be paid for the Shares to be
issued upon exercise of an Option, or Stock Purchase Right, including the method
of payment, shall be determined by the Board and may consist entirely of cash,
check, or other Shares of Stock of the Corporation having a fair market value on
the date of surrender equal to the aggregate exercise price of the Shares as to
which said Option or Stock Purchase Right shall be exercised, or any combination
of such methods of payment, or such other consideration and method  of payment
for the issuance of Shares to the extent permitted under applicable law;
provided however, no Optionee shall be entitled to pay for Shares to be issued
upon exercise of an Incentive Stock Option by exchanging shares of the
Corporation which were previously acquired as "statutory option stock," as that
term is identified in Section 425 of the Code, until the applicable holding
period, as prescribed by the Code, has been satisfied.  In addition, the
Corporation may accept a promissory note issued by a Purchaser in exercise of a
Stock Purchase Right; provided that such note shall not be considered payment
for the Shares and no Share Certificate shall issue until the note is paid in
full.  In making its determination as to the type of consideration to accept,
the Board shall consider if acceptance of such consideration may be reasonably
expected to benefit the Corporation.

    7.   OPTIONS.

         (a)  GENERALLY.  Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Board
shall determine for each Option (which need not be identical) the number of
shares for which the Option shall be granted, the Option price of the Option,
and all other terms and conditions of the Option.

         (b)  TERM OF OPTION.  The term of each Option may be up to ten (10)
years from the date of grant thereof or such shorter term as may be provided in
the Stock Option Agreement.

<PAGE>



         (c)  EXERCISE OF OPTION.

              (i) Any Option granted hereunder shall be exercisable at such
times and under  such conditions as determined by the Board, including
performance criteria with respect to the Corporation or the Optionee, or both,
and as shall be permissible under the terms of the Plan.

              (ii)  An Option may not be exercised for a fraction of a Share.

              (iii)  An Option shall be deemed to be exercised when written
notice of such exercise has been given to the Corporation in accordance with the
terms of the Option by the person entitled to exercise the Option and full
payment for the Shares with respect to which the Option is exercised has been
received by the Corporation.  Full payment may, as authorized by the Board,
consist of any consideration and method of payment allowable under Section 6 of
the Plan.  Until the issuance (as evidenced by the appropriate entry on the
books of the Corporation or of a duly authorized transfer agent of the
Corporation) of the stock certificate evidencing such Shares, no right to vote
or receive dividends or any other rights of a shareholder shall exist with
respect to the Optioned Stock, notwithstanding the exercise of the Option.  No
adjustment will be made for a dividend or other right for which the record date
is prior to the date the stock certificate is issued, except as provided in
Section 11 of the Plan.

              (iv)  Exercise of an Option in any manner shall result in a
decrease in the number of Shares which thereafter may be available, both for
purposes of the Plan and for sales under the Option, by the number of Shares as
to which the Option is exercised.

              (v)  Except as otherwise specifically provided herein, an Option
may not be exercised at any time unless the holder thereof shall have maintained
Continuous Status as an Employee or Consultant of the Corporation or of one or
more of its subsidiaries, or a parent corporation, from the date of the granting
of the Option to the date of its exercise.

         (d)  TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT.  In the event that the employment of
an Employee or the engagement of a Consultant to whom an Option shall have been
granted shall be terminated other than by reason of death or disability, such
Option may be exercised (to the extent that the Employee or Consultant shall
have been entitled to do so at the termination of his employment or consultancy)
at any time within three (3) months after such termination, but in any event no
later than the date of expiration of the Option term.  So long as the holder of
an Option shall maintain Continuous Status as an Employee or Consultant of the
Corporation or one or more of its subsidiaries, his Option shall not be affected
by any change of duties or position.  To the extent that the holder of an Option
was not entitled to exercise his Option at the time of his termination, or
insofar as he does not exercise such Option to the extent he was entitled


<PAGE>

within the time specified herein, the Option shall itself terminate at the time
of such termination.

         (e)  DISABILITY OF OPTIONEE.  Notwithstanding the provisions of
Section 7(d) above, in the event an Employee or Consultant is unable to continue
his employment with or to perform services for the benefit of the Company as a
result of his total and permanent disability (as defined in Section 22(e)(3) of
the Code), he may, but only within six (6) months after termination due to such
disability (or such other period set forth in his Option Agreement) exercise his
Option to the extent he was entitled to exercise it at the date of such
disability.  To the extent that he was not entitled to exercise the Option at
the date of disability, or insofar as he does not exercise such Option to the
extent he was entitled within the time specified herein, the Option shall
terminate.  The Option may be exercised in the event of such disability by any
parent, sibling, spouse or issue of the Employee or Consultant, or by any other
person the Corporation reasonably believes to have the authority to exercise
such Option on the Employee's or Consultant's behalf.

         (f)  DEATH OF OPTIONEE.  Unless otherwise set forth in the Option
Agreement, in the event  of  the death of an Optionee:

              (1)  if Optionee dies during the term of the Option and is at the
time of his death an Employee or Consultant of the Corporation who shall have
been in Continuous Status as an Employee or Consultant since the date of grant
of the Option, the Option may be exercised, at any time within six (6) months
following the date of death (or such other period set forth in his Option
Agreement), by the Optionee's estate or by a person who acquired the right to
exercise the Option by bequest or inheritance, but only to the extent of the
right to exercise that would have accrued had the Optionee continued living and
remained in Continuous Status as an Employee or Consultant six (6) months after
the date of death (or such greater extent as set forth in Employee's stock
Restriction Agreement); or

              (2)  if Optionee dies within three (3) months after the
termination of Continuous Status as an employee or Consultant, the Option may be
exercised, at any time within six (6) months following the date of death, by the
Optionee's estate or by a person who acquired the right to exercise the Option
by bequest or inheritance, but only to the extent of the right to exercise that
had accrued at the date of such termination.

    8.   STOCK PURCHASE RIGHTS.

         (a)  RIGHTS TO PURCHASE.  After the Board determines that it will
offer an Employee or Consultant the right to purchase Shares (other than
pursuant to an Option) under the Plan, it shall advise the offer in writing of
the terms, conditions, and restrictions relating to the offer, including the
number of Shares which such person shall be entitled to purchase, the proposed
Stock Purchase Agreement, and the time


<PAGE>

within which such person must accept such offer, which shall in no event exceed
nine (9) months from the date upon which the Board of Directors or its Committee
made the determination to grant the Stock Purchase Right.  The offer may be
accepted by execution of the Stock Purchase Agreement and its return to the
Corporation (together with payment for the Stock being purchased)  within the
time specified.

         (b)  ISSUANCE OF SHARES.  Forthwith after payment therefor, the Shares
purchased shall be duly issued; provided, however, that the Board may require
that the Purchaser make adequate provision for any Federal and State withholding
obligations of the Corporation as a condition to the Purchaser purchasing such
Shares.

         (c)  OTHER PROVISIONS.  The Stock Purchase Agreement shall contain
such other terms, provisions, and conditions not inconsistent with the Plan as
may be determined by the Board.

    9.   NON-TRANSFERABILITY OF OPTIONS AND STOCK PURCHASE RIGHTS.  The Options
and Stock Purchase Rights may not be sold, pledged, assigned, hypothecated,
transferred, or disposed of in any manner other than by will or by the laws of
descent or distribution and may be exercised, during the lifetime of the
Optionee or Purchaser, only by the Optionee or Purchaser.

    10.  ADJUSTMENTS UPON CHANGES IN CAPITALIZATION.  Subject to any required
action by the shareholders of the Company, the number of shares of Stock covered
by each outstanding Option and Stock Purchase Right, and the number of shares of
Stock which have been authorized for issuance under the Plan but as to which no
Options or Stock Purchase Rights have yet been granted or which have been
returned to the Plan upon cancellation or expiration of an Option or Stock
Purchase Right, or repurchase of Shares from a Purchaser upon termination of
Employment, as well as the price per share of  Stock covered by each such
outstanding Option or Stock Purchase Right, shall be proportionately adjusted
for any increase or decrease in the number of issued shares of Stock resulting
from a stock split, the payment of a stock dividend with respect to the Stock,
or any other increase or decrease in the number of issued shares of Stock
effected without receipt of consideration by the Company; provided, however,
that conversion of any convertible securities of the Company shall not be deemed
to have been "effected without receipt of consideration."  Such adjustment shall
be made by the Board, whose determination in that respect shall be final,
binding, and conclusive.  Except as expressly provided herein, no issuance by
the Company of shares of stock of any class, or securities convertible into
shares of stock of any class, shall affect, and no adjustment by reason thereof
shall be made with respect to, the number or price of shares of Stock subject to
an Option or Stock Purchase Right.

    11. ACCELERATION AND VESTING OF OPTIONS.   In the event the Corporation
consummates a transaction in which 50% of the outstanding shares of the
Corporation are acquired or the assets of the Corporation are acquired,
immediately prior to the


<PAGE>

consummation of such transaction, options and stock purchase rights granted
under this plan become fully vested and immediately exercisable.

    12.  EFFECTIVENESS OF PLAN.  The Plan shall become effective on such date
as the Board of Directors shall determine, but only after the shareholders of
the Corporation shall, by the affirmative vote of a majority in interest of all
the shares of the Corporation taken within twelve (12) months after the date the
Plan is adopted, have approved the Plan.

    13.  TIME OF GRANTING OPTIONS.  Neither anything contained in the Plan or
in any resolution adopted or to be adopted by the Board of Directors or the
stockholders of the Corporation nor any action taken by the Committee shall
constitute the granting of any Option.  The granting of an Option shall take
place only when a written Stock Option Agreement shall have been duly executed
and delivered by or on behalf of the Corporation and the person to whom such
Option shall be granted.

    14.  TERMINATION AND AMENDMENT OF PLAN.  The Plan shall terminate on July
1, 2005, and no Option or Stock Purchase Right shall be granted under the Plan
after that date.  The Board of Directors may at any time and from time to time
modify or amend the Plan (including the form of Stock Option Agreement or Stock
Purchase Agreement)  in such respects as it shall deem advisable, including
increasing the aggregate number of shares reserved under the plan by an amount
not to exceed 25% (125,000 shares). The Board of Directors  may not make changes
in the class of persons eligible to receive options or rights under the Plan,
including the definitions of "Employee" and "Consultant" without approval by a
majority in interest of all the shares of the Corporation. The termination or
any modification or amendment of the Plan shall not, without the consent of the
employee, affect his rights under an Option theretofore granted to him unless
such amendment is required to enable the Option to qualify as an "Incentive
Stock Option" as defined in Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1954.

    15.  ISSUANCE OF SHARES.

         (a)  Shares shall not be issued pursuant to the exercise of an Option
or Stock Purchase Right unless the exercise of such Option or Stock Purchase
Right and the issuance and delivery of such Shares pursuant thereto shall comply
with all relevant provisions of law, including, without limitation, the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the Exchange Act, the rules and regulations
promulgated thereunder, and the requirements of any stock  exchange upon which
the Shares may then be listed, and shall be further subject to the approval of
counsel for the Corporation with respect to such compliance, which approval
shall not be unreasonably withheld.

         (b)  As a condition to the exercise of an Option or Stock Purchase
Right, the Corporation may impose various conditions, including a requirement
that the person exercising such Option represent and warrant, at the time of any
such exercise, that the


<PAGE>

Shares are being purchased only for investment and without any present intention
to sell or distribute such Shares.

    16.  RESERVATION OF SHARES.  The Corporation, during the term of this Plan,
will at all times reserve and keep available such number of Shares as shall be
sufficient to satisfy the requirements of the Plan.  The inability of the
Corporation to obtain authority from any regulatory body having jurisdiction,
which authority is deemed by the Corporation's counsel to be necessary to the
lawful issuance and sale of any Shares hereunder, shall relieve the Corporation
of any liability in respect to the failure to issue or sell such Shares as to
which such requisites authority shall not have been obtained, provided that such
inability is not directly caused by the Corporation or its agents or cannot be
cured by the Corporation without unreasonable effort or expense.


<PAGE>

                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                           STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT


    THIS OPTION AGREEMENT is made this _______ day of _______________________, 
19____, by and between Internet Communications Corporation, a Colorado 
Corporation (the "Corporation") and ________________________________________ an
employee of the Corporation ("Optionee").

    The Corporation desires, by affording the Optionee an opportunity to
purchase Shares of its Common Stock (the "Shares"), to carry out the purpose of
the Incentive Stock Plan (the "Plan") approved by its shareholders and
directors.  The terms defined in the Plan shall have the same defined meanings
herein.

    1.   GRANT OF OPTION.  The Corporation hereby irrevocably grants to the
Optionee the right and option (the "Option") to purchase all or any part of an
aggregate of _________________________ (__________) Shares (such number being
subject to adjustment as provided in section 12 hereof) on the terms and
conditions herein set forth.

    2.   NATURE OF THE OPTION.  This Option is intended to qualify as an
Incentive Stock Option as defined in Section 422 of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986, as amended (the "Code").

    3.   EXERCISE PRICE.  The purchase price of the Shares covered by the
Option shall be $___________ per share, which purchase price is the fair market
value per share of the Corporation's Common Stock as determined in good faith by
the Corporation's Board of Directors.  The purchase price of the shares shall be
paid in full in cash at the time of exercise.

    4.   TERM OF OPTION.  The term of the Option shall be for a period of ten
(10) years from date hereof, subject to earlier termination as provided in
Sections 10, 11, and 12 hereof.

    5.   LIMIT ON EXERCISE OF OPTION.  The Option shall be immediately
exercisable at any time or from time to time during the term of the Agreement,
as to any part of, or all of, the shares (but not for a fraction of a share)
covered thereby.  Except as provided in paragraphs 10, 11, and 12 hereof, the
Option may not be exercised at any time unless the Optionee shall have
maintained Continuous Status as an Employee of the Corporation or of its Parent
or of one or more of its Subsidiaries, from the date hereof to the date of the
exercise of the Option.  The holder of the Option shall not have any of the
rights of a shareholder with respect to the Shares covered by the Option  except
to the extent that one or more certificates for such Shares shall be delivered
to him upon the due exercise of the Option.


<PAGE>

    6.   METHOD OF EXERCISING OPTION.  Subject to the terms and conditions of
this Option Agreement, the Option may be exercised by written notice to the
Corporation, at its principal office.  Such notice shall be in the form of
Exhibit A attached hereto, shall state the election to exercise the Option and
the number of shares in respect of which it is being exercised, and shall be
signed by the person or persons so exercising the Option.  Such notice shall
either:  (a) be accompanied by payment of the full purchase price of such
shares, in which event the Corporation shall deliver a certificate or
certificates representing such shares as soon as practicable after the notice
shall be received; or (b) fix a date (not less than five (5) nor more than ten
(10) business days from the date such  notice shall be received by the
Corporation) for the payment of the full purchase price of such shares at the
principal office of the Corporation, against delivery of a certificate or
certificates representing such shares.  Payment of such purchase price shall, in
either case, be made by check payable to the order of the Corporation.  The
certificate or certificates for the shares as to which the Option shall have
been so exercised shall be registered in the name of the person or persons so
exercising the Option and shall be delivered as provided above to or upon the
written order of the person or persons exercising the Option.  In the event the
Option shall be exercised, pursuant to Section 11 hereof, by any person or
persons other than the Optionee, such notice shall be accompanied by appropriate
proof of the right of such person or persons to exercise the Option.  All shares
that shall be purchased upon the exercise of the Option as provided herein shall
be fully paid and nonassessable.

    7.   PURCHASE OPTION OF THE COMPANY.  Optionee acknowledges that Optionee
has executed an Employee Stock Restriction Agreement, dated as of the date
hereof and attached hereto as Exhibit B (the "Restriction Agreement").  The
Optionee understands that all purchases of shares pursuant to the exercise, in
whole or in part, of the Option shall be governed by the terms of such
Restriction Agreement even though Optionee will not execute such a Restriction
Agreement each time Optionee exercises the Option.

    8.   NONTRANSFERABILITY.  The Option shall not be transferable otherwise
than by will or the laws of descent and distribution, and the Option may be
exercised, during the lifetime of the Optionee, only by the Optionee.  More
particularly (but without limiting the generality of the foregoing), the Option
may not be assigned, transferred (except as provided above), pledged, or
hypothecated in any way, shall not be assignable by operation of law, and shall
not be subject to execution, attachment, or similar process.  Any attempted
assignment, transfer, pledge, hypothecation, or other disposition of the Option
contrary to the provisions hereof, and the levy of any execution, attachment, or
similar process upon the Option, shall be null and void and without effect.

    9.   DISCLOSURE AND RISK.  The Optionee represents and warrants to the
Corporation as follows:

         (a)  This Option and the Shares will be acquired by the Optionee for
Optionee's own account, for investment and not with a view to, or for resale in
connection with,


<PAGE>

any distribution or public offering thereof within the meaning of the Securities
Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act").

         (b)  The Optionee understands that:  (i) at time of grant and
exercise, the Option and the shares have not been and probably will not have
been registered under the Securities Act by reason of their issuance in a
transaction exempt from the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of
the Securities Act, and that they must be held by the Optionee indefinitely;
(ii) that the Optionee must therefore bear the economic risk of such investment
indefinitely, unless a subsequent disposition thereof is registered under the
Securities Act or is exempt from registration; (iii) that Rule 144, the usual
exemption from registration, is only available after the satisfaction of certain
holding periods and in the presence of a public market for the Shares, that
there is no certainty that a public market for the Shares will exist, and that
otherwise it will be necessary that the Shares be sold pursuant to another
exemption from registration which may be difficult to satisfy.

         (c)  That because of Optionee's position with the Corporation and as a
result of inquires made by Optionee and information furnished to Optionee by the
Cooperation, Optionee has as of the date of grant and will have as of the date
of exercise, reviewed all information necessary to make an informed investment
decision.

         (d)  The Optionee understands that, under certain conditions,
disposition of the Shares  subject to this Option Agreement could result in
adverse tax consequences because of failure to meet prescribed holding period
requirements.  The Optionee understands that, if any of the Shares received
under this Option are disposed of within two (2) years after the date of the
Agreement or within one (1) year after such Shares were transferred to Optionee
upon exercise of the Option, Optionee will be treated for federal income tax
purposes as having received ordinary income at the time of such disposition in
an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value of the Shares at the time
such Shares were delivered to Optionee over the price paid for the Shares.
Optionee hereby agrees to notify the Corporation in writing within thirty (30)
days after the date of any such disposition.

         (e)  That Optionee understands that each certificate representing the
Shares shall be endorsed with the following legend:

                   "THE SHARES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE HAVE NOT BEEN
                   REGISTERED OR QUALIFIED UNDER ANY FEDERAL OR STATE
                   SECURITIES LAWS.  THE SHARES MAY NOT BE OFFERED FOR SALE,
                   SOLD, PLEDGED, OR OTHERWISE TRANSFERRED UNLESS SO REGISTERED
                   OR QUALIFIED, OR UNLESS AN EXEMPTION FROM REGISTRATION OR
                   QUALIFICATION EXISTS.  THE AVAILABILITY OF ANY EXEMPTION
                   FROM REGISTRATION OR QUALIFICATION MUST BE ESTABLISHED BY AN
                   OPINION OF COUNSEL FOR THE

<PAGE>


                   SHAREHOLDER, WHICH OPTION AND COUNSEL MUST BE REASONABLY
                   SATISFACTORY TO THE COMPANY."

The Corporation need not register a transfer of any of the Shares unless one of
the conditions specified in the foregoing legend is satisfied and the
Corporation will not unreasonably withhold consent to registration of such a
transfer.  The Corporation may also instruct its transfer agent not to register
the transfer of any of the Shares unless one of the conditions specified in the
foregoing legend is satisfied.  Any legend endorsed on a certificate pursuant to
the foregoing language and the stop transfer instructions with respect to such
Shares, shall be removed, and the Corporation shall promptly issue a certificate
without such legend to the holder of such Shares, if such Shares are registered
under the Securities Act and a prospectus meeting the requirements of Section 10
of the Securities Act is available or if such holder provides the Corporation
with an opinion of counsel for such holder of the Shares reasonably satisfactory
to the Corporation, to the effect that such legend may be removed and such stop-
transfer instructions may be rescinded.

    10.  TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT.  In the event that the employment of the
Optionee by the Corporation shall be terminated (otherwise than by reason of
death), the Option may be exercised by the Optionee at any time within three (3)
months after such termination, but in any event no later than the date of
expiration of the Option term.  So long as the Optionee shall maintain
Continuous Status as an Employee of the Corporation, its Parent, or one or more
of its Subsidiaries (as defined in the Plan), the Option shall not otherwise be
affected by any change of duties or position.  To the extent that the Optionee
was not entitled to exercise an Option held by the Optionee at the time of
termination of Optionee's employment with the Company, the Option shall itself
terminate at the time of such termination.  Nothing in this Option Agreement
shall confer upon the Optionee any right to continue in the employ of the
Corporation or of its Parent or of any of its Subsidiaries or interfere in any
way with the right of the Corporation or any such Parent or Subsidiary to
terminate Optionee's employment or consultancy at any time.

    11.  DEATH OR DISABILITY OF EMPLOYEE.

         (a)  If the Optionee shall die while employed by the Corporation or
its Parent or one or more  of its Subsidiaries and shall have been in Continuous
Status as an Employee since the date hereof, the Option may be exercised (to the
extend that the Optionee shall have been entitled to do so at the date of
Optionee's death) by a legatee or legatees of the Optionee under Optionee's last
will, or by Optionee's personal representatives or distributees, at any time
within six (6) months after the death of the Optionee, but in any event no later
than the date of expiration of the Option Term.  However, if Optionee dies
within three (3) months after the termination of Continuous Status as an
Employee, the Option may be exercised, at any time within six (6) months
following the date of death, by the Optionee's estate or by a person who
acquired the


<PAGE>

right to exercise the Option by bequest or inheritance, but only to the extent
of the right to exercise that had accrued at the date of termination.

         (b)  Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 10 above, in the event
the Optionee is unable to continue Optionee's employment with or to perform
services for the benefit of the Company as a result of his total and permanent
disability (as defined in Section 22(e)(3) of the Code), Optionee may, but only
within six (6) months after termination due to such disability, exercise
Optionee's Option to the extent Optionee was entitled to exercise it at the date
of such disability.  To the extent that Optionee was not entitled to exercise
the Option at the date of disability, or if Optionee does not exercise such
Option to the extent Optionee was so entitled within the time specified herein,
the Option shall terminate.  The Option may be exercised under this paragraph
(b) by any parent, sibling, spouse, or issue of the Optionee, or by any other
person the Corporation reasonably believes to have the authority to exercise
such Option.

    12.  ADJUSTMENTS UPON CHANGES IN CAPITALIZATION OR MERGER.

         (a)  Subject to any required action by the shareholders of the
Corporation, the number of Shares covered by the Option, as well as the purchase
price per Share covered by the Option, shall be proportionately adjusted for any
increase or decrease in the number of issued shares of Common Stock of the
Corporation resulting from a stock split, the payment of a stock dividend with
respect to the Common Stock, or any other increase or decrease in the number of
issued shares of Common Stock effected without receipt of consideration by the
Corporation; provided however, that conversion of any convertible securities of
the Corporation shall not be deemed to have been "effected without receipt of
consideration."  Such adjustment shall be made by the Board, whose determination
in that respect shall be final, binding, and conclusive.  Except as expressly
provided herein, no issuance by the Company of shares of stock of any class, or
securities convertible into shares of stock of any class shall affect, and no
adjustment by reason thereof shall be made with respect to, the number or price
of Shares subject to the Option.

         (b)  In the event of the proposed dissolution or liquidation of the
Corporation, or in the event of a proposed sale of all or substantially all of
the assets of the Corporation, or the merger of the Corporation with or into
another corporation, the Option granted hereunder will automatically terminate
and be of no further force or effect upon the effective date of such
dissolution, liquidation, sale or merger.  The Corporation shall give reasonable
notice to the Optionee prior to effecting any transactions covered by this
paragraph to give the Employee the opportunity to gain the benefit, if any, from
such a transaction.

    13.  GENERAL.  The Corporation shall at all times during the term of the
Option reserve and keep available such number of shares of Common Stock as will
be sufficient to satisfy the requirements of this Option Agreement, shall pay
all original issue and transfer taxes with respect to the issue and transfer of
shares pursuant hereto


<PAGE>

and all other fees and expenses necessarily incurred by the Corporation in
connection therewith, and will from time to time use its best efforts to comply
with all laws and  regulations which, in the opinion of counsel for the
Corporation, shall be applicable thereto.

    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Corporation has caused this Option Agreement to be
duly executed by its officers thereunto duly authorized, and the Optionee has
executed this Agreement, all as of the day and year first above written.

                   INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                   By:_________________________________________

                   Title:______________________________________



                   ____________________________________________
                   Optionee



<PAGE>

    Optionee acknowledges receipt of a copy of the Plan, a copy of which is
annexed hereto, and represents that Optionee is familiar with the terms and
provisions thereof, and hereby accepts this Option subject to all of the terms
and provisions thereof.  Optionee hereby agrees to accept as binding, conclusive
and final all decisions of interpretations of the Corporation's Board of
Directors upon any questions arising under the Plan, provided that such
interpretations are made in good faith and in accordance with the Board's
fiduciary obligations to the Corporation, its shareholders, and its Option
holders.



              Dated:_____________________________, 19______.



              ____________________________________________
              Optionee

<PAGE>


                                      EXHIBIT A

                          INTERNET COMMUNICATION CORPORATION
                             NOTICE OF EXERCISE OF OPTION


I, _____________________________________, hereby give notice to Internet
Communications Corporation (the "Company"), of my intent to exercise my right
and option to purchase ________ shares of the Company's common stock under the
Company's Incentive Stock Option Plan adopted effective January 1, 1991 (the
"Option Plan"), and granted to me pursuant to an Employee Stock Option Agreement
dated _______________________________, 19______ ("Option Agreement").

    I hereby acknowledge that upon delivery of payment in full for such shares
in accordance with the terms of the Option Agreement and Option Plan, all such
shares shall become subject to the terms of that certain Employee Stock
Restriction Agreement dated as of _____________________________, 19______ (the
"Restriction Agreement") between me and the Company.  Further, I specifically
reaffirm the representations, warranties, and acknowledgments contained in
Section 7 of the Restriction Agreement.

    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have executed this Notice this ________ day of
______________________________, 19______.



              X_________________________________________

              __________________________________________
              Print Name



_______________________________________
Witness





<PAGE>




                                                                     APPENDIX C







                            SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT



                                   dated as of



                                  May 29, 1996



                                     between



                       INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                                       and


                              INTERWEST GROUP, INC.
















<PAGE>

                                TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                            Page
                                                                            ----
                                    ARTICLE I
                                  TRANSACTIONS............................     1

     Section 1.1  Note; Share Exchange....................................     1
     Section 1.2  Adjustments.............................................     2


                                   ARTICLE II
                                    CLOSINGS..............................     3

     Section 2.1  First Closing...........................................     3
     Section 2.2  Second Closing..........................................     3
     Section 2.3  Location of Closings....................................     3


                                   ARTICLE III
                             CONDITIONS OF CLOSINGS.......................     3

     Section 3.1  Conditions Precedent to Both Closings...................     3
     Section 3.2  Additional Conditions Precedent to First Closing........     5
     Section 3.3  Additional Conditions Precedent to Second Closing.......     6
     Section 3.4  Legends.................................................     6


                                   ARTICLE IV
                         REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES...................     7

     Section 4.1  Corporate Existence and Power...........................     7
     Section 4.2  Authorization; Contravention; Modifications.............     8
     Section 4.3  Approvals...............................................     8
     Section 4.4  Binding Effect..........................................     9
     Section 4.5  Financial Information...................................     9
     Section 4.6  Taxes...................................................    10
     Section 4.7  Litigation..............................................    10
     Section 4.8  Compliance with Laws....................................    10
     Section 4.9  Subsidiaries............................................    10
     Section 4.10 Proprietary Rights......................................    11
     Section 4.11 Insurance...............................................    11
     Section 4.12 Debt....................................................    12
     Section 4.13 No Default..............................................    12
     Section 4.14 Capitalization..........................................    12
     Section 4.15 Material Contracts......................................    14
     Section 4.16 Investment Intent.......................................    14

                                       - i - 

<PAGE>

     Section 4.17  Fees for Brokers and Finders...........................    15
     Section 4.18  Misstatements..........................................    15
     Section 4.19  Company Representations................................    15
     Section 4.20  No Merger Agreements...................................    16
     Section 4.21  Continuing Representations and Warranties..............    16


                                    ARTICLE V
                                    COVENANTS.............................    17

     Section 5.1  Special Covenants.......................................    17
     Section 5.2  Affirmative Covenants...................................    20
     Section 5.3  Negative Covenants......................................    23
     Section 5.4  Additional Affirmative Covenants........................    24


                                   ARTICLE VI
                                   TERMINATION............................    25

     Section 6.1  Termination.............................................    25
     Section 6.2  Expenses and Fees.......................................    26


                                   ARTICLE VII
                                  MISCELLANEOUS...........................    27

     Section 7.1  Notices.................................................    27
     Section 7.2  No Waivers; Remedies; Specific Performance..............    27
     Section 7.3  Amendments, Etc. .......................................    28
     Section 7.4  Successors and Assigns..................................    28
     Section 7.5  Accounting Terms and Determinations.....................    28
     Section 7.6  Governing Law...........................................    28
     Section 7.7  Counterparts; Effectiveness.............................    29
     Section 7.8  Severability of Provisions..............................    29
     Section 7.9  Headings and References.................................    29
     Section 7.10 Entire Agreement........................................    29
     Section 7.11 Survival................................................    29
     Section 7.12 Non-Exclusive Jurisdiction..............................    29
     Section 7.13 Waiver of Jury Trial....................................    30
     Section 7.14 Affiliate...............................................    30
     Section 7.15 Non-Recourse............................................    30







                                       - ii - 

<PAGE>
                                      ANNEX


Annex A        -    Definitions


                                    EXHIBITS

Exhibit A      -    Form of Note
Exhibit B      -    Form of Registration Rights Agreement
Exhibit C      -    Form of Amendment


Exhibit 3.1(f)(1) - Certificate of Secretary of the Company, Group or Interwest
Exhibit 3.1(f)(2) - Certificate of Officer of the Company or Group
Exhibit 3.1(f)(5) - Opinion of Counsel for the Company
Exhibit 3.1(f)(6) - Opinion of Counsel for Group























                                       - iii - 

<PAGE>

                            SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT


     SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT dated as of May 29, 1996 between INTERNET 
COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION, a Colorado corporation (the "COMPANY"), and 
INTERWEST GROUP, INC., a Colorado corporation ("GROUP").

     Terms not otherwise defined in this Agreement have the meanings stated 
in Annex A.

     The parties agree as follows:

                                     ARTICLE

                                  TRANSACTIONS

     SECTION 1.  NOTE; SHARE EXCHANGE.  Subject to the terms and conditions 
set forth in this Agreement,

               (a)  at the First Closing,

          (i)  the Company shall issue, sell and deliver to Group, and Group
     shall purchase, accept and acquire from the Company at par and for cash, a
     promissory note (the "Note") in the principal amount of $900,000 and
     substantially in the form of EXHIBIT A attached hereto, pursuant to which,
     if the principal amount of and interest accrued on the Note shall not be
     paid in full at the maturity thereof (whether at stated maturity, on any
     date of required prepayment or upon acceleration), Group may require the
     Company to issue, sell and deliver to the Holder upon the conversion of the
     Note up to 300,000 shares of common stock, no par value, of the Company
     (the "COMMON STOCK"; as such number of shares may be adjusted pursuant to
     the terms of the Note, the "CONVERSION SHARES"), at a price of $3.00 per
     Conversion Share (as such price per share may be adjusted pursuant to the
     terms of the Note, the "NOTE CONVERSION PRICE"); and

          (ii) the Company and Group shall execute and deliver the Registration
     Rights Agreement substantially in the form of EXHIBIT B attached hereto
     (the "THE REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT"); and

               (b)  at the Second Closing,

          (i)  the Company shall issue, sell and deliver to Group, in
     consideration of the sale and delivery to the Company of the Interwest
     Shares, and Group shall purchase, accept and acquire from the Company,
     2,306,541 shares of Common Stock (as such number of shares may be adjusted
     pursuant to Section 1.2(a), the "ADDITIONAL SHARES"), which number of
     shares (as so adjusted) is intended by the parties to be equal to 49.0% of
     the number of shares of Common stock issued and outstanding after giving
     effect to the issuance, sale and delivery of the Additional Shares pursuant
     to this Section 1.1(b)(1) but without taking into account the issuance of
     shares of Common Stock after the date of this Agreement (A) pursuant to the
     exercise of Outstanding Options, in each case in accordance with the terms
     thereof as of the date of this Agreement, (B) pursuant to the conversion of
     the Note and (C) with the approval of Group, which approval may be granted,
     withheld, conditioned or delayed in its sole discretion (collectively,
     "PERMITTED ISSUANCES"); and

          (ii) Group shall sell and deliver to the Company, in consideration of
     the issuance, sale and 

                                       - 1 - 

<PAGE>

     delivery to Group of the Additional Shares, and the Company shall purchase,
     accept, and acquire from Group, 40,000 shares of voting common stock, no 
     par value, of Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation ("INTERWEST") and 
     1,000 shares of nonvoting common stock, no par value, of Interwest 
     (collectively, the "INTERWEST SHARES"), which are all the issued and 
     outstanding shares of such common stock.

          SECTION 2.  ADJUSTMENTS.

               (a)  Except as provided to the contrary in the following 
sentence, the respective numbers of Conversion Shares and Additional Shares 
and the Note Conversion Price, in each case as stated in this Section 1, 
shall be adjusted in the event of any change in Common Stock by reason of the 
issuance of any Equity Securities, stock or other non-cash dividends, 
extraordinary cash dividends, split-ups, mergers, recapitalizations, 
combinations, subdivisions, conversions, exchanges of shares or the like on 
or before the First Closing Date (in the case of the Conversion Shares and 
the Note Conversion Price) or on or before the Second Closing Date (in the 
case of the Additional Shares), such that Group shall receive upon the 
payment of the Note Conversion Price or the sale and delivery of the 
Interwest Shares, as the case may be, the number and class of shares or other 
securities or property that would have been received in respect of a share of 
Common Stock, as the case may be, if the First Closing Date or the Second 
Closing Date, as the case may be, had occurred immediately prior to such 
event, or the record date therefor, as applicable. Notwithstanding anything 
in this Agreement or in any other Transaction Document to the contrary, no 
such adjustments shall be required with respect to Permitted Issuances.

               (b)  No adjustment made pursuant to this Section 1.2 shall 
constitute or be deemed a waiver by Group of any breach of any of the 
representations, warranties or obligations of the Company contained in this 
Agreement.

                                     ARTICLE

                                    CLOSINGS

          SECTION 1.  FIRST CLOSING.  The closing of the transactions subject 
to Section 1.1(a) (the "FIRST CLOSING TRANSACTIONS") shall take place (the 
"FIRST CLOSING") on May 29, 1996 or, at the election of Group, on the second 
Business Day after the conditions precedent to the obligations of the parties 
under this Agreement with respect thereto shall have been satisfied or 
waived, as the case may be, or on such other date as the parties may agree in 
writing (the "First Closing Date"), but in no event later than May 31, 1996.

          SECTION 2.  SECOND CLOSING.  The closing of the transactions 
subject to Section 1.1(b) (collectively, the "SECOND CLOSING TRANSACTIONS") 
shall take place (the "SECOND CLOSING") on August 1, 1996 or, at the election 
of Group, on the second Business Day after the conditions precedent to the 
obligations of the parties under this Agreement with respect thereto shall 
have been satisfied or waived, as the case may be, or on such other date as 
the parties may agree in writing (the "Second Closing Date"), but in no event 
later than September 30, 1996.

          SECTION 3.  LOCATION OF CLOSINGS.  Each of the First Closing and 
the Second Closing (collectively, the "CLOSINGS") shall take place at the 
executive offices of the Company at its address stated on the signature pages 
of this Agreement or at such other location as agreed to by the parties. 


                                     ARTICLE

                                       - 2 - 

<PAGE>

                             CONDITIONS OF CLOSINGS

          SECTION 1.  CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO BOTH CLOSINGS.  The obligations 
of each party under this Agreement with respect to the Transactions are 
subject to the satisfaction of each of the following conditions, unless such 
conditions either are required to be satisfied by such party (for the benefit 
of the other party) or are waived by such party at or before the related 
Closing:

               (a)  each party shall have obtained from each Governmental 
Body or other person each Approval or taken all actions required to be taken 
in connection with each Approval, and all waiting, review or appeal periods 
prescribed with respect to each Approval shall have terminated or expired, as 
the case may be, in each case with respect to an Approval that is required or 
advisable on the part of such party for (1) the due execution and delivery by 
such party of each Transaction Document to which it is or may become a party, 
(2) the conclusion of the First Closing Transactions or the Second Closing 
Transactions, as the case may be, (3) the performance by such party of its 
obligations under each Transaction Document to which it is or may become a 
party with respect to the First Closing Transactions or the Second Closing 
Transactions, as the case may be, and (4) the exercise by such party of its 
rights and remedies under each Transaction Document to which the party is or 
may become a party with respect to the First Closing Transactions or the 
Second Closing Transactions, as the case may be;

               (b)  no Action shall be pending or, to the knowledge of either 
party, threatened against such party or any other person that restricts in 
any material respect or prohibits (or, if successful, would restrict or 
prohibit) the conclusion of the First Closing Transactions or the Second 
Closing Transactions, as the case may be;

               (c)  neither party (1) is in violation of or default, in any 
material respect, with respect to any Regulation of any Governmental Body or 
any decision, ruling, order or award of any arbitrator applicable to it or 
its business, properties or operations, (2) would be in violation of or 
default, in any material respect, with respect to the same in connection with 
or as a result of the conclusion of the First Closing Transactions or the 
Second Closing Transactions, as the case may be, or (3) has received notice 
that, in connection with or as a result of the conclusion of the First 
Closing Transactions or the Second Closing Transactions, as the case may be, 
it is or would be in violation of or default, in any material respect, with 
respect to the same;

               (d)  the representations and warranties of the other party 
contained in each Transaction Document to which such other party is a party 
shall be true and correct in all material respects on and as of the First 
Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as the case may be, with the same 
force and effect as though made on and as of such Closing Date;

               (e)  the other party shall have performed, in all material 
respects, all of the covenants and other obligations that are required by the 
Transaction Documents to which it is a party to be performed by such other 
party at or before the First Closing or the Second Closing, as the case may 
be; and

               (f)  the party shall have received from the other party the 
following, each dated the First Closing Date or the Second Closing Date, as 
the case may be, in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the 
receiving party:
 
          (i)  a certificate of the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of such
     other party and, with respect to the Company, a certificate of the
     Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of Interwest, substantially in the form
     of EXHIBIT 3.1(f)(1), with respect to (i) the articles of incorporation of
     such other party, (ii) the bylaws of such other party, (iii) the
     resolutions of the Board of Directors of such other party approving each

                                       - 3 - 

<PAGE>

     Transaction Document and the other documents to be delivered by it under
     the Transaction Documents and (iv) the names and true signatures of the
     officers of such other party authorized to sign each Transaction Document
     to which such other party is a party as of the First Closing Date or the
     Second Closing Date, as the case may be, and the other documents to be
     delivered by such other party under such Transaction Documents;

          (ii) a certificate of the President or a Vice President of such other
     party, substantially in the form of EXHIBIT 3.1(f)(2) to the effect that
     (i) the representations and warranties of such other party contained in the
     Transaction Documents to which it is a party are true and correct in all
     material respects as of the First Closing Date or the Second Closing Date,
     as the case may be, and (ii) such other party has performed, in all
     material respects, all covenants and other obligations required by the
     Transaction Documents to which it is a party to be performed by it at or
     before the First Closing or the Second Closing, as the case may be;

          (iii) certified copies, or other evidence satisfactory to such
     receiving party, of all Approvals of all Governmental Bodies and other
     persons with respect to the other party referred to in Section 4.3(a) with
     respect to the First Closing Date and Section 4.3(b) with respect to the
     Second Closing Date;

          (iv) a certificate of the Secretary of State of each jurisdiction in
     which such other party is incorporated, dated as of a recent date, as to
     the good standing of and payment of taxes by such other party and as to the
     charter documents of such other party or Consolidated Subsidiary, as the
     case may be, on file in the office of the Secretary of State;

          (v)  with respect to the Company, a favorable opinion of one or more
     counsel for the Company, which together are substantially in the form of
     EXHIBIT 3.1(f)(5), in each case to the extent indicated therein as
     applicable to the First Closing or the Second Closing, as the case may be,
     and as to other matters reasonably requested by the receiving party; and

          (vi) with respect to Group, a favorable opinion of one or more counsel
     for Group, which together are substantially in the form of EXHIBIT
     3.1(f)(6) in each case to the extent indicated therein as applicable to the
     First Closing or the Second Closing, as the case may be, and as to other
     matters reasonably requested by the receiving party, including, at the
     election of Group, an opinion that the Second Closing Transactions will be
     characterized as a tax-free reorganization under Section 368(a)(1)(B) of
     the Code. 

          SECTION 2.  ADDITIONAL CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO FIRST CLOSING.   The 
obligations of each party under this Agreement with respect to the First 
Closing Transactions are also subject to the satisfaction of each of the 
following conditions at or before the First Closing, unless the conditions 
either are required to be satisfied by such party (for the benefit of the 
other party) or are waived by such party:

               (a)  the Company shall have duly executed and delivered to 
Group the Note substantially in the form of EXHIBIT A attached hereto, with 
such changes therein as shall have been approved by the Company and Group;
 
               (b)  Group shall have delivered to the Company an amount in 
immediately available funds equal to the purchase price for the Note; and

               (c)  the Company and Group shall have executed and delivered 
the Registration Rights Agreement substantially in the form of EXHIBIT B 
attached hereto, with such changes therein as shall have been 

                                       - 4 - 

<PAGE>

approved by the Company and Group;

          SECTION 3.  ADDITIONAL CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO SECOND CLOSING.   
The obligations of each party under this Agreement with respect to the Second 
Closing Transactions are also subject to the satisfaction of each of the 
following conditions at or before the Second Closing, unless the conditions 
either are required to be satisfied by such party (for the benefit of the 
other party) or are waived by the party:

               (a)  the number of authorized shares of Common Stock shall 
have been duly increased from 4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 shares pursuant 
to the Amendment substantially in the form of EXHIBIT C attached hereto, with 
such changes therein as shall have been approved by the Company and Group;

               (b)  the shareholders of the Company shall have duly approved 
the Transaction Documents and the Transactions;

               (c)  the shareholder of Group shall have duly approved the 
Second Closing Transactions;

               (d)  the Company shall have duly executed and delivered to 
Group one or more certificates representing the Additional Shares;

               (e)  Group shall have delivered to the Company one or more 
certificates representing the Interwest Shares, duly endorsed for transfer or 
together with a stock power duly endorsed for transfer;

               (f)  the bylaws of the Company shall have been amended to fix 
the number of directors of the Company at seven;

               (g)  three persons designated by Group shall have been elected 
as directors of the Company effective as of the Second Closing Date to serve 
in such capacities until the next annual meeting of the shareholders of the 
Company; and

               (h)  the Second Closing Transactions shall be characterized as 
a tax-free reorganization under Section 368(a)(1)(A) or 368(a)(1)(B) of the 
Code.

          SECTION 4.  LEGENDS.

               (a)  Each certificate for Company Shares and any certificate 
issued in exchange therefor or on conversion or upon transfer, except 
certificates issued in connection with a sale registered under the Securities 
Act and except as provided below, shall bear legends to the following effect:

          (i)  "The shares represented by this certificate have not been
     registered under the Securities Act of 1933 and may not be offered, sold,
     transferred or otherwise disposed of except in compliance with said Act."
 
          (ii) "The shares represented by this certificate are subject to the
     restrictions contained in the Registration Rights Agreement dated as of May
     29, 1996, a copy of which is on file at the office of the Secretary of the
     Company."




                                       - 5 - 

<PAGE>

               (b)  The Note and any certificate issued in exchange therefor 
or on conversion or upon transfer, shall bear the legends to the effect 
stated in Section 3.4(a), MUTATIS MUTANDIS.

               (c)  The legend stated in Section 3.4(a)(1), and the 
corresponding legend referred to in Section 3.4(b), shall be removed by 
delivery of one or more substitute certificates without such legend if the 
holder thereof shall have delivered to the Company a copy of a letter from 
the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission or an opinion of counsel, 
in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Company, to the effect 
that the legend is not required for purposes of the Securities Act.

               (d)  The legend stated in Section 3.4(a)(2) and the 
corresponding legend referred to in Section 3.4(b) shall be removed at such 
time as the related securities are no longer subject to the Registration 
Rights Agreement.

                                     ARTICLE

                         REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES

          Each party represents and warrants, with respect to itself and, in 
the case of Group, with respect to Interwest, as follows (the Company or 
Interwest being referred to in this Article IV as a "SUBJECT COMPANY"):

          SECTION 1.  CORPORATE EXISTENCE AND POWER.  The representing party, 
and, with respect to Interwest, the Subject Company each (1) is a corporation 
duly incorporated, validly existing and in good standing under the laws of 
the jurisdiction of its incorporation, (2) has all necessary corporate power 
and authority and all material licenses, authorizations, consents and 
approvals required to own, lease, license or use its properties now owned, 
leased, licensed or used and proposed to be owned, leased, licensed or used 
and to carry on its business as now conducted and proposed to be conducted, 
(3) is duly qualified as a foreign corporation under the laws of each 
jurisdiction in which both (A) qualification is required either (i) to own, 
lease, license or use its properties now owned, leased, licensed and used or 
(ii) to carry on its business as now conducted and (B) the failure to be so 
qualified could materially and adversely affect either or both of (i) the 
business, properties, operations, prospects or condition (financial or 
otherwise) of the Subject Company, and (ii) the ability of the representing 
party or the Subject Company to perform its obligations under any Transaction 
Document to which it is or may become a party and (4) has all necessary 
corporate power and authority to execute and deliver each Transaction 
Document to which it is or may become a party.

          SECTION 2.  AUTHORIZATION; CONTRAVENTION; MODIFICATIONS.  Subject 
to obtaining the Approvals referred to in Section 4.3, the execution and 
delivery by the representing party of each Transaction Document to which the 
representing party is or may become a party and the performance by it of its 
obligations under each such Transaction Document have been duly authorized by 
all necessary corporate action and do not and will not (1) contravene, 
violate, result in a breach of or constitute a default under, (A) its 
articles of incorporation or bylaws, (B) any Regulation of any Governmental 
Body or any decision, ruling, order or award of any arbitrator by which the 
representing party or any of its properties may be bound or affected or (C) 
any agreement, indenture or other instrument to which the representing party 
is a party or by which the representing party or its properties may be bound 
or affected, (2) except as contemplated by the Transaction Documents, result 
in or require the creation or imposition of any Lien on any of the properties 
now owned or hereafter acquired by the representing party.

          SECTION 3.  APPROVALS.

                                       - 6 - 

<PAGE>

               (a)  Except with respect to the Approval that may be required
under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Act in connection with the conversion of the Note
and such other Approvals as shall have been disclosed in writing to the other
party, which writing makes reference to this Agreement, no Approval of any
Governmental Body or other person is required or advisable on the part of the
representing party for (1) the due execution and delivery by the representing
party of any Transaction Document to which it is or may become a party, (2) the
conclusion of the First Closing Transactions, (3) the performance by the
representing party of its obligations under each Transaction Document to which
it is or may become a party with respect to the First Closing Transactions and
(4) the exercise by Group of its rights and remedies under each such Transaction
Document with respect to the First Closing Transactions.  Each such Approval
shall have been obtained, all actions by each person required to be taken in
connection with each such Approval, other than Approval under the Hart-Scott-
Rodino Act, shall have been taken and all prescribed waiting, review or appeal
periods with respect to each such Approval shall have terminated or expired, as
the case may be, in each case on or before the First Closing Date.

               (b)  Except with respect to the Approvals required in connection
with the performance by the Company of its obligations under Section 5.1(a)(1),
including, without limitation, the Approval by the shareholders of the Company
of the Amendment and the filing of articles of amendment with respect thereto
with the Secretary of State of the State, the Approvals required in connection
with the performance by Group of its obligations under Section 5.1(a)(2), the
Approval that may be required under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Act in connection with
the conversion of the Note and such other Approvals as shall have been disclosed
in writing to the other party, which writing makes reference to this Agreement,
no Approval of any Governmental Body or other person that is required or
advisable on the part of the representing party for (1) the due execution and
delivery by the representing party of any Transaction Document to which it is or
may become a party, (2) the conclusion of the Second Closing Transactions, (3)
the performance by the representing party of its obligations under each
Transaction Document to which it is or may become a party with respect to the
Second Closing and (4) the exercise by Group of its rights and remedies under
each such Transaction Document with respect to the Second Closing Transactions.
Each such Approval shall have been obtained, all actions by each person required
to be taken in connection with each such Approval shall have been taken and all
prescribed waiting, review or appeal periods with respect to each such Approval
shall have terminated or expired, as the case may be, in each case on or before
the Second Closing Date.

          SECTION 4.  BINDING EFFECT.  Each Transaction Document to which the
representing party is or may become a party is, or when executed and delivered
in accordance with this Agreement will be, the legally valid and binding
obligation of the representing party enforceable against it in accordance with
its terms, except as may be limited by bankruptcy, insolvency, reorganization,
moratorium or other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors' rights
generally and general principles of equity, including, without limitation,
concepts of materiality, reasonableness, good faith and fair dealing and the
possible unavailability of specific performance or injunctive relief, regardless
of whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law.

          SECTION 5.  FINANCIAL INFORMATION.

               (a)  The consolidated balance sheet of the Subject Company and
its Consolidated Subsidiaries as of the last day of its latest complete fiscal
year (the "BALANCE SHEET DATE") and the related consolidated statements of
operations, shareholders' equity and cash flows for the fiscal year then ended,
reported on by the independent public accountants of the representing party
(and, with respect to the Company, filed with the Securities and Exchange
Commission in the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
January 31, 1996), a true and complete copy of which has been delivered to the
other party, fairly present the consolidated financial position of the Subject
Company and its Consolidated Subsidiaries as of that date and their consolidated
results of operations and cash flows for the year then ended, in accordance with
GAAP applied on a consistent basis except as 



                                    -7-


<PAGE>

described in the footnotes to such financial statements or as disclosed in 
writing to the other party, which writing makes reference to this Agreement.

               (b)  The representing party has made available to the other party
copies of each management letter delivered to the representing party by the
independent public accountants of the representing party in connection with the
financial statements referred to in this Section 4.5 or relating to any review
by them of the internal controls of the Subject Company and its Consolidated
Subsidiaries during the three years ended on its Balance Sheet Date or
thereafter, and has made available for inspection all reports and working papers
produced or developed by them or management in connection with their examination
of those financial statements, as well as all such reports and working papers
for prior periods for which any liability of the Subject Company and its
Subsidiaries for Taxes has not been finally determined or barred by applicable
statutes of limitation.

          SECTION 6.  TAXES.  Each of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries
has filed all Tax Returns that are required to be filed with any Governmental
Body and has paid all Taxes due pursuant to the Tax Returns or any assessment
received by it or otherwise required to be paid, except Taxes being contested in
good faith by appropriate proceedings and for which adequate reserves or other
provisions are maintained, and except for the filing of Tax Returns as to which
the failure to file could not, individually or in the aggregate, have a Material
Adverse Effect.

          SECTION 7.  LITIGATION.

               (a)  Except as previously disclosed to the other party in
writing, which writing makes reference to this Agreement, there is no Action
pending or, to the knowledge of the representing party, threatened against the
Subject Party or any of its Subsidiaries that (1) involves any of the
Transactions or (2) individually or in the aggregate, if determined adversely to
any of them, could result in a liability to any of them in an amount that could
have a Material Adverse Effect.

               (b)  There is no Action pending or, to the knowledge of the
representing party, threatened against the representing party, any of its
Subsidiaries or any other person that involves any of the Transactions or any
property owned, leased, licensed or used by the representing party or such
Subsidiary that, individually or in the aggregate, if determined adversely to
any of them, could have a Material Adverse Effect.

          SECTION 8.  COMPLIANCE WITH LAWS.  None of the Subject Company and its
Subsidiaries is in, and none of them has received notice of, a violation of or
default with respect to, any Regulation of any Governmental Body or any
decision, ruling, order or award of any arbitrator applicable to it or its
business, properties or operations, including individual products or services
sold or provided by it, except for violations or defaults that, individually or
in the aggregate, could not have a Material Adverse Effect.

          SECTION 9.  SUBSIDIARIES.

               (a)  The representing party has previously delivered to the other
party a correct and complete list of the Subsidiaries of the Subject Company,
which list makes reference to this Agreement, showing the following as of the
date of this Agreement with respect to each such Subsidiary: (i) the
jurisdiction of its incorporation; (ii) the title of each authorized class or
series of capital stock; (iii) the number of shares of each authorized class or
series of capital stock; (iv) the number of such shares outstanding; (v) the
number of outstanding shares owned directly or indirectly by the representing
party; and (vi) the directors and officers of the Subsidiary as of the date of
this Agreement.



                                    -8-


<PAGE>

               (b)  All outstanding shares of capital stock of each Subsidiary
are duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable and are owned
as set forth in the written notice referenced in Section 4.13(a), directly or
indirectly, beneficially and of record by the representing party, free and clear
of all Liens other than Permitted Liens.


          SECTION 10.  PROPRIETARY RIGHTS.

               (a)  The representing party has previously disclosed to the other
party in writing, which writing makes reference to this Agreement, a correct and
complete description and list of all Proprietary Rights in which one or more of
the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries has an interest, the failure to hold
which, individually or in the aggregate, could have a Material Adverse Effect. 
None of the representing party and its Subsidiaries has received notice that the
validity of any such Proprietary Right or its title to or use of any such
Proprietary Right is being questioned in any Action.

               (b)  With respect to the Company, without derogating from the
generality of Section 4.10(a), the Company has the right to use the name
"Internet" in the State of Colorado.

               (c)  The Subject Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be,
has good title to each of the interests created by such Proprietary Rights.  The
right, title and interest of the Subject Company or such Subsidiary, as the case
may be, in and to each such Proprietary Right is free and clear of all Liens
other than Permitted Liens.

               (d)  The representing party has no reason to believe, and does
not believe, that any use has been or is being made of any such Proprietary
Right by any person other than the Subject Company, such Subsidiary or a person
duly authorized to make that use.  All such Proprietary Rights used by the
Subject Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, but previously owned or
held by any of its directors, officers, employees or agents, have been duly
transferred to the Subject Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be.

               (e)  There is no liability or obligation of any of the Subject
Company and its Subsidiaries with respect to any such Proprietary Right that is
required to have been paid or otherwise performed, as of the date of this
Agreement, that has not been paid or otherwise performed in full.

          SECTION 11.  INSURANCE.  The Subject Company and its Subsidiaries are
insured with reputable insurers against all risks normally insured against in
accordance with generally prevailing practices in the communications industry
and all of such insurance policies and bonds maintained by or for the benefit of
the Subject Company and such Subsidiary, as the case may be, are in full force
and effect.  The Subject Company and its Subsidiaries maintain insurance with
reputable insurance companies in such amounts and covering such risks as are
usually carried by companies engaged in the same or similar business and
similarly situated.  There are no currently outstanding material losses for
which the Company or such Subsidiary has failed to give or present notice or
claim under any policy.  There are no requirements by any insurance company or
by any board of fire underwriters or other body exercising similar functions or
by any Governmental Body of which the representing party has knowledge requiring
any repairs or other work to be done to any of the properties owned, leased,
licensed or used by the Subject Company or such Subsidiary or requiring any
equipment or facilities to be installed on or in connection with any of the
properties, the failure to complete which could result in the cancellation of
the policy of insurance. Policies for all the insurance are in full force and
effect and none of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries is in default in any
material respect under any of the policies.  The representing party has no
knowledge of the cancellation or proposed cancellation of any of the insurance
or of any proposed increase in the contributions for workers' compensation or



                                    -9-


<PAGE>

unemployment insurance or of any conditions or circumstances applicable to the
business of the Company or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, which might
result in a material increase in those contributions.

          SECTION 12.  DEBT.  The representing party has previously disclosed to
the other party in writing, which writing makes reference to this Agreement, a
correct and complete description and list of the following: (i) all credit
agreements, indentures, purchase agreements, Guarantees, Capitalized Leases and
other Investments, agreements and other arrangements presently in effect
providing for or relating to Debt in any amount greater than $250,000 in respect
of which any of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries is in any manner
directly or contingently obligated; (ii) the maximum principal or face amounts
of such Debt outstanding or which may be outstanding under each of those
agreements and other arrangements; and (iii) the maturity date or dates of such
Debt.

          SECTION 13.  NO DEFAULT.  Except as previously disclosed to the other
party in writing, which writing makes reference to this Agreement, none of the
Subject Company and its Subsidiaries is in default in respect of any obligation
under any credit agreement, indenture, purchase agreement, Guarantee,
Capitalized Lease and other Investment, agreement or arrangement referred to in
Section 4.12, which default either alone or together with any other default,
entitles another party thereto, with the giving of notice or the passage of time
or both, to terminate or modify the rights and obligations of the parties
thereunder or with respect thereto or to accelerate, increase or otherwise
modify any obligation of the Subject Company or any of its Subsidiaries
thereunder.

          SECTION 14.  CAPITALIZATION.

               (a)  With respect to the Company,

          (i)  the authorized capital stock of the Company consists of (A)
     4,500,000 shares of Common Stock and (B) 100,000,000 shares of preferred
     stock, par value $.0001 per share, of which no shares are issued and
     outstanding; 

          (ii) the number of shares of Common Stock as of the date hereof (A)
     issued and outstanding, (B) held in the treasury of the Company, (C)
     reserved for issuance upon exercise of outstanding stock options granted by
     the Company (the "Outstanding Options"), together with the exercise prices
     therefor and (D) reserved for issuance as Conversion Shares upon conversion
     of the Note and reserved for issuance as Additional Shares has been
     previously disclosed to Group in writing, which writing makes reference to
     this Agreement.

               (b)  With respect to Interwest, (1) the authorized capital stock
of Interwest consists of (A) 100,000 shares of voting common stock, no par
value, of which 40,000 shares are issued and outstanding, and (B) 10,000 shares
of nonvoting common stock, no par value, of which 1,000 shares are issued and
outstanding, and (2) all of which issued and outstanding Interwest Shares are
owned, beneficially and of record, by Group.
 
               (c)  Except as set forth above and except as provided in the
Transaction Documents, no Equity Securities of the Subject Company are issued,
reserved for issuance or outstanding.

               (d)  All outstanding shares of capital stock of the Subject
Company are, and all shares that may be issued pursuant to the exercise of the
Outstanding Options, the Conversion Shares that may be issued pursuant to the
conversion of the Note (if the same shall be executed and delivered) and the
Additional Shares, as the case may be, will be, when issued, duly authorized,
validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable and, except as provided in the
Transaction Documents, are not subject to preemptive rights.



                                   -10-


<PAGE>

               (e)  Except with respect to the Outstanding Options and the
Transaction Documents, there are no outstanding bonds, debentures, notes or
other indebtedness or other securities of the Subject Company having the right
to vote (or convertible into, or exchangeable for, securities having the right
to vote) on any matters on which shareholders of the Subject Company may vote.

               (f)  Except with respect to the Outstanding Options and the
Transaction Documents, there is no agreement or arrangement restricting the
voting or transfer of the Equity Securities of the Subject Company.

               (g)  Except with respect to the Outstanding Options and the
Transaction Documents, there are no outstanding securities, options, warrants,
calls, rights, commitments, agreements, arrangements or undertakings of any kind
to which any of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries is a party or by which
any of them is bound obligating the Subject Company or such Subsidiary to issue,
deliver or sell, or cause to be issued, delivered or sold, additional shares of
capital stock or other Equity Securities of the Subject Company or such
Subsidiary or obligating the Subject Company or such Subsidiary to issue, grant,
extend or enter into any such security, option, warrant, call, right,
commitment, agreement, arrangement or undertaking.

               (h)  Except as previously disclosed to the other party in
writing, which writing makes reference to this Agreement, there are no
outstanding contractual obligations, commitments, understandings or arrangements
of any of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries to repurchase, redeem or
otherwise acquire, require or make any payment in respect of any shares of
Equity Securities of the Subject Company or such Subsidiary.

               (i)  Except with respect to statutory restrictions of general
application, there are no legal, contractual or other restrictions on the
payment of dividends or other distributions or amounts on or in respect of any
of the Equity Securities of the Subject Company.

               (j)  Except as contemplated by the Registration Rights Agreement,
there are no agreements or arrangements to which any of the Subject Company and
its Subsidiaries is a party pursuant to which the Subject Company is or could be
required to register shares of common stock or other securities under the
Securities Act.

               (k)  Equity Securities of the Subject Company that were issued
and reacquired by the Subject Company were so reacquired (and, if reissued, so
reissued) in compliance with all applicable Regulations, and the Subject Company
has no liability with respect to the reacquisition or reissuance of the Equity
Securities.

          SECTION 15.  MATERIAL CONTRACTS.  The representing party has
previously disclosed to the other party in writing, which writing makes
reference to this Agreement, a correct and complete description and list of the
following (collectively, the "MATERIAL CONTRACTS") with respect to any of the
Subject Company and its Subsidiaries:

               (a)  agreements with investment bankers, brokers, finders,
consultants and advisers engaged by or on behalf of the Subject Company or such
Subsidiary with respect to the Transactions or other transactions contemplating
the recapitalization of the Subject Company or such Subsidiary, the purchase or
sale by the Subject Company or such Subsidiary of assets not in the ordinary
course of business or the issuance and sale by the Subject Company or such
Subsidiary of any Equity Securities or Debt of the Subject Company or such
Subsidiary, as the case may be;

               (b)  agreements with any shareholder having beneficial ownership
of 5.0% or more of the shares of common stock of the Subject Company then issued
and outstanding, director or officer of the Subject 



                                   -11-


<PAGE>

Company or such Subsidiary and all shareholders' agreements and voting trusts;
and

               (c)  agreements not made in the ordinary course of business and
which are materially adverse to the business of the Subject Company or such
Subsidiary.

          SECTION 16.  INVESTMENT INTENT.

               (a)  The representing parties acknowledge that the Company is
issuing and selling the Note (and, upon conversion thereof, the Conversion
Shares) and the Additional Shares and that Group is selling the Interwest
Shares, in each case pursuant to the terms of the Transaction Documents, in
reliance upon the exemption afforded by Section 4(2) of the Securities Act for
transactions by an issuer not involving any public offering.

               (b)  The representing party (1) represents that it is acquiring
securities pursuant to Section 1.1 for investment and without any view toward
distribution of any of the securities to any other person and (2) agrees that it
will not sell or otherwise dispose of the securities except in compliance with
the registration requirements or exemption provisions under the Securities Act.

          SECTION 17.  FEES FOR BROKERS AND FINDERS.  The representing party and
its Subsidiaries and other Affiliates have not authorized any person to act as
financial advisor, broker, finder or other intermediary that might be entitled
to any fee, commission, expense reimbursement or other payment of any kind from
any of the representing party, such Subsidiaries and such other Affiliates upon
the conclusion of or in connection with any of the Transactions.

          SECTION 18.  MISSTATEMENTS.  Except to the extent revised or
superseded by a subsequent certificate, schedule or report furnished to the
other party, no information, certificate, schedule or report furnished by or on
behalf of the representing party to the other party with respect to any of the
Subject Company and its Subsidiaries in connection with the negotiation of any
Transaction Document or the satisfaction of any condition under any Transaction
Document contained as of the date thereof any untrue statement of a material
fact or omitted to state a material fact necessary to make the statement
contained therein, in the light of the circumstances under which it was made,
not misleading.

          SECTION 19.  COMPANY REPRESENTATIONS.  With respect to the Company:

               (a)  RECOMMENDATIONS.  The Board of Directors of the Company, at
a meeting duly called and held, has duly (1) determined that the Transaction
Documents and the Transactions, taken as a whole, are in the best interests of
the Company and its shareholders, (2) resolved to recommend that holders of
shares of Common Stock approve the Transaction Documents and the Transactions
(collectively, the "RECOMMENDATIONS") and (3) approved the Transaction Documents
and the Transactions.

               (b)  SHAREHOLDER APPROVAL.  The affirmative vote of a majority of
the shares of the Common Stock voted at the duly convened Shareholders Meeting
(or any other duly convened meeting of the holders of the Common Stock) is the
only vote of the holders of any class or series of the Equity Securities of the
Company necessary to approve the Transaction Documents and the Transactions,
including, without limitation, the increase in the number of authorized shares
of Common Stock from 4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 shares.  None of the First
Closing Transactions is required to be approved by the holders of shares of any
class of Equity Securities of the Company.

               (c)  NO RESTRICTIONS ON GROUP.  No provision of the articles of
incorporation or bylaws of the Company or any other agreement, indenture or
other instrument to which the Company or its properties are 



                                   -12-


<PAGE>

subject (1) directly or indirectly restricts or impairs the right or ability 
of Group to vote, or otherwise to exercise the rights and receive the 
benefits of a shareholder with respect to, Equity Securities of the Company 
that may be acquired or controlled by Group, including, without limitation, 
restrictions based upon the size of the security holdings of Group, the 
business in which it is engaged or other considerations applicable to it and 
not to security holders generally, or (2) permits any other security holder 
of the Company to acquire securities of the Company on a basis not available 
to Group if Group were to acquire Equity Securities of the Company.

               (d)  SEC DOCUMENTS.  The Company has filed with the Securities
and Exchange Commission all reports, schedules, forms, statements and other
documents required by the Exchange Act to be filed by the Company since January
1, 1993 (collectively, and in each case including all exhibits and schedules
thereto and documents incorporated by reference therein, the "SEC DOCUMENTS"). 
The Company has delivered or made available to Group all SEC Documents.  As of
their respective dates, except to the extent revised or superseded by a
subsequent filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission, the SEC Documents
complied in all material respects with the requirements of the Securities Act or
the Exchange Act, as the case may be, and none of the SEC Documents (including
any and all financial statements included therein) as of such dates contained
any untrue statement of a material fact or omitted to state a material fact
required to be stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements
therein, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not
misleading.  The consolidated financial statements of the Company and the
Subsidiaries included in all SEC Documents, including any amendments thereto
(the "SEC FINANCIAL STATEMENTS"), comply as to form in all material respects
with applicable accounting requirements and the published rules and regulations
of the Securities and Exchange Commission with respect thereto.

          SECTION 20.  NO MERGER AGREEMENTS.  None of the representing party and
its Subsidiaries has entered into any agreement with any person which has not
been terminated as of the date of this Agreement and under which there remains
any liability or obligation of any of the representing party and its
Subsidiaries with respect to a merger or consolidation with any of the Subject
Company and its Subsidiaries, an acquisition of any Equity Securities of any of
the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries, any other acquisition of a substantial
amount of the assets of any of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries or any
Business Combination Transaction with respect to any of the Subject Company and
its Subsidiaries.

          SECTION 21.  CONTINUING REPRESENTATIONS AND WARRANTIES.  Each of the
representations and warranties made by the representing party in this Agreement
or in any other Transaction Document as of any date other than a Closing Date
will be true and correct in all material respects on and as of the Closing Date
except as otherwise contemplated by such Transaction Document, and the
representing party will prepare and deliver to the other party such updates or
other revisions of the written disclosures referred to in this Article IV as
have been delivered by the representing party to the other party as shall be
necessary in order to make each of such written disclosures correct and complete
in all material respects on and as of the Closing Date.  The requirement to
prepare and deliver updates or other revisions of the written disclosures, and
the receipt by the other party of information pursuant to Section 5.1 or
otherwise on or before a Closing Date, shall not limit the right of the other
party under Article III to require as a condition precedent to the performance
of its obligations under this Agreement on such Closing Date the accuracy in all
material respects of the representations and warranties and the performance in
all material respects of the covenants of the representing party made in the
Transaction Documents (without regard to such updates or other revisions) and to
receive an unqualified certificate with respect to the same.



                                   -13-


<PAGE>

                                     ARTICLE

                                    COVENANTS


          SECTION 1.  SPECIAL COVENANTS.

               (a)  FIRST CLOSING.  Until the conclusion of the First Closing:

          (i)  COMPANY APPROVALS.  The Company shall use its best efforts to
     obtain:

                    the Approvals with respect to the Transaction Documents and
          the Transactions specified in writing to Group, which writing makes
          reference to this Agreement;

                    the Approval of the shareholders of the Company with respect
          to the Transaction Documents and the Transactions, including, without
          limitation, the increase in the number of authorized shares of Common
          Stock from 4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 shares; and

                    the Approval required, if any, to cause the Company Shares
          to be qualified for inclusion in the National Association of
          Securities Dealers Automated Quotation/Small Cap (the "NASDAQ/SMALL
          CAP"), and give such notice as required, if any, to the National
          Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. with respect to the
          Transaction Documents and the Transactions.

          (ii) GROUP APPROVALS.  Group shall use its best efforts to obtain the
     following Approvals with respect to the Transaction Documents and the
     Transactions on terms and conditions that shall have been approved by the
     Company, which approval may not be unreasonably withheld:

                    the Approvals with respect to the Transaction Documents and
          the Transactions specified in writing to the Company, which writing
          makes reference to this Agreement; and

                    the Approval of the shareholder of Group with respect to the
          Second Closing Transactions.

               (b)  SECOND CLOSING.  Until the conclusion of the Second Closing:

          (i)  SHAREHOLDERS MEETING; PREPARATION OF PROXY STATEMENT.  Without
     limiting the generality of Section 5.1(a)(1)(C), the Company, acting
     through its Board of Directors, shall, in accordance with applicable law
     and as soon as practicable following the execution and delivery of this
     Agreement, (A) duly postpone the annual meeting of shareholders of the
     Company currently scheduled to be held on May 30, 1996, or convene and
     immediately adjourn (without conducting any other business), give such
     notice to the shareholders as may be appropriate or required by law,
     convene and, subject to Section 5.1(b)(1)(D), hold the annual meeting of
     its shareholders or a special meeting thereof (such meeting, including any
     adjournments thereof, the "SHAREHOLDERS MEETING") for the purpose, among
     other things, of considering and taking action upon the Transaction
     Documents and the Transactions, and prepare and file with the Securities
     and Exchange Commission proxy statement (such proxy statement including the
     form of proxy and all such other materials distributed in connection
     therewith, as amended or supplemented from time to time, the "PROXY
     STATEMENT"), (B) use its best efforts (i) to obtain and furnish the
     information required to be included by it in the Proxy Statement and, after
     consultation with Group, respond promptly to any comments made by the
     Securities and Exchange Commission with respect to the Proxy Statement and
     any preliminary version thereof and cause the Proxy Statement to be mailed
     to its shareholders at the earliest practicable time following the
     execution and delivery of this Agreement and (ii) to solicit proxies in
     favor of the Transactions and otherwise obtain 



                                   -14-


<PAGE>

     the approval by its shareholders of the Transaction Documents and the 
     Transactions, including, without limitation, the increase in the number of
     authorized shares of Common Stock from 4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 
     shares, and (C) cause the Proxy Statement and the distribution thereof to
     comply in all material respects with the Exchange Act and ensure that the 
     Proxy Statement will not, at the date the Proxy Statement (or any amendment
     thereof or supplement thereto) is first mailed to shareholders and at the 
     time of the Shareholders Meeting, be false or misleading with respect to 
     any material fact, or omit to state any material fact required to be 
     stated therein or necessary in order to make the statements made therein, 
     in the light of the circumstances under which they are made, not misleading
     or necessary to correct any statement in any earlier communication with 
     respect to the solicitation of proxies for the Shareholders Meeting which
     has become false or misleading.  Subject to the Company's right pursuant 
     to clause (z) of the proviso to Section 5.1(b)(2) to withdraw or modify 
     the Recommendations, the Company shall include in the Proxy Statement the
     recommendation of its Board of Directors that holders of Common Stock vote
     in favor of the approval of the Transaction Documents and the Transactions.
     If the Company is advised by its proxy solicitors prior to the Shareholders
     Meeting or otherwise determines that a vote in favor of the Transactions is
     not likely to be obtained at the Shareholders Meeting, the Shareholders 
     Meeting shall, at the request of Group, be adjourned from time to time, 
     provided that in no event will the Shareholders Meeting be required 
     hereunder to be held more than 120 days from the original scheduled meeting
     date, which 120 day period shall be extended by the number of days, if any,
     that the Company is enjoined from soliciting proxies in connection with 
     the Shareholders Meeting or that the holding of the Shareholders Meeting 
     or the vote thereat is enjoined.  The obligations of the Company pursuant
     to Section 5.1(b)(1) (including, without limitation, the obligation to 
     submit the Transactions to a vote of its shareholders), shall not be 
     affected by the withdrawal or modification of the Recommendations.

          (ii) NO SOLICITATION.  None of the parties and their respective
     Subsidiaries shall, and none of the parties and their respective
     Subsidiaries shall authorize or permit any of its officers, directors,
     employees or Affiliates or any financial advisor, attorney, accountant or
     other representative retained by it to,

                    solicit, initiate or encourage (including, without
          limitation, by way of furnishing information), any inquiry or the
          making of any proposal to the Company or Interwest (each being
          referred to in this Section 5.1(b)(2) as a "SUBJECT COMPANY") or their
          respective Affiliates from any person (other than (x) the other party
          or any Affiliate of, or any person acting in concert with or
          representing such other party and (y) the persons previously
          identified by the covenanting party to the other party), which
          proposal constitutes, or may reasonably be expected to lead to, in
          each case whether in one transaction or in a series of transactions,
          (i) an acquisition from the Subject Company or its shareholders of any
          Equity Securities of any of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries
          (other than the Transactions), (ii) any acquisition of a substantial
          amount of assets of any of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries,
          (iii) a merger or consolidation of any of the Subject Company and its
          Subsidiaries or (iv) any tender offer (including a self-tender offer)
          or exchange offer, recapitalization, liquidation, dissolution or
          similar transaction involving any of the Subject Company and its
          Subsidiaries (other than the Transactions) or any other transaction
          the consummation of which would or could reasonably be expected to
          impede, interfere with, prevent or materially delay the conclusion of
          any of the Transactions or which would or could reasonably be expected
          to materially reduce the benefits of the Transactions to the other
          party (collectively, "BUSINESS COMBINATION TRANSACTIONS") or agree to
          or endorse any Business Combination Transaction; or

                    enter into or participate in any discussions or negotiations
          regarding any Business 



                                   -15-


<PAGE>

          Combination Transaction, or furnish to any other person (other than 
          the other party or any Affiliate of, or any person acting in concert
          with or representing, such other party) any information with respect
          to the business, properties, operations, prospects or conditions 
          (financial or otherwise) of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries
          or any Business Combination Transaction, or otherwise cooperate in 
          any way with, or assist or participate in, facilitate or encourage,
          any effort or attempt by any other person to seek or conclude any 
          Business Combination Transaction;

     PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the foregoing clauses (i) and (ii) of Section
     5.1(b)(2)(A) and Section 5.1(b)(2)(B) shall not prohibit a party from (x)
     furnishing to a third party who has made a written proposal with respect to
     a Business Combination Proposal (a "TRANSACTION PROPOSAL") information
     pursuant to an appropriate confidentiality letter concerning the Subject
     Company and its Subsidiaries and the business, properties, operations,
     prospects or conditions (financial or otherwise) of the Subject Company and
     its Subsidiaries, (y) engaging in discussions or negotiations with such a
     third party who has made such a Transaction Proposal or (z) following
     receipt of a Transaction Proposal, taking and disclosing to its
     shareholders a position contemplated by Rule 14e-2(a) under the Exchange
     Act or changing the Recommendations, but in each case referred to in the
     foregoing clauses (x) through (z) only after the Board of Directors of the
     Subject Company concludes in good faith, based upon the written opinion of
     its counsel, that such action is necessary or appropriate in order for the
     Board of Directors of the Subject Company to act in a manner which is
     consistent with its fiduciary obligations under applicable law.  If the
     Board of Directors of a party or a Subject Company receives a Transaction
     Proposal, then the party or the Subject Company, as the case may be, shall
     promptly inform the other party of the terms and conditions of such
     proposal and the identity of the person making the Transaction Proposal and
     shall keep the other party generally informed with reasonable promptness of
     any steps it is taking pursuant to the preceding sentence of this Section
     5.1(b)(2) with respect to the Transaction Proposal.  Each party has advised
     the directors of the related Subject Company with respect to the
     obligations of the party under this Section 5.1(b), and each of such
     directors has agreed to comply with such obligations.

               (c)  NUMBER OF DIRECTORS.  If the shareholders of the Company
shall have approved the Transaction Documents and the Transactions, the Board of
Directors of the Company shall amend the bylaws of the Company to increase the
number of directors of the Company from four persons to seven persons and at the
Second Closing shall cause the vacancies created thereby to be filled by three
persons designated by Group to serve in such capacities until the next annual
meeting of the shareholders of the Company.

               (d)  RESERVATION OF COMPANY SHARES.  The Company shall reserve
from its authorized but unissued shares of Common Stock, for issuance pursuant
to the terms of the Note and this Agreement, a number of shares equal to the
number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of the Note from time to
time and, upon the approval of the Amendment by the shareholders of the Company,
a number of shares equal to the Additional Shares.

          SECTION 2.  AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS.  Each party covenants and agrees,
with respect to itself and, in the case of Group, with respect to Interwest, to
do the following until the conclusion of the Second Closing (the Company or
Interwest, as the case may be, being referred to in this Section 5.2 as a
"SUBJECT COMPANY"):

               (a)  MAINTENANCE OF EXISTENCE.  The covenanting party shall, and
shall cause its Subsidiaries to, preserve and maintain its corporate existence
and good standing in the jurisdiction of its incorporation and qualify and
remain qualified as a foreign corporation in each jurisdiction in which both (1)
qualification is required either (A) to own, lease, license or use its
properties now owned, leased, licensed or used and proposed to be owned, 



                                   -16-



<PAGE>

leased, licensed or used or (B) to carry on its business as now conducted or 
proposed to be conducted and (2) the failure to be so qualified could 
materially and adversely affect either or both of (A) the business, 
properties, operations, prospects or condition (financial or otherwise) of 
the party and (B) the ability of the party to perform its obligations under 
any Transaction Document to which it is or may become a party.

               (b)  COMPLIANCE WITH LAWS.  The covenanting party shall, and 
shall cause its Subsidiaries to, comply in all respects with all Regulations 
of each Governmental Body and all decisions, rulings, orders and awards of 
each arbitrator applicable to it or its business, properties or operations in 
connection with the Transactions.

               (c)  BEST EFFORTS.  Upon the terms and subject to the 
conditions provided in the Transaction Documents, the covenanting party 
shall, and shall cause its Subsidiaries to, use its best efforts to take, or 
cause to be taken, all action, and to do, or cause to be done, and to assist 
and cooperate with the other party hereto in doing all things necessary, 
proper or advisable under applicable Regulations to ensure that the 
conditions set forth in Article III and to the conclusion of the Transactions 
are satisfied and to conclude and make effective, in the most expeditious 
manner practicable, the Transactions including, without limitation, using its 
best efforts to obtain all necessary Approvals.

               (d)  NOTIFICATION.  The covenanting party shall, and shall 
cause its Subsidiaries to, give prompt notice to the other parties to this 
Agreement or any other Transaction Document, as the case may be, of (1) the 
occurrence, or failure to occur, of any event that would be likely to cause 
any representation or warranty of the covenanting party contained in the 
Transaction Document to be untrue or inaccurate in any material respect at 
any time from the date of this Agreement to the Second Closing Date and (2) 
any failure of the covenanting party to perform or otherwise comply with, in 
any material respect, any covenant, condition or agreement to be performed or 
complied with by it under the Transaction Documents; which covenant of 
notification shall not limit the right of the other party under Article III 
to require as a condition precedent to the performance of its obligations 
under this Agreement the continuing accuracy and performance of the 
representations and warranties and covenants of the notifying party made in 
the Transaction Documents and to receive an unqualified certificate with 
respect to the same.

               (e)  PUBLICITY AND REPORTS.  Except as may be required by 
applicable laws, court process or by obligations pursuant to any listing 
agreement with a national securities exchange or on NASDAQ/Small Cap Market, 
the covenanting party shall, and shall cause its Subsidiaries to, consult 
with the other party before issuing any press release or making any public 
statement with respect to the Transactions.

               (f)  CONFIDENTIALITY.  The covenanting party shall, and shall 
cause its Subsidiaries to, keep confidential information disclosed by any of 
the other party, its Subsidiaries of its respective representatives to any of 
the covenanting party, its Subsidiaries or its representatives, whether 
before or after the date of this Agreement, in connection with the 
Transactions or the discussions and negotiations preceding the execution of 
the Transaction Documents, and use such information only as contemplated by 
the Transaction Documents, except in each case to the extent that (1) the 
information was known by the recipient when received or the information is or 
hereafter becomes lawfully obtainable from other sources, (2) disclosure to a 
Governmental Body having jurisdiction over the parties is necessary or 
appropriate, (3) disclosure may otherwise be required by applicable 
Regulations or (4) the duty as to confidentiality is waived in writing by the 
other party.  If this Agreement is terminated, each party shall use 
reasonable efforts to return upon written request from the other party all 
documents (and reproductions of those documents) received by it or its 
representatives from the other party (and, in the case of reproductions, all 
reproductions made by the receiving party) that include information not 
within the exceptions contained in the preceding sentence, unless the 
recipients provide assurances reasonably satisfactory to the requesting party 
that the documents have been 


                                     -17-

<PAGE>

destroyed.

               (g)  REPORTING REQUIREMENTS.  The covenanting party shall, and
shall cause its Subsidiaries to, furnish to the other party:

          (i)  ADVERSE EVENTS.  Promptly after the occurrence, or failure to
     occur, of any such event, information with respect to any event (A) which
     could have a Material Adverse Effect, (B) which, if known as of the date of
     this Agreement, would have been required to be disclosed to the other party
     or (C) which would be likely to cause any representation or warranty
     contained in any Transaction Document with respect to the covenanting party
     or such Subsidiary to be untrue or inaccurate in any material respect at
     any time from the date of this Agreement to the Second Closing Date;

          (ii) ACCESS TO INFORMATION.  Afford to the other party, and to the
     officers, employees, financial advisors, attorneys, accountants and other
     representatives of the other party, reasonable access during normal
     business hours to all its properties, books, contracts commitments,
     personnel and records; furnish as promptly as practicable to the other
     party and its representatives such information with respect to the
     business, properties, operations, prospects or conditions (financial or
     otherwise) of the Subject Company and its Subsidiaries as they may from
     time to time reasonably request; and

          (iii)     GENERAL INFORMATION.  Such other information respecting the
     condition or operations, financial or otherwise, of any of the Subject
     Company and its Subsidiaries as the other party may from time to time
     reasonably request.

               (h)  MAINTENANCE OF RECORDS.  The Subject Company shall, and 
shall cause its Subsidiaries to, keep adequate records and books of account 
reflecting all its financial transactions, keep minute books containing 
accurate records of all meetings and accurately reflecting all corporate 
action of its shareholders and its Board of Directors (including committees) 
and keep stock books and ledgers correctly recording all transfers and 
issuances of all capital stock.

               (i)  MAINTENANCE OF PROPERTIES.  The Subject Company shall, 
and shall cause its Subsidiaries to, maintain, keep and preserve all its real 
property and personal property used or useful in the proper conduct of its 
business in good working order and condition, ordinary wear and tear excepted.

               (j)  CONDUCT OF BUSINESS.  Except as otherwise contemplated by 
the Transaction Documents, the Subject Company shall, and shall cause its 
Subsidiaries to, continue to engage in an efficient and economical manner 
solely in a business of the same general type as conducted by it on the date 
of this Agreement in the ordinary course, consistent with past practices; and 
use its best efforts to preserve the business of the Company and its 
Subsidiaries and to preserve the goodwill of customers, suppliers and others 
having business relations with the Company and its Subsidiaries.

               (k)  MAINTENANCE OF INSURANCE.  The Subject Company shall, and 
shall cause its Subsidiaries to, maintain insurance such that the 
representations and warranties stated in Section 4.20 shall at all times 
remain true.

               (l)  PAYMENT OF TAXES.  The Subject Company shall, and shall 
cause its Subsidiaries to, timely file all Tax Returns that are required to 
be filed by it and pay before they become delinquent all Taxes due pursuant 
to those Tax Returns or any assessment received by it or otherwise required 
to be paid, except Taxes being 


                                     -18-

<PAGE>


contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings and for which adequate 
reserves or other provisions are maintained, and except for the filing of 
such Tax Returns as to which the failure to file could not, individually or 
in the aggregate, have a Materially Adverse Effect.

          SECTION 3.  NEGATIVE COVENANTS.  Each party covenants and agrees, 
with respect to itself and, in the case of Group, with respect to Interwest, 
as follows, and shall not enter into any agreement or take any other action 
inconsistent with the following, in each case until the conclusion of the 
Second Closing (the Company or Interwest, as the case may be, being referred 
to in this Section 5.3 as a "SUBJECT COMPANY"):

               (a)  CHARTER DOCUMENTS.  The Subject Company shall not, and 
shall not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, amend its articles of 
incorporation or its bylaws.

               (b)  CAPITALIZATION.  The Subject Company shall not, and shall 
not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, issue any shares of capital stock or 
other Equity Securities other than Permitted Issuances.

               (c)  MERGERS, ETC.  Except as shall have been previously 
agreed in writing by the parties, which writing makes reference to this 
Agreement, the Subject Company shall not, and shall not permit any of its 
Subsidiaries to, merge or consolidate with any person, sell, lease, license 
or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its assets (whether now 
owned or hereafter acquired) to any person or acquire all or substantially 
all of the assets or the business of any person, in each case whether in one 
transaction or in a series of transactions, or to effect any other Business 
Consolidation Transaction, except that a Consolidated Subsidiary may merge 
into or transfer assets to the Subject Company or a Wholly-Owned Consolidated 
Subsidiary.

               (d)  SETTLE LITIGATION.  The Subject Company shall not, and 
shall not permit any of its Subsidiaries to, settle or compromise any 
litigation (whether or not commenced prior to the date of this Agreement) or 
settle, pay or compromise any claims not required to be paid (which are not 
payable or reimbursable under policies of insurance maintained by or on 
behalf of any of the Company and its Subsidiaries), individually in an amount 
in excess of $25,000 and in the aggregate in an amount in excess of $100,000, 
other than in consultation and cooperation with the other party, and, with 
respect to any such settlement, with the prior written consent of the other 
party.

               (e)  COMPANY COVENANTS.  The Company shall not:

          (i)  subject to clause (z) of the proviso to Section 5.1(b)(2),
     withdraw or modify the Recommendations; and

          (ii) take any action which would cause the Common Stock to no longer
     be listed on NASDAQ/Small Cap Market or registered pursuant to Section 13
     or 15(d) of the Exchange Act.

          SECTION 4.  ADDITIONAL AFFIRMATIVE COVENANTS.

               (a)  FURTHER ASSURANCES.  Promptly upon request by the other 
party, each party shall, and shall cause its Subsidiaries to, correct any 
defect or error that may be discovered in any Transaction Document or in the 
execution or acknowledgment of any Transaction Document and execute, 
acknowledge, deliver, file, re-file, register and re-register, any and all 
such further acts, certificates, assurances and other instruments as the 
requesting party may require from time to time in order (1) to carry out more 
effectively the purposes of each Transaction Document, (2) to enable the 
requesting party to exercise and enforce its rights and remedies and collect 
any payments and proceeds under each Transaction Document and (3) to better 
transfer, preserve, protect and confirm to the 


                                     -19-

<PAGE>

requesting party the rights granted or now or hereafter intended to be 
granted to the requesting party under each Transaction Document or under each 
other instrument executed in connection with any Transaction Document.

               (b)  HART-SCOTT-RODINO.  If the conversion of any principal 
amount of the Note shall not be exempt from the Hart-Scott-Rodino Act, each 
party shall from time to time use its best efforts to comply with any 
applicable requirements under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Act relating to filing 
and furnishing information to the Department of Justice and the Federal Trade 
Commission, including, but not limited to, the following:

          (i)  assisting in the preparation and filing of the "Antitrust
     Improvements Act Notification and Report Form for Certain Mergers and
     Acquisitions" and taking all other action required by 16 C.F.R. Parts 801-
     803 (or any successor form or Regulation);

          (ii) complying with any additional request for documents or
     information made by the Department of Justice or the Federal Trade
     Commission or by a court; and

          (iii)     causing all affiliated persons of the "ultimate parent
     entity" of the party within the meaning of the Hart-Scott-Rodino Act to
     cooperate and assist in the filing and compliance.

Each party shall exchange information as may reasonably be requested by the
other in connection with the matters referred to in this Section 5.4(b).

               (c)  TAX MATTERS.  Group shall include the income of Interwest 
(including any deferred income triggered into income by Reg. Section 
1.1502-13 and Reg. Section 1.1502-14 and any excess loss accounts taken into 
income under Reg. Section 1.1502-19) on Group's consolidated federal income 
Tax Returns for all periods through the Second Closing Date and pay any 
federal income Taxes attributable to such income.  Interwest shall furnish 
Tax information to Group for inclusion in Group's federal consolidated income 
Tax Return for the period which includes the Second Closing Date in 
accordance with Interwest's past custom and practice.  Interwest's income 
shall be apportioned to the period up to and include the Second Closing Date 
and the period after the Second Closing Date by closing the books of 
Interwest as of the end of the Second Closing Date. The Company shall 
indemnify Group for any additional tax owed by Group (including tax owed by 
Group due to this indemnification payment) resulting from any transaction not 
in the ordinary course of business occurring on the Second Closing Date after 
the Company's purchase of the Interwest Shares.

               (d)  DESIGNATION OF DIRECTORS.   Group shall have the right to 
designate not less than one person to be elected as a Class I director, Class 
II director and Class III director.

                                     ARTICLE

                                   TERMINATION

          SECTION 1.  TERMINATION.

               (a)  The obligations of the parties under Section 1.1(a) and 
Article V with respect to the First Closing may be terminated at any time 
prior to the conclusion of the First Closing, and the obligations of the 
parties under Sections 1.1(b) and Article V with respect to the Second 
Closing may be terminated at any time prior to the conclusion of the Second 
Closing, in each case by:

          (i)  the mutual consent of the Company and Group;


                                     -20-

<PAGE>

          (ii) the Company, if (A) the conditions to be satisfied by Group set
     forth in Sections 3.1, 3.2 and 3.3 shall not have been met with respect to
     the First Closing by May 31, 1996 or with respect to the Second Closing by
     August 1, 1996 and (B) the Company shall have paid in full to Group all
     amounts then owed to Group pursuant to Section 6.2(c), if any;

          (iii) the Company, if a representation, warranty or covenant of
     Group set forth in a Transaction Document is breached or violated by Group
     in any material respect;

          (iv) Group, if the conditions to be satisfied by the Company set forth
     in Sections 3.1, 3.2 and 3.3 shall not have been met with respect to the
     First Closing by May 31, 1996 or with respect to the Second Closing by
     August 15, 1996;

          (v)  Group, if a representation, warranty or covenant of the Company
     set forth in a Transaction Document is breached or violated by the Company
     in any material respect;

          (vi) Group, if the Company shall have modified or amended in any
     respect materially adverse to Group or withdrawn its approval of any of the
     Recommendations; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that any communication of the Company
     that advises that the Company has received a Transaction Proposal or is
     engaging in an activity permitted by clauses (x) or (y) of the proviso to
     the first sentence of Section 5.1(b)(2) with respect to a Transaction
     Proposal and that takes no action or position with respect to the
     Transactions or any Transaction Proposal shall not be deemed to be a
     withdrawal, modification or amendment of the Recommendations or the
     Company's approval thereof; and, PROVIDED, FURTHER, that a
     "stop-look-and-listen" communication with respect to the Transactions of
     the nature contemplated in Rule 14d-9(e) under the Exchange Act made by the
     Company as a result of a Transaction Proposal (whether or not a tender
     offer), without more, shall not be deemed to be a modification or amendment
     of the Recommendations or the Company's approval thereof that is materially
     adverse to Group if, within ten business days after the date of such
     communication, the Company shall have reaffirmed its Recommendations;
 
          (vii) the Company, if there shall have occurred a Subsequent Event
     with respect to any of Interwest and its Subsidiaries and Group shall have
     paid in full to the Company all amounts then owed to the Company pursuant
     to Section 6.2; or

          (viii) Group, if there shall have occurred a Subsequent Event with
     respect to the Company and its Subsidiaries;

               (b)  Any termination of the obligations of the parties shall 
be made by written agreement or by written notice from the terminating party 
to the other parties.

               (c)  The termination of the obligations of the parties under 
this Section 6.1 shall not relieve any party of any liability for a breach of 
any warranty, covenant or agreement, or for any misrepresentation, under this 
Agreement, or be deemed to constitute a waiver of any available remedy 
(including specific performance if available) for any breach or 
misrepresentation.

          SECTION 2.  EXPENSES AND FEES.

               (a)  COLLECTION EXPENSES.   In addition to the other 
provisions of this Section 6.2, the Company shall promptly, but in no event 
later than two business days following written notice thereof, together with 


                                     -21-

<PAGE>

related bills or receipts, reimburse Group for all reasonable out-of-pocket 
costs, fees and expenses, including, without limitation, the reasonable fees 
and disbursements of counsel and the expenses of litigation, incurred in 
connection with collecting Expenses and any other fees due under this 
Agreement or any of the other Transaction Documents as a result of any 
willful breach by the Company of its obligations under this Section 6.2.

               (b)  OTHER EXPENSES.  Except as otherwise provided in this 
Section 6.2, whether or not the Transactions are concluded, all costs and 
expenses incurred in connection with the Transaction Documents and the 
Transactions shall be paid by the party incurring such expenses. 
Notwithstanding the foregoing, the costs and expenses of preparing and 
distributing the Proxy Statement and obtaining and complying with the 
antitrust requirements of any Governmental Body shall be paid by the Company.

               (c)  SUBSEQUENT EVENT FEE.  If a Subsequent Event shall occur 
on or before the date that is 90 days after the date of this Agreement (and 
prior to the Second Closing Date), the responsible party shall pay to the 
other party $400,000 promptly following the public announcement of such 
Subsequent Event.

                                     ARTICLE

                                  MISCELLANEOUS

          SECTION 1.  NOTICES.  All notices, requests and other 
communications to any party or under any Transaction Document shall be in 
writing. Communications may be made by telecopy or similar writing.  Each 
communication shall be given to the party at its address stated on the 
signature pages of this Agreement or at any other address as the party may 
specify for this purpose by notice to the other party.  Each communication 
shall be effective (1) if given by telecopy, when the telecopy is transmitted 
to the proper address and the receipt of the transmission is confirmed, (2) 
if given by mail, 72 hours after the communication is deposited in the mails 
properly addressed with first class postage prepaid or (3) if given by any 
other means, when delivered to the proper address and a written 
acknowledgment of delivery is received.
 
          SECTION 2.  NO WAIVERS; REMEDIES; SPECIFIC PERFORMANCE.

               (a)  No failure or delay by any party in exercising any right, 
power or privilege under any Transaction Document shall operate as a waiver 
of the right, power or privilege.  A single or partial exercise of any right, 
power or privilege shall not preclude any other or further exercise of the 
right, power or privilege or the exercise of any other right, power or 
privilege.  The rights and remedies provided in the Transaction Documents 
shall be cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by 
law.

               (b)  In view of the uniqueness of the Transactions and the 
business, properties, operations, prospects and condition (financial and 
otherwise) of the Company, Interwest and their respective Subsidiaries, 
neither party would have an adequate remedy at law for money damages in the 
event that any of the Transaction Documents is not performed in accordance 
with its terms, and therefore each party agrees that the other party shall be 
entitled to specific enforcement of the terms of each Transaction Document in 
addition to any other remedy to which it may be entitled, at law or in equity.


          SECTION 3.  AMENDMENTS, ETC.  No amendment, modification, 
termination, or waiver of any provision of any Transaction Document, and no 
consent to any departure by a party to a Transaction Document from 


                                     -22-

<PAGE>

any provision of the Transaction Document, shall be effective unless it shall 
be in writing and signed and delivered by the other parties to the 
Transaction Document, and then it shall be effective only in the specific 
instance and for the specific purpose for which it is given.

          SECTION 4.  SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS.

               (a)  Each party may assign to a Wholly-Owned Subsidiary 
thereof its rights and delegate its obligations under this Agreement before a 
Closing; such assignee shall accept those rights and assume those obligations 
for the benefit of the other party in writing in form reasonably satisfactory 
to the other party. Thereafter, without any further action by any person, all 
references in this Agreement to the "Company" or "Group", as the case may be, 
and all comparable references, shall be deemed to be references to the 
transferee, but such assignor shall not be released from any obligation or 
liability under this Agreement.

               (b)  Except as provided in Section 8.4(a), no party to this 
Agreement may assign its rights under the Transaction Document.  Any 
delegation in contravention of this Section shall be void AB INITIO and shall 
not relieve the delegating party of any obligation under this Agreement.

               (c)  The provisions of each Transaction Document shall be 
binding upon and inure to the benefit of the parties to the Transaction 
Document and their respective successors and permitted assigns.

          SECTION 5.  ACCOUNTING TERMS AND DETERMINATIONS.  Unless otherwise 
specified, all accounting terms shall be interpreted, all accounting 
determinations shall be made, all records and books of account shall be kept 
and all financial statements required to be prepared or delivered shall be 
prepared in accordance GAAP, applied on a basis consistent (except for 
changes approved by the Company's independent public accountants) with the 
latest audited financial statements referred to in Section 4.5.

          SECTION 6.  GOVERNING LAW.  Each Transaction Document shall be 
governed by and construed in accordance with the internal laws of the State 
of Colorado.  All rights and obligations of the Company and Group shall be in 
addition to and not in limitation of those provided by applicable law.
 
          SECTION 7.  COUNTERPARTS; EFFECTIVENESS.  Each Transaction Document 
may be signed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an 
original, with the same effect as if all signatures were on the same 
instrument.

          SECTION 8.  SEVERABILITY OF PROVISIONS.  Any provision of any 
Transaction Document that is prohibited or unenforceable in any jurisdiction 
shall, as to  that jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of the 
prohibition or unenforceability without invalidating the remaining provisions 
of the Transaction Document or affecting the validity or enforceability of 
the provision in any other jurisdiction.

          SECTION 9.  HEADINGS AND REFERENCES.  Article and section headings 
in any Transaction Document are included in the Transaction Document for the 
convenience of reference only and do not constitute a part of the Transaction 
Document for any other purpose.  References to parties and articles and 
sections in any Transaction Document are references to the parties to or the 
articles and sections of the Transaction Document, as the case may be, unless 
the context shall require otherwise.

          SECTION 10.  ENTIRE AGREEMENT.  Except as otherwise specifically 
provided in this Section, the Transaction Documents, together with that 
certain letter agreement dated as of May 29, 1996 by and between the 


                                     -23-

<PAGE>

Company and Group (the "Letter Agreement"), embody the entire agreement and 
understanding of the respective parties and supersede all prior agreements or 
understandings with respect to the subject matters of those documents. All 
references to this Agreement herein and in all opinions, certificates and 
other documents delivered pursuant to or otherwise delivered in connection 
with this Agreement shall be deemed to refer to this Agreement as amended by 
the Letter Agreement.

          SECTION 11.  SURVIVAL.  Except as otherwise specifically provided 
in any Transaction Document, and notwithstanding any investigation or notice 
to the contrary or any waiver by any other party of a related condition 
precedent to the performance by the other party of an obligation under the 
Transaction Document, (1) each representation and warranty of each party to 
the Transaction Document contained in or made pursuant to the Transaction 
Document shall survive each Closing and remain in full force and effect until 
the date that is the first anniversary of the Second Closing Date or, if the 
Second Closing Date shall then not have occurred, the date that is the first 
anniversary of the First Closing Date and (2) the other party may assert or 
commence an Action against the party with respect to the breach of any such 
representation or warranty of the party on or before such date and may 
maintain any such Action thereafter.  Each covenant or agreement of a party 
to a Transaction Document required to be performed on or after a Closing 
shall remain in full force and effect thereafter in accordance with its terms.

          SECTION 12.  NON-EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION.  Each party (1) agrees 
that any Action with respect to any Transaction Document may be brought in 
the courts of the State of Colorado or of the United States of America for 
the District of Colorado, (2) accepts for itself and in respect of its 
property, generally and unconditionally, the jurisdiction of those courts and 
(3) irrevocably waives any objection, including, without limitation, any 
objection to the laying of venue or based on the grounds of FORUM NON  
CONVENIENS, which it may now or hereafter have to the bringing of any Action 
in those jurisdictions; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that any party may assert in an 
Action in any other jurisdiction or venue each mandatory defense, third-party 
claim or similar claim that, if not so asserted in such Action, may 
thereafter not be asserted by such party in an original Action in the courts 
referred to in clause (1) above.

          SECTION 13.  WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL.  Each party waives any right to 
a trial by jury in any Action to enforce or defend any right under any 
Transaction Document or any amendment, instrument, document or agreement 
delivered, or which in the future may be delivered, in connection with any 
Transaction Document and agrees that any Action shall be tried before a court 
and not before a jury.


          SECTION 14.  AFFILIATE.  Nothing contained in the Transaction 
Documents shall constitute Group an "affiliate" of any of the Company and its 
Subsidiaries within the meaning of Rule 13e-3 under the Exchange Act.

          SECTION 15.  NON-RECOURSE.  No recourse under any of the 
Transaction Documents shall be had against any "controlling person" (within 
the meaning of Section 20 of the Exchange Act) of any party or the 
shareholders, directors, officers, employees, agents and Affiliates of the 
party or such controlling persons, whether by the enforcement of any 
assessment or by any legal or equitable proceeding, or by virtue of any 
Regulation, it being expressly agreed and acknowledged that no personal 
liability whatsoever shall attach to, be imposed on or otherwise be incurred 
by such controlling person, shareholder, director, officer, employee, agent 
or Affiliate, as such, for any obligations of the party under this Agreement 
or any other Transaction Document or for any claim based on, in respect of or 
by reason of such obligations or their creation.

                         ___________________________


                                     -24-


<PAGE>

          IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed and delivered this 
Purchase Agreement as of the date first written above in Denver, Colorado.

                                   INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION



                                   By: 
                                       -------------------------------------
                                         Name:
                                         Title:

                                   Address:  7100 East Belleview Avenue
                                             Suite 201
                                             Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111

                                   Telecopy: (303) 770-0588




                                   INTERWEST GROUP, INC.


                                   By: 
                                       -------------------------------------
                                         Name:
                                         Title:

                                   Address:  12201 East Arapahoe Road
                                             Suite C10
                                             Englewood, Colorado 80112

                                   Telecopy: (303) 792-0227












                                      S-1

<PAGE>

                               DEFINITION ANNEX


          "ACTION" against a person means an action, suit, investigation, 
complaint or other proceeding pending against or affecting the person or its 
property, whether civil or criminal, in law or equity or before any 
arbitrator or Governmental Body.

          "ADDITIONAL SHARES" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(b)(1) of 
this Agreement.

          "AFFILIATE" of a person means any other person (1) that directly or 
indirectly controls, is controlled by or is under common control with, the 
person or any of its Subsidiaries, (2) that directly or indirectly 
beneficially owns or holds 5.0% or more of any class of voting stock of the 
person or any of its Subsidiaries or (3) 5.0% or more of the voting stock of 
which is directly or indirectly beneficially owned or held by the person or 
any of its Subsidiaries. The term "CONTROL" means the possession, directly or 
indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management 
and policies of a person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, 
by contract or otherwise.

          "AMENDMENT" means the amendment to the articles of incorporation of 
the Company substantially in the form of EXHIBIT C attached hereto pursuant 
to which (i) the number of authorized shares of Common Stock shall be 
increased from 4,500,000 shares to 20,000,000 shares, (ii) the Board of 
Directors of the Company shall be staggered in three classes and (iii) a plan 
of merger, share exchange or sale of all or substantially all of the assets 
of the Company shall be approved by the affirmative vote of at least 
two-thirds of the shares entitled to vote thereon.

          "APPROVAL" means an authorization, consent, approval or waiver of, 
clearance by, notice to or registration or filing with, or any other similar 
action by or with respect to a Governmental Body or any other person and the 
expiration or termination of all prescribed waiting, review or appeal periods 
with respect to any of the foregoing.

          "BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP" has the meaning assigned to that term in 
Section 13(d) of the Exchange Act.

          "BEST EFFORTS" means the use of all reasonable efforts, including, 
without limitation, the expenditure of amounts reasonably related to the 
objective sought to be achieved, with respect to matters and actions over 
which the person has or could reasonably be expected to exert any control or 
influence.

          "BUSINESS COMBINATION TRANSACTION" has the meaning stated in 
Section 5.1(b)(2)(A) of this Agreement.

          "BUSINESS DAY" means any day excluding Saturday, Sunday and any day 
which is a legal holiday under the laws of the State of Colorado or is a day 
on which banking institutions located in such state are authorized or 
required by law or other governmental action to close.

          "CAPITALIZED LEASE" means any lease that is or should be 
capitalized and appear on the balance sheet of the lessee.

          "CLOSING DATE" means the First Closing Date or the Second Closing 
Date, as the context may require.

          "CLOSINGS" has the meaning stated in Section 2.3 of this Agreement.


                                     A-1

<PAGE>

          "CODE" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

          "COMMON STOCK" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1 of this 
Agreement.

          "COMPANY" means Internet Communications Corporation, a Colorado 
corporation, and its successors.

          "COMPANY SHARES" means, collectively, the Conversion Shares and the 
Additional Shares.

          "CONSOLIDATED" means, as applied to any financial or accounting 
term, the term determined on a consolidated basis for a person and its 
Subsidiaries, excluding intercompany items and minority interests.

          "CONSOLIDATED SUBSIDIARY" of a person at any date means any 
Subsidiary of the person or other entity the accounts of which would be 
consolidated with those of the person in its consolidated financial 
statements as of that date.

          "CONVERSION SHARES" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(a)(1) of 
this Agreement.

          "DEBT" of a person at any date means, without duplication, the sum 
of (1) all obligations of the person (A) for borrowed money, (B) evidenced by 
bonds, debentures, notes or other similar instruments, (C) to pay the 
deferred purchase price of property or services, except trade accounts 
payable arising in the ordinary course of business, (D) as lessee under 
Capitalized Leases, (E) under letters of credit issued for the account of the 
person and (F) arising under acceptance facilities, plus (2) all Debt of 
others Guaranteed by the person, plus (3) all Debt of others secured by a 
Lien on any asset of the person and whether or not such Debt is assumed by 
the person.

          "DOLLARS" AND "$" refer to United States dollars and other lawful 
currency of the United States of America from time to time in effect.

          "EQUITY SECURITIES" of a person means the capital stock of the 
person and all other securities convertible into or exchangeable or 
exercisable for any shares of its capital stock, all rights to subscribe for 
or to purchase, all options for the purchase of, and all calls, commitments 
or claims of any character relating to, any shares of its capital stock and 
any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for any of the 
foregoing.

          "EXCHANGE ACT" means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as 
amended, and the related rules and regulations thereunder.

          "FIRST CLOSING" has the meaning stated in Section 2.1 of this 
Agreement.

          "FIRST CLOSING DATE" has the meaning stated in Section 2.1 of this 
Agreement.

          "FIRST CLOSING TRANSACTIONS" has the meaning stated in Section 2.1 
of this Agreement.

          "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles as in effect 
in the United States of America from time to time.

          "GOVERNMENTAL BODY" means any agency, bureau, commission, court, 
department, official, political subdivision, tribunal or other 
instrumentality of any government, whether federal, state, county or local, 
domestic 


                                           A-2 
<PAGE>

or foreign.

          "GROUP" means Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation, a Colorado 
corporation, and its successors.

          "GUARANTEE" by any person means any obligation, contingent or 
otherwise, of the person directly or indirectly guaranteeing any Debt of any 
other person or in any manner providing for the payment of any Debt of any 
other person or the investment of funds in any other person or otherwise 
protecting the holder of the Debt against loss (whether by agreement to 
indemnify, to lease assets as lessor or lessee, to purchase assets, goods, 
securities or services, or to take-or-pay or otherwise), but the term 
"GUARANTEE" does not include endorsements for collection or deposit in the 
ordinary course of business.  The term "GUARANTEE" used as a verb has a 
correlative meaning.

          "HART-SCOTT-RODINO ACT" means the Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust 
Improvements Act of 1976, as amended and related rules, regulations and 
published interpretations thereunder.

          "HOLDER" means Group, and its successors, as payee under the Note.

          "INTERWEST" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(b)(2). 

          "INTERWEST SHARES" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(b)(2) of 
this Agreement.

          "KNOWLEDGE" with respect to a representation or warranty of a party 
contained in any Transaction Document means, after due inquiry by the 
representing party of each of the following persons, the actual knowledge of 
any of the officers or other employees of the representing party having 
managerial responsibility for the portion of the operations, assets or 
liabilities of the representing party and its Subsidiaries with respect to 
which such knowledge of the person is being represented.

          "LIEN" means any mortgage, deed of trust, lien (statutory or 
otherwise), pledge, hypothecation, charge, deposit arrangement, preference, 
priority, security interest or encumbrance of any kind (including, but not 
limited to, any conditional sale agreement or other title retention 
agreement, any Capitalized Lease or financing lease having substantially the 
same economic effect as the foregoing and the filing of or agreement to give 
any financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code or comparable law 
of any jurisdiction to evidence any of the foregoing).

          "MATERIAL ADVERSE EFFECT" means, with respect to a circumstance or 
event subject to a representation, warranty, covenant or other agreement of a 
person or any of its Subsidiaries in any Transaction Document that includes a 
reference therein to the possible occurrence of a Material Adverse Effect, 
whether considered individually or together in the aggregate with all other 
circumstances or events that are the subject of the same representation, 
warranty, covenant or other agreement, a material adverse effect on the 
business, properties, operations, prospects, condition (financial or 
otherwise) or capitalization of the person and its Subsidiaries, taken as a 
whole, or the ability of the person to perform its obligations under any 
Transaction Document to which it is or may become a party.           


          "MATERIAL CONTRACT" means an agreement referred to in Section 4.15.

          "NASDAQ/SMALL CAP MARKET" has the meaning stated in Section 
5.1(a)(1)(D) of this Agreement.

          "NOTE" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(a)(1).

                                           A-3 
<PAGE>

          "NOTE CONVERSION PRICE" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(a)(1) 
of this Agreement.

          "NPL" has the meaning stated in Section 4.23(b)(3) of this 
Agreement.

          "OUTSTANDING OPTIONS" has the meaning stated in Section 4.14(a)(2) 
of this Agreement.

          "PERMITTED ISSUANCES" has the meaning stated in Section 1.1(b)(1) 
of this Agreement.

          "PERMITTED LIENS" with respect to a person means, collectively, 
Liens the existence of which, without regard to the giving of notice, the 
passage of time or the existence or occurrence of any other condition, do not 
permit the holder of any Debt of the person of any of its Subsidiaries in an 
amount greater than $10,000 individually or $25,000 in the aggregate to cause 
such Debt to become due and payable or to seek to enforce or realize upon the 
rights of the holder in or with respect to property or assets of such person 
or such Subsidiary, as the case may be, that secure such Debt.

          "PERSON" means an individual, a corporation, a partnership, an 
association, a trust or any other entity or organization, including a 
Governmental Body.

          "PROPERTY" means any right or interest in or to property of any 
kind whatsoever, whether real, personal or mixed and whether tangible or 
intangible.

          "PROPRIETARY RIGHTS" means all copyrights, uncopyrighted works, 
trademarks, trademark rights, service marks, trade names, trade name rights, 
patents, patent rights, unpatented inventions, licenses, permits, trade 
secrets, know-how, inventions, computer software, seismic data and 
intellectual property rights and other proprietary rights together with 
applications and licenses for, and the goodwill of the business relating to, 
any of the foregoing.

          "PROXY STATEMENT" has the meaning stated in Section 5.1(b)(1) of 
this Agreement.

          "RECOMMENDATIONS" has the meaning set forth in Section 4.19 of this 
Agreement.

          "RECORD DATE" means the date determined by the Board of Directors 
of the Company with respect to which holders of Common Stock at such date 
will be entitled to vote with respect to Transaction Documents and the 
Transactions at the Shareholders Meeting.

          "REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT" means the Registration Rights 
Agreement between the Company and Group to be dated as of the First Closing 
Date, substantially in the form attached hereto as EXHIBIT B.

          "REGULATION" means (1) any applicable law, rule, regulation, 
judgment, decree, ruling, order, award, injunction, recommendation or other 
official action of any Governmental Body and (2) any official change in the 
interpretation or administration of any of the foregoing by the Governmental 
Body or by any other Governmental Body or other person responsible for the 
interpretation or administration of any of the foregoing.

          "SEC DOCUMENTS" has the meaning stated in Section 4.19(d) of this 
Agreement.
 
          "SEC FINANCIAL STATEMENTS" has the meaning set forth in Section 
4.19(d) of this Agreement.

          "SECOND CLOSING" has the meaning stated in Section 2.2 of this 
Agreement.

                                           A-4 
<PAGE>

          "SECOND CLOSING DATE" has the meaning stated in Section 2.2 of this 
Agreement.

          "SECOND CLOSING TRANSACTIONS" has the meaning stated in Section 2.2 
of this Agreement.

          "SECURITIES ACT" means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and 
the related rules and regulations thereunder.

          "SHAREHOLDERS MEETING" has the meaning stated in Section 5.1(b)(1) 
of this Agreement.

          "STATE" means the State of Colorado.

          "SUBSEQUENT EVENT" means, with respect to a party (the "AFFECTED 
PARTY"), any of the following, in each case whether or not any shall have 
exercised and delivered, or exercised any rights or performed any obligations 
under, any of the Transaction Documents:

               (1)  the affected party or any of its Subsidiaries, without
     having received the prior written consent of the other party, shall have
     entered into an agreement with respect to a Business Combination
     Transaction, or the Board of Directors of the affected party shall have
     recommended that the shareholders of the affected party approve or accept
     any Business Combination Transaction;

               (2)  the affected party or any of its Subsidiaries, without
     having received the prior written consent of the other party, shall have
     authorized, recommended, proposed or publicly announced its intention to
     authorize, recommend or propose, an agreement with respect to a Business
     Combination Transaction, or the Board of Directors of the affected party
     shall have publicly withdrawn or modified, or publicly announced its intent
     to withdraw or modify, the Recommendations;

               (3)  any person other than the other party or any Affiliate of
     the other party shall have acquired beneficial ownership or the right to
     acquire beneficial ownership of 30% or more of the outstanding shares of
     common stock of the affected party then issued and outstanding; or

               (4)  any person shall have proposed a Business Combination
     Transaction (A) that the Board of Directors of the affected party
     determines in its good faith judgment is more favorable to the affected
     party's shareholders than the Transactions and (B) as a result of which the
     Board of Directors of the affected party concludes in good faith that
     termination of the Transaction Documents is necessary or appropriate in
     order for the Board of Directors of the affected party to act in a manner
     which is consistent with its fiduciary obligations under applicable law.

          "SUBSIDIARY" of a person means (i) any corporation or other entity 
of which securities or other ownership interests having ordinary voting power 
to elect not less than 50% of the Board of Directors or other persons 
performing similar functions are at the time directly or indirectly owned by 
the person or (ii) a partnership in which the person or a Subsidiary of the 
person is, at the date of determination, a general or limited partner of such 
partnership, but only if the person or its Subsidiary is entitled to receive 
more than fifty percent of the assets of such partnership upon its 
dissolution.
 
          "TAXES" means all taxes, charges, fees, levies, duties, imposts, 
withholdings, restrictions, fines, interest, penalties, additions to tax or 
other assessments or charges, including, but not limited to, income, excise, 
property, withholding, sales, use, gross receipts, value added and franchise 
taxes, license recording, documentation 

                                           A-6 
<PAGE>

and registration fees and custom duties imposed by any Governmental Body.

          "TAX RETURN" means a report, return or other information required 
to be filed by a person with or submitted to a Governmental Body with respect 
to Taxes, including, where permitted or required, combined or consolidated 
returns for any group of entities that includes the person.

          "TERMINATION FEE" has the meaning stated in Section 6.2(d) of this 
Agreement.

          "TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS" means, collectively, means this Agreement, 
the Note, the Registration Rights Agreement, the Amendment and all other 
instruments and documents executed and delivered by any person in connection 
with the conclusion of one or more of the transactions contemplated thereby.

          "TRANSACTIONS" means, collectively, the transactions undertaken 
pursuant to or otherwise contemplated by, the Transaction Documents, 
including, without limitation, the First Closing Transactions and the Second 
Closing Transactions.

          "TRANSFER" means a sale, an assignment, a lease, a license, a 
grant, a transfer or other disposition of an asset or any interest of any 
nature in an asset.  The term "TRANSFER" used as a verb has a correlative 
meaning.

          "WHOLLY-OWNED SUBSIDIARY" of a person means any Subsidiary all of 
the shares of capital stock or other ownership interests of which, except 
directors' qualifying shares, are at the time directly or indirectly owned by 
the person.




















                                           A-6 
<PAGE>


                                                                     Exhibit A
                                                                        to
                                                                     Appendix C



                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

                             CONVERTIBLE PROMISSORY NOTE 
                                DUE DECEMBER 31, 1996


THIS NOTE AND THE SHARES OF COMMON STOCK ISSUABLE UPON THE CONVERSION HEREOF
HAVE NOT BEEN REGISTERED UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933, AS AMENDED, AND MAY
NOT BE OFFERED, SOLD, TRANSFERRED OR OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF EXCEPT IN COMPLIANCE
WITH SAID ACT.  THIS NOTE AND SUCH SHARES ARE ALSO SUBJECT TO THE RESTRICTIONS
CONTAINED IN A REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT DATED AS OF MAY 29, 1996, A COPY OF
WHICH IS ON FILE AT THE OFFICE OF THE SECRETARY OF THE COMPANY.



$900,000.00                                                  Englewood, Colorado
                                                                    May 29, 1996


         FOR VALUE RECEIVED, INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION, a Colorado
corporation (the "COMPANY"), promises to pay to the order of INTERWEST GROUP,
INC. or its assigns (the "HOLDER"), on December 31, 1996 (or such earlier date
on which the principal amount hereof shall be payable in accordance with the
terms hereof, the "MATURITY DATE"), the principal amount of NINE HUNDRED
THOUSAND AND NO/100 DOLLARS ($900,000.00).

         The unpaid principal amount of this Note shall be prepaid in full on
the date that is 30 days after the earlier to occur of (1) the failure of
shareholders of the Company, at a meeting thereof duly called, noticed and
convened, to approve the Transaction Documents and the Transactions and (2) the
termination of the Share Exchange Agreement by Group pursuant to Section 6.1(a)
of the Share Exchange Agreement.

         The Company also promises to pay interest on the unpaid principal
amount hereof, from the date hereof until paid in full, (a) at the rate of 8.0%
per annum from the date hereof to and including July 28, 1996 or, if the Second
Closing Date shall have occurred on or before July 28, 1996, to and including
August 27, 1996, and (b) at the rate of 12.5% per annum thereafter.  Interest on
this Note shall be payable in arrears on and to the last calendar day of each
month, upon any payment or conversion of this Note (to the extent accrued on the
amount being paid or converted) and at maturity (whether at stated maturity, on
the date of any required prepayment, upon acceleration or otherwise) of this
Note.  Interest shall be computed on the basis of a year of twelve 30-day
months.  Upon the occurrence and during the continuation of

<PAGE>

an Event of Default (as defined below), interest shall accrue at the rate that 
is 3.5% per annum greater than the rate otherwise applicable and interest shall
be payable on demand.

         SECTION 1.  SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT.  This Note is the "Note"
referred to in the Share Exchange Agreement dated as of May 29, 1996 between the
Company and Interwest Group, Inc. (as amended or modified from time to time, the
"SHARE EXCHANGE AGREEMENT"), to which reference is hereby made for a more
complete statement of the terms and conditions under which the indebtedness
evidenced hereby was incurred and is to be repaid.  Terms not otherwise defined
herein have the respective meanings assigned in the Share Exchange Agreement. 
No reference herein to the Share Exchange Agreement and no provision of this
Note or the Share Exchange Agreement shall alter or impair the obligations of
the Company, which are absolute and unconditional, to pay the principal of and
interest on this Note at the place, at the respective times, and in the currency
herein prescribed.

         SECTION 2.  PAYMENT.

              (a)  All payments of principal and interest in respect of this
Note shall be made in lawful money of the United States of America in same day
funds at the office of the Holder located at 12201 East Arapahoe Road, Suite
C10, Englewood, Colorado 80112, or at such other place as shall be designated in
writing by the Holder.  Until notified in writing of the transfer or assignment
of this Note, the Company shall be entitled to deem the Holder or any subsequent
permitted assignee of this Note as the owner and holder of this Note.  Each of
the Holder and any subsequent assignee of this Note agrees, by its acceptance
hereof, that before disposing of this Note or any part hereof it will make a
notation hereon of all principal payments previously made hereunder and of the
date to which interest hereon has been paid; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that the failure
to make a notation of any payment made on this Note shall not limit or otherwise
affect the obligations of the Company hereunder with respect to payments of
principal of or interest on this Note.

              (b)  Whenever any payment on this Note shall be stated to be due
on a day which is not a Business Day, such payment shall be made on the next
succeeding Business Day and such extension of time shall be included in the
computation of the payment of interest on this Note.

              (c)  No principal amount of this Note may be paid before such
principal amount is due, whether at stated maturity, by acceleration or
otherwise, except pursuant to the conversion hereof in accordance with
Section 5.


                                       2
<PAGE>

         SECTION 3.     EVENTS OF DEFAULT.  If any of the following conditions
or events ("EVENTS OF DEFAULT") shall occur:

              (a)  FAILURE TO MAKE PAYMENTS WHEN DUE.  Failure to pay any
amount of principal of this Note when due (whether at stated maturity, on the
date of any required prepayment or upon acceleration, or otherwise), or failure
to pay interest or any other amount due under this Note on or before the fifth
day after the date due; or

              (b)  DEFAULT IN OTHER AGREEMENTS.  (i) Failure of the Company or
any of its Subsidiaries (as such term is defined in the Share Exchange
Agreement) to pay when due any principal of or interest on any Debt (other than
this Note) (A) in the aggregate amount of $50,000 beyond the end of any grace
period provided therefor or (B) in any amount beyond 60 days after the end of
any grace period provided therefor; or (ii) breach or default by the Company or
any of its Consolidated Subsidiaries with respect to any other material term of
(A) any evidence of any Debt or (B) any loan agreement, mortgage, indenture or
other agreement relating to such Debt, if the effect of such breach or default
is to cause, or to permit the holder or holders of that Debt (or a trustee on
behalf of such holder or holders) to cause, that Debt to become or be declared
due and payable prior to its stated maturity or the stated maturity of any
underlying obligation, as the case may be (upon the giving or receiving of
notice, lapse of time, both, or otherwise); or (iii) termination of the Share
Exchange Agreement pursuant to paragraph (5) of Section 6.1(a) thereof; or

              (c)  BREACH OF WARRANTY.  Any representation, warranty,
certification or other statement of the Company made in any Transaction Document
or in any statement or certificate at any time given in writing pursuant hereto
or thereto or in connection therewith shall be false in any material respect on
the date as of which made and such default shall not have been remedied or
waived within 30 days after the earlier of (i) the Company's obtaining knowledge
of such default or (ii) receipt by the Company of notice from the Holder of such
default; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that if such default cannot be cured solely by the
payment of money and the cure of such default requires a period in excess of 30
days, and if the Company is diligently and continuously prosecuting such cure,
then such default shall not be an Event of Default unless the Company fails to
cure such default within 90 days after the Company's obtaining knowledge or
notice thereof, as the case may be; or

              (d)  FAILURE OF ENFORCEABILITY.  Any Transaction Document shall,
at any time, cease to be in full force and effect or shall be declared null and
void by a court of competent jurisdiction, or the validity or enforceability
thereof shall be contested by the Company, in each case for any reason other
than the failure of the Holder to take any action within its control; or 

              (e)  OTHER DEFAULTS UNDER TRANSACTION DOCUMENTS.  The Company
shall default in any material respect in the performance of or compliance with
any term contained in any Transaction Document, other than any such term
referred to in any other clause of this subsection, and such default shall not
have been remedied or waived within 30 days after the


                                       3
<PAGE>

earlier of (i) the Company's obtaining knowledge of such default or (ii) 
receipt by the Company of notice from the Holder of such default; PROVIDED,
HOWEVER, that if such default cannot be cured solely by the payment of money
and the cure of such default requires a period in excess of 30 days, and if
the Company is diligently and continuously prosecuting such cure, then such
default shall not be an Event of Default unless the Company fails to cure
such default within 90 days after the Company's obtaining knowledge or notice
thereof, as the case may be; or

              (f)  INVOLUNTARY BANKRUPTCY; APPOINTMENT OF RECEIVER, ETC.  (i) A
court having jurisdiction in the premises shall enter a decree or order for
relief in respect of the Company, in an involuntary case under Title 11 of the
United States Code entitled "Bankruptcy" as now and hereafter in effect, and
any successor statute, (the "BANKRUPTCY CODE") or under any other applicable
bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law now or hereafter in effect, which decree
or order is not stayed; or any other similar relief shall be granted under any
applicable federal or state law; or (ii) an involuntary case shall be commenced
against the Company under the Bankruptcy Code or under any other applicable
bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law now or hereafter in effect; or a decree or
order of a court having jurisdiction in the premises for the appointment of a
receiver, liquidator, sequestrator, trustee, custodian or other officer having
similar powers over the Company or over all or a substantial part of its
property, shall have been entered; or there shall have occurred the involuntary
appointment of an interim receiver, trustee or other custodian of the Company
for all or a substantial part of its property; or a warrant of attachment,
execution or similar process shall have been issued against any substantial part
of the property of the Company, and any such event described in this clause (ii)
shall continue for 60 days unless dismissed, bonded or discharged; or

              (g)  VOLUNTARY BANKRUPTCY; APPOINTMENT OF RECEIVER, ETC. (i) The
Company shall have an order for relief entered with respect to it, in connection
with, or shall commence, a voluntary case under the Bankruptcy Code or under any
other applicable bankruptcy, insolvency or similar law now or hereafter in
effect, or shall consent to the entry of an order for relief in an involuntary
case, or to the conversion of an involuntary case to a voluntary case, under any
such law, or shall consent to the appointment of or taking possession by a
receiver, trustee or other custodian for all or a substantial part of its
property; or the Company shall make any assignment for the benefit of creditors;
or (ii) the Company shall be unable, or shall fail generally, or shall admit in
writing its inability, to pay its debts as such debts become due; or the Board
of Directors (or any committee thereof) of the Company shall adopt any
resolution or otherwise authorize any action to approve any of the actions
referred to in clause (i) above or this clause (ii); or

              (h)  JUDGMENTS AND ATTACHMENTS.  Any money judgment, writ or
warrant of attachment or similar process involving in the aggregate at any time
an amount in excess of $10,000 (not adequately covered by insurance as to which
a solvent and unaffiliated insurance company has acknowledged coverage) shall be
entered or filed against the Company or any of their respective assets and shall
remain undischarged, unvacated, unbonded or unstayed for a period of 60 days (or
in any event later than five days prior to the date of any proposed sale
thereunder); it being understood and agreed that, in the event the Company posts
a bond


                                       4
<PAGE>

pursuant to this Section 3(h), such bond shall not be considered Debt of
the Company for purposes of this Note; or

              (i)  DISSOLUTION.  Any order, judgment or decree shall be entered
against the Company decreeing the dissolution or split up of the Company and
such order shall remain undischarged or unstayed for a period in excess of 30
days; or

              (j)  EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS.  There shall occur one or more
Employee Plan Events which individually or in the aggregate results in or might
reasonably be expected to result in liability of the Company or any of its ERISA
Affiliates in excess of $10,000 on or before the Maturity Date; or there shall
exist an amount of unfunded benefit liabilities (as defined in
Section 4001(a)(18) of ERISA), individually or in the aggregate for all Employee
Plans (excluding for purposes of such computation any Employee Plans with
respect to which assets exceed benefit liabilities and all Multiemployer Plans),
which exceeds $10,000;

then, (A) upon the occurrence of any Event of Default described in Section 3(f)
or 3(g), each of (1) the unpaid principal amount of and accrued interest on this
Note and (2) all other Obligations shall automatically become immediately due
and payable, without notice, presentment, demand, protest or other requirements
of any kind, all of which are hereby expressly waived by the Company, and
(B) upon the occurrence and during the continuance of any other Event of
Default, the Holder may, by written notice to the Company, declare all or any
portion of the amounts described in clauses (1) and (2) above to be, and the
same shall forthwith become, immediately due and payable.

         SECTION 4.     REMEDIES.

              (a)  Upon the occurrence and during the continuation of an Event
of Default, all or any one or more of the rights, powers, privileges and other
remedies available to the Holder against the Company under this Note (including,
without limitation, the conversion of this Note pursuant to Section 5) or any of
the other Transaction Documents, or at law or in equity, may be exercised by the
Holder at any time and from time to time, whether or not all or any portion of
the obligations hereunder shall be declared due and payable.  Any such actions
taken by the Holder shall be cumulative and concurrent and may be pursued
independently, singly, successively, together or otherwise, at such time and in
such order as the Holder may determine in its sole discretion, to the fullest
extent permitted by law, without impairing or otherwise affecting the other
rights and remedies of the Holder permitted by law, equity or contract or as set
forth herein or in the other Transaction Documents.

              (b)  The rights, powers and remedies of the Holder under this
Note shall be cumulative and not exclusive of any other right, power or remedy
which the Holder may have against the Company pursuant to the Share Exchange
Agreement, this Note or the other Transaction Documents or existing at law or in
equity or otherwise.  The rights, powers and remedies of the Holder may be
pursued singly, concurrently or otherwise, at such time and in such order as the
Holder may determine in its sole discretion.  No delay or omission to exercise


                                       5

<PAGE>

any remedy, right or power accruing upon an Event of Default shall impair any
such remedy, right or power or shall be construed as a waiver thereof, but any
such remedy, right or power may be exercised from time to time and as often as
may be deemed expedient.  A waiver of any Event of Default with respect to the
Company shall not be construed to be a waiver of any subsequent Event of Default
by the Company or to impair any remedy, right or power consequent thereon.

              (c)  The remedies set forth in this Section 4 are subject to the
provisions of Section 8. 

         SECTION 5.  CONVERSION.

              (a)  OPTIONAL CONVERSION FOLLOWING MATURITY DATE.  This Note may
be converted into shares of Common Stock, as follows:

         (1)  If the principal amount hereof and all interest accrued thereon
    shall not have been paid in full on the Maturity Date (whether at stated
    maturity, on the date of any required prepayment, upon acceleration or
    otherwise), then, during the period commencing on the day following the
    Maturity Date and ending at the close of business on the date that is 45
    days after the Maturity Date, and subject to and upon compliance with the
    provisions of this Section 5, at the option of the Holder, this Note or any
    portion of the principal amount hereof which is $1,000 or an integral
    multiple thereof, may be converted at the principal amount thereof into
    shares of Common Stock, as said shares shall be constituted on the date on
    which this Note shall be surrendered for conversion and notice given in
    accordance with the provisions of this Section (the "CONVERSION DATE"), at
    the Conversion Price (as defined below) in effect at the Conversion Date.

         (2)  In order to exercise the conversion privilege, the Holder shall
    surrender this Note to the Company at its executive offices, together with
    the conversion notice in the form attached hereto as Exhibit A (or similar
    separate written notice) duly executed, and, if so required by the Company,
    accompanied by instruments of transfer, in form satisfactory to the
    Company, duly executed by the Holder or by its duly authorized attorney in
    writing.  As promptly as practicable after the surrender of this Note for
    conversion as aforesaid, the Company shall deliver at its executive office
    to such Holder, or on its written order, a certificate or certificates for
    the number of full shares of Common Stock deliverable upon the conversion
    of this Note or portion thereof (the "CONVERSION SHARES") and a check or
    cash in respect of any fraction of a share of Common Stock otherwise
    deliverable upon such conversion, all as provided in this Section 5,
    together with a Note in principal amount equal to the unconverted and
    unredeemed portion, if any, of this Note so converted.  Such conversion
    shall be deemed to have been effected on the date on which such notice
    shall have been received at said executive offices and this Note shall have
    been surrendered as aforesaid, and the person or persons in whose name or
    names any certificate or certificates for Conversion Shares


                                       6
<PAGE>

    shall be deliverable upon such conversion shall be deemed to have become 
    on said date the holder or holders of record of the shares represented 
    thereby; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that any such surrender on any date when the 
    stock transfer books of the Company shall be closed shall constitute the 
    person or persons in whose name or names the certificates are to be 
    delivered as the record holder or holders thereof for all purposes on the 
    next succeeding day on which such stock transfer books are open, but such
    conversion shall be at the Conversion Price in effect on the date of such
    surrender.  Subject to the foregoing, no payment or adjustment shall be
    made for dividends on any Shares that shall be delivered upon the
    conversion of this Note.

         (3)  Notwithstanding any other provision hereof, (A) if the conversion
    of any principal amount of this Note is to be made in connection with a
    Business Combination Transaction, the exercise of the conversion privilege
    may at the election of the Holder be conditioned upon the conclusion of
    such transaction, in which case such exercise shall not be deemed to be
    effective until the conclusion of such transaction and (B) if the issuance
    of any Conversion Shares pursuant to the conversion of any principal amount
    of this Note is not exempt from the applicable requirements under the Hart-
    Scott-Rodino Act, the exercise of the conversion privilege shall be 
    conditioned upon the compliance by the Company, the Holder and all other 
    persons with such requirements, in which case such exercise shall not be 
    deemed to be effective until all such requirements are satisfied.  The 
    Holder may by written notice withdraw any such exercise of such conversion 
    privilege before the effectiveness thereof.  Any such exercise or withdrawal
    shall not impair or otherwise affect the other rights and remedies of the 
    Holder permitted by law, equity or contract or as set forth herein or in the
    other Transaction Documents.

              (b)  FRACTIONAL INTERESTS.  The Company shall not be required to
deliver fractions of shares of Common Stock upon conversions of this Note.  If
any fractional interest in a share of Common Stock would be deliverable upon the
conversion of this Note, the Company shall make an adjustment therefor in cash
equal to the average market price per share (determined as provided below) of
the Common Stock on the Conversion Date.

              (c)  MECHANICAL ADJUSTMENTS.  The number of Conversion Shares
issuable upon the conversion of this Note and the Conversion Price shall be
subject to adjustment from time to time, as follows:

         (1)  If the Company shall at any time pay a dividend on its Common
    Stock in shares of its Common Stock (including, if applicable, shares of
    Common Stock held by the Company in treasury or by a Subsidiary), subdivide
    its outstanding shares of Common Stock into a larger number of shares or
    combine its outstanding shares of Common Stock into a smaller number of
    shares or otherwise effect a reclassification or recapitalization of the
    Common Stock, then in each such case the number of Conversion Shares
    thereafter issuable upon conversion of this Note shall be adjusted so that
    this Note shall thereafter be convertible into the number of Conversion
    Shares equal to the number of shares of Common Stock which the Holder would
    have held after the occurrence of


                                       7

<PAGE>

    any of the events described above had this Note been exercised in full 
    immediately prior to the occurrence of such event.  An adjustment made 
    pursuant to this paragraph (1) shall become effective retroactively to 
    the related record date in the case of a dividend and shall become effective
    on the related effective date in the case of a subdivision, combination, 
    reclassification or recapitalization.

         (2)  Except with respect to Permitted Issuances, if the Company or a
    Subsidiary shall at any time issue or sell shares of Common Stock at a
    purchase price per share of Common Stock (the value of any consideration,
    if other than cash, to be determined in good faith by the Board of
    Directors) less than the Average Market Price per share (determined as
    provided below) of the Common Stock on the date of issuance or sale (for
    the purpose of this paragraph (2), the "ADJUSTMENT DATE"), then in each
    such case, the number of Conversion Shares thereafter issuable upon
    conversion of this Note after such Adjustment Date shall be determined by
    multiplying the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of
    this Note on the date immediately preceding such Adjustment Date by a
    fraction, the numerator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares
    of Common Stock outstanding on such date of issuance or sale and the number
    of additional shares of Common Stock so issued or sold, and the denominator
    of which shall be the sum of the number of shares of Common Stock
    outstanding on such date of issuance or sale and the number of shares of
    Common Stock which the aggregate offering price of the total number of
    shares so offered would purchase at such Average Market Price.  For the
    purposes of this paragraph (2), the number of shares of Common Stock at any
    time outstanding shall not include shares held in the treasury of the
    Company or by a Subsidiary.

         (3)  If the Company or a Subsidiary shall at any time issue or sell
    Derivative Securities (as defined below) providing for the purchase of
    shares of Common Stock upon the conversion, exchange or exercise thereof at
    a price per share of Common Stock (taking into account any consideration
    received by the Company upon the issuance or sale of such Derivative
    Securities and any additional consideration to be received upon the
    conversion, exchange or exercise thereof, the value of such consideration,
    if other than cash, to be determined in good faith by the Board of
    Directors) less than the Average Market Price per share (determined as
    provided below) of the Common Stock on the date of issuance or sale (for
    the purpose of this paragraph (3), the "ADJUSTMENT DATE"), then in each
    such case, the number of Conversion Shares thereafter issuable upon
    conversion of this Note after such Adjustment Date shall be determined by
    multiplying the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of
    this Note on the date immediately preceding such Adjustment Date by a
    fraction, the numerator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares
    of Common Stock outstanding on such Adjustment Date and the number of
    additional shares of Common Stock so offered for subscription or purchase
    upon the conversion, exchange or exercise of such Derivative Securities,
    and the denominator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares of
    Common Stock outstanding on such Adjustment Date and the number of shares
    of Common Stock which the aggregate offering price of the total number of
    shares so offered would purchase at


                                       8

<PAGE>

    such Average Market Price.  Such adjustment shall be made whenever any such
    Derivative Securities are issued, and shall become effective on the date of
    issuance retroactive to the Adjustment Date.  If all the shares of Common 
    Stock so offered for subscription or purchase are not delivered upon the 
    final conversion, exchange or exercise of such Derivative Securities, then,
    upon the final conversion, exchange or exercise of such Derivative 
    Securities, or the expiration, cancellation or other termination thereof, 
    the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of this Note shall 
    thereafter be readjusted to the number of Conversion Shares which would have
    been in effect had the numerator and the denominator of the foregoing 
    fraction and the resulting adjustment been made based upon the number of 
    shares of Common Stock actually delivered upon the conversion, exchange or 
    exercise of such Derivative Securities, or the expiration, cancellation or 
    other termination thereof rather than upon the number of shares of Common 
    Stock so offered for subscription or purchase.  If the purchase price 
    provided for in any Derivative Securities, the additional consideration, 
    if any, payable upon the conversion, exchange or exercise of any Derivative
    Securities or the rate at which any Derivative Securities are convertible
    into or exchangeable or convertible into Common Stock shall change at any
    time (including, without limitation, at the time of or after such
    conversion, exchange or exercise), the number of Conversion Shares issuable
    upon conversion of this Note in effect at the time of such change shall be
    readjusted to the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of
    this Note which would have been in effect at such time had such Derivative
    Securities still outstanding provided for such changed purchase price,
    additional consideration or changed conversion rate, as the case may be, on
    the related Adjustment Date, and such readjustment shall become effective
    on the date of such change retroactive to the Adjustment Date; PROVIDED,
    that no such readjustment shall have the effect of decreasing the number of
    Conversion Shares issuable upon the conversion of this Note by an amount in
    excess of the amount of the adjustment initially made with respect to the
    issuance or sale of the Derivative Securities.  For the purposes of this
    paragraph (3), the number of shares of Common Stock at any time outstanding
    shall not include shares held in the treasury of the Company or by a
    Subsidiary.

         (4)  If the Company shall at any time declare or pay a dividend or
    other distribution on its Common Stock other than a stock dividend payable
    solely in shares of Common Stock or a cash dividend paid out of current
    earnings (the value of any such dividend or other distribution, if other
    than cash, to be determined in good faith by the Board of Directors), then
    in each such case, the number of Conversion Shares thereafter issuable upon
    conversion of this Note after the declaration date therefor (for the
    purpose of this paragraph (4), the "ADJUSTMENT DATE") shall be determined
    by multiplying the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of
    this Note on the date immediately preceding such Adjustment Date by a
    fraction, the numerator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares
    of Common Stock outstanding on such Adjustment Date and the number of
    additional shares of Common Stock which the aggregate value of such
    dividend or distribution would purchase at such Average Market Price and
    the denominator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares of Common
    Stock

                                       9

<PAGE>

    outstanding on such Adjustment Date.  For the purposes of this paragraph
    (4), the number of shares of Common Stock at any time outstanding shall
    not include shares held in the treasury of the Company or by a Subsidiary.

         (5)  If the Company or a Subsidiary shall at any time purchase shares
    of Common Stock at a price per share of Common Stock (the value of any
    consideration, if other than cash, to be determined in good faith by the
    Board of Directors) less the Average Market Price per share (determined as
    provided below) of the Common Stock on the date of such purchase (for the
    purpose of this paragraph (5), the "ADJUSTMENT DATE"), then in each such
    case, the number of Conversion Shares thereafter issuable upon conversion
    of this Note after such Adjustment Date shall be determined by multiplying
    the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of this Note on
    the date immediately preceding such Adjustment Date by a fraction, the
    numerator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares of Common Stock
    outstanding on such Adjustment Date and the number of additional shares of
    Common Stock which the aggregate purchase price of the total number of
    shares so purchased would purchase at such Average Market Price and the
    denominator of which shall be the sum of the number of shares of Common
    Stock outstanding on such Adjustment Date and the number of shares of
    Common Stock so purchased.  For the purposes of this paragraph (5), the
    number of shares of Common Stock at any time outstanding shall not include
    shares held in the treasury of the Company or by a Subsidiary.

         (6)  In case of any capital reorganization or any reclassification
    (other than a change in par value) of the capital stock of the Company, or
    of any exchange or conversion of the Common Stock for or into securities of
    another corporation, or in case of the consolidation or merger of the
    Company with or into any other person (other than a merger which does not
    result in any reclassification, conversion, exchange or cancellation of
    outstanding shares of Common Stock) or in case of any sale or conveyance of
    all or substantially all of the assets of the Company, the person formed by
    such consolidation or resulting from such capital reorganization,
    reclassification or merger or which acquires such assets, as the case may
    be, shall make provision such that this Note shall thereafter be
    convertible into the kind and amount of shares of stock, other securities,
    cash and other property receivable upon such capital reorganization,
    reclassification of capital stock, consolidation, merger, sale or
    conveyance, as the case may be, by a holder of the shares of Common Stock
    equal to the number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of this
    Note immediately prior to the effective date of such capital
    reorganization, reclassification of capital stock, consolidation, merger,
    sale or conveyance, assuming (1) such holder of Common Stock of the Company
    is not a person with which the Company consolidated or into which the
    Company merged or which merged into the Company or to which such sale or
    transfer was made as the case may be ("CONSTITUENT ENTITY"), or an
    affiliate of a constituent entity, and (2) such person failed to exercise
    his rights of election, if any, as to the kind or amount of securities,
    cash and other property receivable upon such capital reorganization,
    reclassification of capital stock, consolidation, merger, sale or
    conveyance and, in any case appropriate

                                       10
<PAGE>

    adjustment (as determined by the Board of Directors) shall be made in the 
    application of the provisions herein set forth with respect to rights and 
    interests thereafter of the Holder, to the end that the provisions set forth
    herein (including the specified changes in and other adjustments of the 
    number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of this Note) shall 
    thereafter be applicable, as near as reasonably may be, in relating to any
    shares of stock or other securities or other property thereafter deliverable
    upon conversion of this Note.

         (7)  For the purposes of this Section 5:

              (A)  "AVERAGE MARKET PRICE" per share of Common Stock on any date
         means the average of the daily Closing Prices for the fifteen (15)
         consecutive Trading Days commencing twenty (20) Trading Days before
         the date of declaration or authorization by the Board of Directors of
         the Company of such issuance or distribution;

               (B) "CLOSING PRICE" means the last reported sales price, regular
         way, per share of Common Stock on such day, or if no such sale takes
         place on such day, the average of the closing bid and asked prices,
         regular way, in each case, as reported in the principal consolidated
         transaction reporting system with respect to securities listed or
         admitted to trading on a national securities exchange, or, if shares
         of such stock are not listed or admitted to trading on a national
         securities exchange, on the NASDAQ/National Market System or the
         NASDAQ/Small Cap market, as the case may be, or, if such last sales
         price or closing bid and asked prices are not so reported, the average
         of the closing bid and asked prices as furnished by any New York Stock
         Exchange member firm selected from time to time by the Board of
         Directors for such purpose, or if no such prices are available, the
         fair market value of the Common Stock as determined in good faith by
         the Board of Directors; 

              (C)  "DERIVATIVE SECURITIES" means securities convertible into or
         exchangeable or convertible into shares of Common Stock, rights or
         warrants to subscribe for or purchase shares of Common Stock, options
         for the purchase of, or calls, commitments or other claims of any
         character relating to, shares of Common Stock or any securities
         convertible into or exchangeable for any of the foregoing; and

              (D)  "PERMITTED ISSUANCES" means the issuance of shares of Common
         Stock after the date of this Note (i) pursuant to the exercise of
         Outstanding Options, in each case in accordance with the terms thereof
         as of the date of this Note, (ii) pursuant to the conversion of this
         Note and (iii) with the approval of Holder, which approval may be
         granted, withheld, conditioned or delayed in its sole discretion.

                                       11

<PAGE>

         (8)  If any shares of Common Stock or Derivative Securities are issued
    or sold or deemed to have been issued or sold for cash, the consideration
    received therefor shall be deemed to be the net amount received by the
    Company therefor.  In case any shares of Common Stock or Derivative
    Securities are issued or sold for a consideration other than cash, the
    amount of the consideration other than cash received by the Company shall
    be the fair value of such consideration, except where such consideration
    consists of marketable securities, in which case the amount of
    consideration received by the Company shall be the market price thereof as
    of the date of receipt.  In case any shares of Common Stock or Derivative
    Securities are issued to the owners of the non-surviving entity in
    connection with any merger or other business combination in which the
    Company is the surviving entity, the amount of consideration therefor shall
    be deemed to be the fair value of such portion of the net assets and
    business of the non-surviving entity as is attributable to such shares of
    Common Stock or Securities, as the case may be.  The fair value of any
    consideration other than cash or marketable securities shall be determined
    jointly by the Company and the Holder.  If such parties are unable to reach
    agreement within a reasonable period of time, such fair value shall be
    determined by an appraiser jointly selected by the Holder, whose
    determination shall be final and binding on the Company and the Holder. 
    The fees and expenses of such appraiser shall be paid by the Company.

         (9)  If the Company takes a record of the holders of Common Stock for
    the purpose of entitling them (A) to receive a dividend or other
    distribution on its Common Stock or (B) to subscribe for or purchase shares
    of Common Stock or Derivative Securities, then such record date shall be
    deemed to be the date of the payment or distribution of such dividend or
    other distribution or the date of issuance and sale of any shares of Common
    Stock deemed to have been issued or sold in connection thereto.

         (10) All calculations under this Section 5 shall be made to the
    nearest one-thousandth of a share of Common Stock.

         (11) The price payable by the Holder for the issuance of Conversion
    Shares by the Company upon conversion of this Note (the "CONVERSION PRICE")
    is $3.00 per Conversion Share at the date of this Note.  Whenever the
    number of Conversion Shares issuable upon the conversion of this Note is
    adjusted or readjusted pursuant to paragraphs (1) through (10), inclusive,
    above, the Conversion Price payable upon conversion of this Note shall be
    adjusted or readjusted by multiplying the Conversion Price immediately
    prior to the related Adjustment Date by a fraction, the numerator of which
    shall be the number of Conversion Shares purchasable upon the conversion of
    this Note immediately preceding such Adjustment Date, and the denominator
    of which shall be the number of Conversion Shares so purchasable
    immediately thereafter; PROVIDED that no such readjustment pursuant to
    paragraph (3) above with respect to the conversion, exchange or exercise,
    or expiration, cancellation or other termination, of any Derivative
    Securities shall have the effect of increasing the Conversion Price by an
    amount in excess of the

                                       12

<PAGE>

    amount of the adjustment initially made in respect of the issuance or sale 
    of such Derivative Securities.

         (12) If any event occurs of the type contemplated by the provisions of
    this Section 5 but not expressly provided for by such provisions
    (including, without limitation, the granting of stock appreciation rights,
    phantom stock rights or other rights with equity features), then the
    Company's board of directors shall make an appropriate adjustment in the
    number of Conversion Shares issuable upon conversion of this Note and the
    Conversion Price so as to protect the rights of the Holder under this Note.

         (13) For the purpose of this Section 5, the term "SHARES OF COMMON
    STOCK" means (A) the class of stock designated as the Common Stock of the
    Company at the date of this Note or (B) any other class of stock resulting
    from successive changes or reclassification of such shares consisting
    solely of changes in par value, or from par value to no par value, or from
    no par value to par value.  In the event that at any time, as a result of
    an adjustment made pursuant to paragraphs (1) through (4), inclusive,
    above, the Holder shall become entitled to receive any shares of the
    Company other than shares of Common Stock, thereafter the number of such
    other shares so receivable upon conversion of this Note and the Conversion
    Price shall be subject to adjustment from time to time in a manner and on
    terms as nearly equivalent as practicable to the provisions with respect to
    the Conversion Shares contained in paragraphs (1) through (4), inclusive,
    above, and the provisions of Sections 5(d), 5(e) and 5(f), inclusive, with
    respect to the Conversion Shares, shall apply on like terms to any such
    other shares.

         (14) Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, there shall be
    no adjustment in the number of Conversion Shares or in the Conversion Price
    in respect of Permitted Issuances.

         (15) In case of any consolidation or merger of the Company with or
    into another entity (whether or not the Company is the surviving entity) or
    in case of any sale, transfer or lease of all or substantially all of the
    assets of the Company, the Company or such successor or purchasing entity,
    as the case may be, shall execute with the Holder an agreement that the
    Holder shall have the right thereafter upon payment of the Conversion Price
    in effect immediately prior to such action to purchase upon conversion of
    this Note the kind and amount of shares and other securities, cash and
    property that the Holder would have owned or would have been entitled to
    receive after the happening of such consolidation, merger, sale, transfer,
    lease or conveyance had this Note been exercised in full immediately prior
    to such action, and if the successor or purchasing entity is not a
    corporation, such person shall provide appropriate tax indemnification with
    respect to such shares or other securities and property so that upon
    conversion of this Note, the Holder would have the same benefits it
    otherwise would have had if such successor or purchasing person were a
    corporation.  Such agreement shall provide for adjustments that shall be as
    nearly equivalent as may be practicable to the adjustments provided for in
    paragraphs (1) through (14), inclusive, above.  The

                                       13
<PAGE>

    provisions of this paragraph (15) shall similarly apply to successive 
    consolidations, mergers, sales or conveyances.

              (d)  TIME OF ADJUSTMENTS.  Each adjustment required by Section
5(c) shall be effective as and when the event requiring such adjustment occurs.

              (e)  NOTICE OF ADJUSTMENT.  Whenever the number of Conversion
Shares purchasable upon the conversion of this Note or the Conversion Price is
adjusted as herein provided, the Company shall promptly mail by first class
mail, postage prepaid, to each Holder a certificate of a firm of independent
public accountants selected by the Board of Directors of the Company (who may be
the regular accountants employed by the Company) setting forth the number of
Conversion Shares purchasable upon the conversion of this Note and the
Conversion Price after such adjustment, setting forth a brief statement of the
facts requiring such adjustment and setting forth the computation by which such
adjustment was made.  Such certificate shall be conclusive evidence of the
correctness of such adjustment.

              (f)  NO ADJUSTMENT FOR DIVIDENDS.  Except as provided in Section
5(c), no adjustment in respect of any dividends declared or paid on the Common
Stock shall be made during the term of this Note or upon the conversion of this
Note.

              (g)  TAXES.  The issue of stock certificates on conversions of
this Note shall be made without charge to the Holder for any tax in respect of
the issue thereof.  The Company shall not, however, be required to pay any tax
which may be payable in respect of any transfer involved in the issue and
delivery of shares in any name other than that of the Holder, and the Company
shall not be required to issue or deliver any such stock certificate unless and
until the person or persons requesting the issue thereof shall have paid to the
Company the amount of such tax or shall have established to the satisfaction of
the Company that such tax has been paid.

              (h)  RESERVATION OF SHARES.  The Company shall at all times
reserve and keep available out of the aggregate of its authorized but unissued
shares or its issued shares held in its treasury, or both, for the purpose of
effecting the conversion of this Note, such number of its duly authorized shares
of Common Stock as shall from time to time be sufficient to effect the
conversion, exchange or exercise of outstanding securities of the Company
convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for any shares of the Common
Stock, all rights to subscribe for or to purchase, all options for the purchase
of, and all calls, commitments or claims of any character relating to, any
shares of Common Stock and any securities convertible into or exchangeable or
exercisable for any of the foregoing.

              (i)  REGISTRATION OR APPROVAL.  If any shares of Common Stock
reserved or to be reserved for the purpose of conversion of this Note require
registration with or approval of any governmental authority under any federal or
state law before such shares may be validly delivered upon conversion,
including, without limitation, the Hart-Scott-Rodino-Act, then the

                                       14

<PAGE>

Company covenants that it will in good faith and as expeditiously as possible 
endeavor to secure such registration or approval, as the case may be.

              (j)  VALIDLY ISSUED, ETC.  The Company covenants that all shares
of Common Stock which may be delivered upon conversion of this Note shall upon
delivery be validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable and free from all
taxes, liens and charges with respect to the issue or delivery thereof.

              (k)  NOTICE.  In the event:

         (1)  that the Company shall pay any dividend or make any distribution
    to the holders of shares of Common Stock otherwise than in cash charged
    against capital surplus, consolidated net earnings or retained earnings of
    the Company and its Subsidiaries; or 

         (2)  that the Company shall offer for subscription or purchase, pro
    rata, to all of the holders of shares of Common Stock any additional shares
    of stock of any class or any securities convertible into or exchangeable
    for stock of any class; or

         (3)  of any reclassification or change of outstanding shares of the
    class of Common Stock issuable upon the conversion of this Note (other than
    a change in par value, or from par value to no par value, or from no par
    value to par value, or as a result of a subdivision or combination), or of
    any merger or consolidation of the Company with, or merger of the Company
    into, another corporation (other than a merger or consolidation in which
    the Company is the continuing corporation and which does not result in any
    reclassification or change of outstanding shares of Common Stock issuable
    upon conversion of this Note), or of any sale or conveyance to another
    corporation of the property of the Company as an entirety or substantially
    as an entirety or of any Business Combination Transaction;

then, and in any one or more of such events, the Company will give to the Holder
written notice thereof at least fifteen days prior to (A) the record date fixed
with respect to any of the events specified in (1) and (2) above, and (B) the
effective date of any of the events specified in (3) above.  Failure to give
such notice, or any defect therein, shall not affect the legality or validity of
such dividend, distribution, reclassification, consolidation, merger, sale,
transfer, dissolution, liquidation or winding up.

              (l)  SPECIFIC PERFORMANCE.  The Company acknowledges that the
failure of the Company to perform its obligations under this Section 5 will not
be compensable by the payment of monetary damages and hereby waives any defense
to a claim by the Holder that the provisions of this Section 5 be specifically
enforced.

                                       15

<PAGE>

         SECTION 6.     LEGENDS.

              (a)  Each certificate for Conversion Shares and any certificate
issued in exchange therefor or on conversion or upon transfer, except
certificates issued in connection with a sale registered under the Securities
Act of 1933, as amended, and except as provided below, shall bear the legends to
the following effects:

         1.   "The shares represented by this certificate have not been
    registered under the Securities Act of 1933 and may not be offered, sold,
    transferred or otherwise disposed of except in compliance with said Act."

         2.   "The shares represented by this certificate are subject to
    restrictions set forth in the Registration Rights Agreement dated as of May
    29, 1996, a copy of which is on file in the office of the Secretary of the
    Company."

              (b)  The legend stated in Section 6(a)(1) shall be removed by
delivery of one or more substitute certificates without such legend if the
holder thereof shall have delivered to the Company a copy of a letter from the
staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission or an opinion of counsel, in
form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Company, to the effect that
the legend is not required for purposes of the Securities Act of 1933, as
amended.

              (c)  The legend stated in Section 6(a)(2) shall be removed at
such time as the Warrant Shares are no longer subject to the Registration Rights
Agreement referenced therein.

         SECTION 7.     COSTS AND EXPENSES.  The Company promises to pay all
costs and expenses, including reasonable attorneys' fees incurred in the
collection and enforcement of this Note.  The Company and any endorsers of this
Note hereby consent to renewals and extensions of time at or after the maturity
hereof, without notice, and hereby waive diligence, presentment, protest, demand
and notice of every kind and, to the full extent permitted by law, the right to
plead any statute of limitations as a defense to any demand hereunder.

         SECTION 8.     THIS NOTE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND SHALL BE CONSTRUED
AND ENFORCED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE INTERNAL LAWS OF THE STATE OF COLORADO.

         SECTION 9.     SEVERABILITY OF PROVISIONS.  Any provision of this Note
that is prohibited or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to  that
jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of the prohibition or
unenforceability without invalidating the remaining provisions of this Note or
affecting the validity or enforceability of the provision in any other
jurisdiction.

         SECTION 10.    HEADINGS AND REFERENCES.  Headings in this Note are
included for the convenience of reference only and do not constitute a part of
this Note for any other

                                       16


<PAGE>

purpose.  References to sections in this Note are
references to the sections of this Note, unless the context shall require
otherwise.

         SECTION 11.    NON-EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION.  Each of the Company and
the Holder, by acceptance hereof, (1) agrees that any legal action with respect
to this Note may be brought in the courts of the State of Colorado or of the
United States of America for the District of Colorado, (2) accepts for itself
and in respect of its property, generally and unconditionally, the jurisdiction
of those courts, and (3) irrevocably waives any objection, including, without
limitation, any objection to the laying of venue or based on the grounds of
FORUM NON  CONVENIENS, which it may now or hereafter have to the bringing of any
legal action in those jurisdictions; PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that each of the Company
and the Holder may assert in a legal action in any other jurisdiction or venue
each defense, third-party claim or similar claim that, if not so asserted in
such legal action, may thereafter not be asserted by such party in an original
legal action in the courts referred to in clause (1) above.

         SECTION 12.    WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL.  Each of the Company and the
Holder, by acceptance hereof, waives any right to a trial by jury in any legal
action to enforce or defend any right under this Note or any amendment,
instrument, document or agreement delivered, or which in the future may be
delivered, in connection with this Note and agrees that any legal action shall
be tried before a court and not before a jury.

         SECTION 13.    NO RECOURSE AGAINST OTHERS.  A director, officer,
employee or stockholder, as such, of the Company shall not have any liability
for any obligations of the Company under this Note or for any claim based on, in
respect of or by reason of, such obligations or its creation.  The Holder by
accepting this Note waives and releases all such liability.  The waiver and
release are part of the consideration for the issue of this Note.


                                       17


         IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this Note to be duly
executed and delivered by its officer thereunto duly authorized as of the date
and at the place first written above.

                                  INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                                  By:
                                       Name:
                                       Title:


                                       18

<PAGE>
                                      EXHIBIT A

                             [FORM OF CONVERSION NOTICE]


TO INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

         The undersigned owner of this Note hereby irrevocably exercises the
option to convert this Note, or portion hereof (which is $1,000 or an integral
multiple thereof) below designated, into shares of Common Stock of the Company
in accordance with the terms of this Note, and directs that the shares issuable
and deliverable upon the conversion, together with any check in payment for
fractional shares and a Note representing any unconverted principal amount
hereof, be issued and delivered to the registered holder hereof unless a
different name has been indicated below.  If shares are to be issued in the name
of a person other than the undersigned, the undersigned will pay all transfer
taxes payable with respect hereto.

Dated:


                                       A-1


<PAGE>
                                                                      Exhibit B
                                                                          to
                                                                      Appendix C


                                     FORM OF

                          REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT


     REGISTRATION RIGHTS AGREEMENT dated as of May 29, 1996 between INTERNET
COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION, a Colorado corporation (the "COMPANY"), and
INTERWEST GROUP, INC., a Colorado corporation (the "STOCKHOLDER").

          Terms not otherwise defined herein have the meanings stated in the
Share Exchange Agreement (as defined below).


                                    RECITALS

          A.   The Company and the Stockholder have executed and delivered the
Share Exchange Agreement dated as of May 29, 1996 (the "SHARE EXCHANGE
AGREEMENT"), pursuant to which, among other things, (1) on the date hereof, the
Stockholder is purchasing the Note from the Company and hereafter may, if the
principal amount of and interest accrued on the Note shall not be paid in full
at the maturity thereof (whether at stated maturity, on the date of any required
prepayment or upon acceleration), acquire the Conversion Shares upon the
conversion of the Note and (2) on the Second Closing Date, if the same shall
occur, the Stockholder will acquire the Additional Shares from the Company.  The
Conversion Shares and the Additional Shares are collectively referred to as the
"REGISTRABLE SHARES".

          B.   The Company and the Stockholder desire to enter into this
Agreement to provide for the registration under the Securities Act of the
disposition of the Registrable Shares and certain other matters.

                                    AGREEMENT

     The parties agree as follows:

SECTION 1.  REGISTRATION RIGHTS.

               (a)  From and after second anniversary of the First Closing Date
on one or more occasions when the Company shall have received the written
request of the Stockholder, any pledgee of Registrable Shares from the
Stockholder or holders of at least 100,000 Registrable Shares in the aggregate
(as such number of shares may be adjusted in the event of any change in


                                       B-1
<PAGE>

the Registerable Shares by reason of stock dividends, split-ups, reverse split-
ups, mergers, recapitalizations, subdivisions, conversions, exchanges of shares
or the like) that shall have been acquired directly or indirectly from the
Stockholder and to which rights under this Section 1(a) shall have been assigned
pursuant to Section 11(a), in each case in a transaction or series of
transactions not constituting a Rule 144 Transaction (as defined in
Section 1(h)) (each such person, when requesting registration under this Section
1(a) or under Section 1(b) and thereafter in connection with any such
registration, being hereinafter referred to as a "REGISTERING STOCKHOLDER"), as
expeditiously as practicable the Company shall register not less than 50,000
Registrable Shares (as such number may be adjusted) specified by the Registering
Stockholder in a Registration Statement (as defined in Section 1(h)).  If the
requested registration pursuant to this Section 1(a) shall involve an
underwritten offering, the Registering Stockholder initiating a request for
registration of Registrable Shares pursuant to this Section 1(a) shall select
(with the consent of the Company, not to be unreasonably withheld) the managing
underwriter in connection with the offering and any additional investment
bankers and managers to be used in connection with the offering. 
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing:

          (1)  the Company shall not be required to prepare and file pursuant to
     this Section 1(a) more than five Registration Statements; PROVIDED that a
     Registration Statement shall be deemed not to have been prepared and filed
     if the same does not become effective; PROVIDED, FURTHER, that if 10% or
     more of the Registrable Shares requested to be registered by the
     Registering Stockholder initiating a request for registration of
     Registrable Shares pursuant to this Section 1(a) are excluded from any
     registration in accordance with Section 1(a)(2), there shall be provided
     one additional registration under this Section (1)(a)(1) in respect of each
     such exclusion; and

          (2)  if a requested registration pursuant to this Section 1(a) shall
     involve an underwritten offering, and if the managing underwriter shall
     advise in writing the Company and the Registering Stockholders that, in its
     opinion, the number of Registrable Shares of any class proposed to be
     included in the registration (including securities of the Company which are
     proposed to be offered by persons other than Registering Stockholders)
     exceeds the number which would have an adverse effect on the offering,
     including the price at which the Registrable Shares can be sold, the
     Company will include in the registration the maximum number of securities
     which it is so advised can be sold without the adverse effect, allocated as
     follows:

               (A)  FIRST, all Registrable Shares owned by Registering 
          Stockholders and requested to be included in such registration (if 
          necessary, allocated pro rata among all Registering Stockholders on
          the basis of the relative number of Registrable Shares each such 
          Registering Stockholder has requested to be included in the 
          registration); and

               (B)  SECOND, any other securities proposed to be included in the
          registration.


                                       B-2
<PAGE>

     (b)  From and after the first anniversary of the First Closing Date, if the
Company shall determine to register or qualify by a registration statement filed
under the Securities Act and under any applicable state securities laws, any
offering of any Equity Securities of the Company, whether pursuant to Section
1(a) or otherwise, the Company shall give notice of such determination to each
potential Registering Stockholder and each other person having rights with
respect to the registration under the Securities Act of the disposition of
securities of the Company (each such potential Registering Stockholder and each
such other person, being hereinafter referred to as a "TRANSACTION REGISTERING
STOCKHOLDER") about which the Company has knowledge; it being understood that
without prior notice to the Company, the Company shall not be deemed to have
knowledge of the existence of any pledgee of Registrable Shares.  The Company
shall, as expeditiously as possible and in good faith, include in the
registration statement such Registrable Shares (the "TRANSACTION REGISTRABLE
SHARES"), as those persons shall specify by notice received by the Company not
later than 30 days after the giving of the notice by the Company (each person so
notifying the Company being hereinafter referred to as a "PIGGY-BACK
STOCKHOLDER").  Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing to the contrary,

          (1)  the Company shall not be required to include any shares owned by
     Piggy-Back Stockholders in a registration statement on Form S-4 or S-8 (or
     any successor form) or a registration statement filed in connection with an
     exchange offer or other offering of securities solely to the then existing
     shareholders of the Company; and

          (2)  if a registration pursuant to this Section 1(b) involves an
     underwritten offering, the Company shall select the managing underwriter
     for the offering and any additional investment bankers and managers to be
     used in connection with the offering, and if the managing underwriter
     advises the Company in writing that, in its opinion, the number of
     securities requested to be included in the registration is so great as
     would adversely affect the offering, including the price at which the
     Registrable Shares can be sold, the Company will include in the
     registration the maximum number of securities which it is so advised can be
     sold without the adverse effect, allocated as follows:

               (A)  FIRST, all securities proposed to be registered by the
     Company for its own account;

               (B)  SECOND, all securities proposed to be registered by the
     Company pursuant to the exercise by any person other than a Registering
     Stockholder of a right to request the registration of securities of Common
     Stock in accordance with an agreement substantially similar to the
     provisions of Section 1(a);

               (C)  THIRD, all Transaction Registrable Shares requested to be
     included in the registration under Section 1(b) of this Agreement (if
     necessary, allocated pro rata among all requesting Transaction Registering
     Stockholders, on the basis of the relative number of Transaction
     Registrable Shares, each Transaction Registering Stockholder has requested
     to be included in the registration); and


                                       B-3
<PAGE>

               (D)  FOURTH, any other securities proposed to be registered by
     the Company other than for its own account, including, without limitation,
     securities proposed to be registered by the Company pursuant to the
     exercise by any person other than a Registering Stockholder of any right in
     accordance with an agreement substantially similar to this Section 1(b);

PROVIDED, HOWEVER, that in no event will the number of Registrable Shares
included in the Registration pursuant to this Section 1(b)(2) be reduced to less
than 10% of the aggregate number of securities included in the registration.

     (c)  The Company shall provide each Registering Stockholder, each
underwriter participating in any disposition pursuant to such registration and
their respective representatives reasonable opportunity for due diligence in
connection with each registration of Registrable Shares of the Registering
Stockholder pursuant to this Section 1.

          (d)  At the request of one or more of the Registering Stockholders or
the Company in connection with any registration pursuant to this Section 1, the
Company and the requesting Registering Stockholders shall enter into an
appropriate underwriting agreement with respect to the Registrable Shares of the
Registering Stockholders containing terms and provisions customary in agreements
of that nature, including provisions with respect to expenses substantially the
same as those set forth in Section 2 and provisions with respect to
indemnification and contribution substantially the same as those set forth in
Section 3.

     (e)  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, the Company shall not
be required to include in any registration pursuant to this Section 1 any
Registrable Shares owned by a Registering Stockholder (1) if the Company shall
deliver to the Registering Stockholder an opinion, satisfactory in form, scope
and substance to the Registering Stockholder and addressed to the Registering
Stockholder by legal counsel satisfactory to the Registering Stockholder, to the
effect that the distribution of Registrable Shares proposed by the Registering
Stockholder is exempt from registration under the Securities Act and all
applicable state securities laws or (2) if such Registering Stockholder or any
underwriter of Registrable Shares shall fail to furnish to the Company the
information in respect of the distribution of the shares that may be required
under this Agreement to be furnished by the Registering Stockholder or the
underwriter to the Company.

     (f)  Upon written notice to each Registering Stockholder, the Company may
postpone effecting a registration pursuant to this Section 1 on one occasion
during any period of nine consecutive months, may require other holders of
shares registered pursuant to this Section 1 to refrain from disposing of the
shares under the registration or may require Transaction Registering
Stockholders to refrain from otherwise disposing of any shares of Equity
Securities of the Company owned by them (whether pursuant to Rule 144 under the
Securities Act or otherwise), in each case for a reasonable time specified in
the notice but not exceeding 90 days (which period may not be extended or
renewed), if (1) an investment banking firm of recognized


                                       B-4
<PAGE>

national standing shall advise the Company and the Registering Stockholders in
writing that effecting the registration or disposition would materially and
adversely affect an offering of Equity Securities of the Company the preparation
of which had then been commenced or (2) the Company is in possession of material
non-public information the disclosure of which during the period specified in
such notice the Company believes would not be in the best interests of the
Company.

     (g)  In the event the registration of Registrable Shares shall be required
by this Section 1:

     (1)  Each Registering Stockholder shall furnish, and shall cause each
     underwriter of the Registrable Shares of the Registering Stockholder to be
     distributed pursuant to the registration to furnish, to the Company in
     writing promptly upon the request of the Company the additional information
     regarding the Registering Stockholder or the underwriter, the contemplated
     distribution of the Registrable Shares and the other information regarding
     the proposed distribution by the Registering Stockholder and the
     underwriter that shall be required in connection with the proposed
     distribution by the applicable securities laws of the United States of
     America and the states thereof in which the Registrable Shares are
     contemplated to be distributed.  The information furnished by any
     Registering Stockholder or any underwriter shall be certified by the
     Registering Stockholder or the underwriter, as the case may be, and shall
     be stated to be specifically for use in connection with the registration.

     (2)  The Company shall prepare and file with the Securities and Exchange
     Commission the Registration Statement, including the Prospectus (as defined
     in Section 1(h)), under the Securities Act and as required under any
     applicable state securities laws, on the form that is then required or
     available for use by the Company to permit each Registering Stockholder,
     upon the effective date of the Registration Statement, to use the
     Prospectus in connection with the contemplated distribution by the
     Registering Stockholder of the Registrable Shares so registered.  If any
     Registration Statement refers to any Registering Stockholder by name or
     otherwise as the holder of any securities of the Company, then the
     Registering Stockholder shall have the right to require, in the event that
     such reference to the Registering Stockholder by name or otherwise is not
     required by the Securities Act or any similar federal statute then in
     force, the deletion of the reference to the Registering Stockholder.  The
     Company shall deliver to each Registering Stockholder, without charge, one
     executed copy of the Registration Statement and each amendment or post-
     effective amendment thereof and one copy of each document incorporated
     therein by reference.  If the registration shall have been initiated solely
     by the Company or shall not have been initiated by the Registering
     Stockholder, the Company shall not be obligated to prosecute the
     registration, and may withdraw the Registration Statement at any time prior
     to the effectiveness thereof, if the Company shall determine in good faith
     not to proceed with the offering of securities included in the Registration
     Statement.  In all other cases, the Company shall use its best efforts to
     cause the


                                       B-5
<PAGE>

     Registration Statement to become effective and, as soon as practicable
     after the effectiveness thereof, shall deliver to each Registering
     Stockholder evidence of the effectiveness and a reasonable supply of copies
     of the Prospectus.  In addition, if necessary for resale by the Registering
     Stockholders, the Company shall qualify or register in such states as may
     be reasonably requested by each Registering Stockholder the Registrable
     Shares of the Registering Stockholder that shall have been included in the
     Registration Statement; PROVIDED that the Company shall not be obligated to
     file any general consent to service of process or to qualify as a foreign
     corporation in any state in which it is not subject to process or qualified
     as of the date of the request.

     (3)  The Company shall use its best efforts to cause the Registration
     Statement and the Prospectus to remain effective or current, as the case
     may be, including the filing of necessary amendments, post-effective
     amendments and supplements, and shall furnish copies of such amendments,
     post-effective amendments and supplements to the Registering Stockholders,
     so as to permit distributions by the Registering Stockholders during the
     respective contemplated periods of distribution, but in no event longer
     than six consecutive months from the effective date of the Registration
     Statement; PROVIDED that the period shall be increased by the number of
     days that any Registering Stockholder shall have been required by Section
     1(f) to refrain from disposing of the Registrable Shares owned by the
     Registering Stockholder in the distribution.  During such respective
     contemplated periods of distribution, the Company shall comply with the
     provisions of the Securities Act applicable to it with respect to the
     disposition of all Registrable Shares that shall have been included in the
     Registration Statement in accordance with the intended methods of
     disposition by the Registering Stockholders set forth in the Registration
     Statement, the Prospectus or the supplement, as the case may be.  The
     Company shall not be deemed to have used its best efforts to cause the
     Registration Statement to remain effective during the applicable period if
     it voluntarily takes any action (other than an action required under
     applicable law) that would result in the Registering Stockholders not being
     able to dispose of the Registrable Shares during that period in accordance
     with the intended methods of disposition.  The Company shall notify each
     Registering Stockholder, at any time when a prospectus with respect to the
     Registrable Shares is required to be delivered under the Securities Act,
     when the Company becomes aware of the happening of any event as a result of
     which the Prospectus (as then in effect) contains any untrue statement of a
     material fact or omits to state a material fact necessary to make the
     statements therein (in the case of the Prospectus or any preliminary
     prospectus, in light of the circumstances under which they were made) not
     misleading and, as promptly as practicable thereafter, prepare and file
     with the Securities and Exchange Commission an amendment or supplement to
     the Registration Statement or the Prospectus so that, as thereafter
     delivered to the purchasers of such Registrable Shares, such Prospectus
     will not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a
     material fact necessary to make the statements therein, in light of the
     circumstances under which they were made, not misleading.  The Company
     shall make every reasonable effort to obtain the withdrawal of any order
     suspending the effectiveness of the Registration Statement at the earliest
     possible


                                       B-6
<PAGE>


     moment.  Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing to the contrary, the
     Company may at any time upon notice to each Registering Stockholder
     terminate the effectiveness of the Registration Statement or upon notice to
     any Registering Stockholder withdraw from the Registration Statement the
     Registrable Shares of the Registering Stockholder if, in the opinion of
     counsel for the Company, there shall have arisen any legal impediment to
     the offer of the Registrable Shares made by the Prospectus or if any legal
     action or administrative proceeding shall have been instituted or
     threatened or any other claim shall have been made relating to the offer
     made by the Prospectus or against any of the parties involved in the offer;
     PROVIDED that, promptly after those matters shall be resolved to the
     satisfaction of counsel for the Company, pursuant to this Section 1 the
     Company shall cause the registration of Registrable Shares formerly covered
     by the Registration Statement that were removed from registration by the
     action of the Company.

          (4)  If requested by any Registering Stockholder or an underwriter,
     the Company shall as promptly as practicable prepare and file with the
     Securities and Exchange Commission an amendment or supplement to the
     Registration Statement or the Prospectus containing such information as the
     Registering Stockholder or the underwriter requests to be included therein,
     including, without limitation, information with respect to the Registrable
     Shares being sold by the Registering Stockholder to the underwriter, the
     purchase price being paid therefor by such underwriter and other terms of
     the underwritten offering of the Registrable Shares to be sold in such
     offering.

     (5)  Each Registering Stockholder shall report to the Company distributions
     made by the Registering Stockholder of Registrable Shares pursuant to the
     Prospectus and, upon written notice by the Company that an event has
     occurred as a result of which an amendment or supplement to the
     Registration Statement or the Prospectus is required, the Registering
     Stockholder shall cease further distributions pursuant to the Prospectus
     until notified by the Company of the effectiveness of the amendment or
     supplement.  Each Registering Stockholder shall distribute Registrable
     Shares  only in accordance with the manner of distribution contemplated by
     the Prospectus with respect to the Registrable Shares.  Each Registering
     Stockholder, by participating in a registration pursuant to this Section 1,
     acknowledges that the remedies of the Company at law for failure by the
     Registering Stockholder to comply with the undertaking contained in this
     Section 1(g) would be inadequate and that the failure would not be
     adequately compensable in damages and would cause irreparable harm to the
     Company, and therefore agrees that undertakings made by the Registering
     Stockholder in this Section 1(g) may be specifically enforced.

     (6)  The Company shall deliver to the Registering Stockholders, their
     counsel and the underwriters, if any, of Registrable Shares owned by
     Registering Stockholders to be distributed pursuant to such registration,
     the certificates, opinions of counsel and comfort letters that are
     customarily delivered in connection with underwritten public offerings.


                                       B-7
<PAGE>

          (7)  The Company shall cooperate with each Registering Stockholder and
     each underwriter to facilitate the timely preparation and delivery of
     certificates (not bearing any restrictive legends) representing Registrable
     Shares to be sold under the Registration Statement, and enable such
     Registrable Shares to be in such denominations and registered in such names
     as the Registering Stockholder or the underwriter may request.

     (8)  The Company shall use its best efforts to comply with all applicable
     rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission, and make
     available to its securityholders, as soon as reasonably practicable, an
     earnings statement covering the period of at least twelve months, but not
     more than eighteen months, beginning with the first calendar month after
     the effective date of the Registration Statement, which earnings statement
     shall satisfy the provisions of Section 11(a) of the Securities Act.

          (9)  The Company shall take all action required to cause the
     Registrable Shares to be listed on each national securities exchange on
     which the Common Stock shall then be listed, if any, and to be qualified
     for inclusion in the National Association of Securities Dealers Automated
     Quotation/Small Cap market ("NASDAQ/SMALL CAP").

     (h)  For the purposes of this Section 1, the following terms shall have the
following meanings:

     (1)  "REGISTRATION STATEMENT" means a registration statement filed by the
     Company in accordance with Section 1(g)(2), including exhibits and
     financial statements thereto, in the form in which it shall become
     effective and, in the event of any amendment thereto after the effective
     date of the registration statement, also means (from and after the
     effectiveness of the amendment) the registration statement as so amended;

          (2)  "RULE 144 TRANSACTION" means a transaction involving the sale of
     Registrable Shares to a person other than an affiliate of the Company under
     circumstances in which all of the applicable conditions of Rule 144 or Rule
     144A (or any similar provisions then in force) under the Securities Act are
     satisfied; and

     (3)  "PROSPECTUS" means the prospectus relating to the Registrable Shares
     owned by the Registering Stockholders included in a Registration Statement
     and, in the event of any amendment or supplement to the prospectus after
     the effective date of the Registration Statement, also means (from and
     after the effectiveness of the amendment or the filing with the Securities
     and Exchange Commission of the supplement) the prospectus as so amended or
     supplemented and, if a prospectus relating to the Registrable Shares shall
     be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission pursuant to Rider 424
     under the Securities Act, such prospectus.


                                       B-8
<PAGE>

SECTION 2.  EXPENSES.

     (a)  The Company shall bear all expenses of the following in connection
with the registration of Registrable Shares pursuant to Section 1, whether or
not any related Registration Statement shall become effective:

          (1)  preparing, printing and filing each Registration Statement and
     Prospectus and each qualification or notice required to be filed under
     federal and state securities laws or the rules and regulations of the
     National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD") in connection
     with a registration pursuant to Section 1;

          (2)  all fees and expenses of complying with federal and state
     securities laws and the rules and regulations of the NASD;

          (3)  furnishing to each Registering Stockholder one executed copy of
     the related Registration Statement and the number of copies of the related
     Prospectus that may be required by Sections 1(g)(2) and 1(g)(3) to be so
     furnished, together with a like number of copies of each amendment, post-
     effective amendment or supplement;

          (4)  performing its obligations under Section 1(g)(6);


          (5)  printing and issuing share certificates, including the transfer
     agent's fees, in connection with each distribution so registered; and

          (6)  preparing audited financial statements required by the Securities
     Act and the rules and regulations thereunder to be included in the
     Registration Statement and preparing audited financial statements for use
     in connection with the registration other than audited financial statements
     required by the Securities Act and the rules and regulations thereunder;

          (7)  internal expenses of the Company (including, without limitation,
     all salaries and expenses of its officers and employees performing legal or
     accounting duties);

          (8)  premiums or other expenses relating to liability insurance
     required by the Company or underwriters of the Registering Stockholders;

          (9)  fees and disbursements of underwriters of the Registering
     Stockholders customarily paid by issuers or sellers of securities;

          (10) listing of the Registrable Shares on national securities
     exchanges and inclusion of the Registrable Shares in NASDAQ/Small Cap; and


                                       B-9
<PAGE>

          (11) fees and expenses of any special experts retained by the Company
     in connection with the registration.

               (b)  The Registering Stockholders shall bear all other expenses
incident to the distribution by the respective Registering Stockholders of their
Registrable Shares in connection with a registration pursuant to Section 1,
including without limitation the selling expenses of the Registering
Stockholders, commissions, underwriting discounts, insurance, fees of counsel
for the Registering Stockholders and their underwriters.

SECTION 3.  INDEMNIFICATION

               (a)  The Company shall indemnify and hold harmless each
Registering Stockholder participating in a registration pursuant to Section 1,
each underwriter of any of the Registrable Shares owned by the Registering
Stockholder to be distributed pursuant to the registration, each partner in each
Registering Stockholder, the officers and directors of the Registering
Stockholder and the underwriter and each person, if any, who controls the
Registering Stockholder, each partner in each Registering Stockholder or the
underwriter within the meaning of Section 15 (or any successor provision) of the
Securities Act, and their respective successors, against all claims, losses,
damages and liabilities to third parties (or actions in respect thereof) arising
out of or based on any untrue statement (or alleged untrue statement) of a
material fact contained in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus or other
document incident thereto or any omission (or alleged omission) to state therein
a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the
statements therein not misleading, and shall reimburse each such Registering
Stockholder and each other person indemnified pursuant to this Section 3(a) for
any legal and any other expenses reasonably incurred in connection with
investigating or defending any such claim, loss, damage, liability or action;
PROVIDED that the Company shall not be liable in any case to the extent that any
such claim, loss, damage or liability arises out of or is based on any untrue
statement or omission based upon written information furnished to the Company by
any Registering Stockholder or underwriter for a Registered Stockholder
specifically for use in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus.

               (b)  Each Registering Stockholder, by participating in a
registration pursuant to Section 1, thereby agrees to indemnify and to hold
harmless the Company and its officers and directors and each person, if any, who
controls any of them within the meaning of Section 15 (or any successor
provision) of the Securities Act, and their respective successors, against all
claims, losses, damages and liabilities to third parties (or actions in respect
thereof) arising out of or based upon any untrue statement (or alleged untrue
statement) of a material fact contained in the Registration Statement or the
Prospectus or other document incident thereto or any omission (or alleged
omission) to state therein a material fact required to be stated therein or
necessary to make the statements therein not misleading, and shall reimburse the
Company and each other person indemnified pursuant to this Section 3(b) for any
legal and any other expenses reasonably incurred in connection with
investigating or defending any such claim, loss, damage, liability or action;
PROVIDED that this Section 3(b) shall apply only if (and only to the extent
that)


                                      B-10
<PAGE>

the statement or omission was made in reliance upon and in conformity with
information furnished to the Company in writing by the Registering Stockholder
specifically for use in the Registration Statement or the Prospectus; PROVIDED,
FURTHER, that in no event shall the liability of a Registering Stockholder
hereunder be greater in amount than the dollar amount of the proceeds received
by the Registering Stockholder upon the sale of the Registrable Shares giving
rise to such indemnification obligations.

               (c)  If any action or proceeding (including any governmental
investigation or inquiry) shall be brought or asserted against any person
indemnified under this Section 3, the indemnified person shall promptly notify
the indemnifying party in writing, and the indemnifying party shall assume the
defense of the action or proceeding, including the employment of counsel
satisfactory to the indemnified person and the payment of all expenses.  The
indemnified person shall have the right to employ separate counsel in any action
or proceeding and to participate in the defense of the action or proceeding, but
the fees and expenses of that counsel shall be at the expense of the indemnified
person unless

          (1)  the indemnifying party shall have agreed to pay those fees and
     expenses; or

          (2)  the indemnifying party shall have failed to assume the defense of
     the action or proceeding or shall have failed to employ counsel reasonably
     satisfactory to the indemnified person in the action or proceeding; or

          (3)  the named parties to the action or proceeding (including any
     impleaded parties) include both the indemnified person and the indemnifying
     party, and the indemnified person shall have been advised by counsel that
     there may be one or more legal defenses available to the indemnified person
     that are different from or additional to those available to the
     indemnifying party (in which case, if the indemnified person notifies the
     indemnifying party in writing that it elects to employ separate counsel at
     the expense of the indemnifying party, the indemnifying party shall not
     have the right to assume the defense of such action or proceeding on behalf
     of the indemnified person; it being understood, however, that the
     indemnifying party shall not, in connection with any one action or
     proceeding or separate but substantially similar or related actions or
     proceedings in the same jurisdiction arising out of the same general
     allegations or circumstances, be liable for the reasonable fees and
     expenses of more than one separate firm of attorneys at any time for the
     indemnified person, which firm shall be designated in writing by the
     indemnified person).

The indemnifying party shall not be liable for any settlement of any action or
proceeding effected without its written consent, but if settled with its written
consent, or if there be a final judgment for the plaintiff in any such action or
proceedings, the indemnifying party shall indemnify and hold harmless the
indemnified person from and against any loss or liability by reason of the
settlement or judgment.


                                      B-11
<PAGE>

          (d)  If the indemnification provided for in this Section 3 is
unavailable to an indemnified person (other than by reason of exceptions
provided in this Section 3) in respect of losses, claims, damages, liabilities
or expenses referred to in this Section 3, then each applicable indemnifying
party, in lieu of indemnifying the indemnified person, shall contribute to the
amount paid or payable by the indemnified person as a result of the losses,
claims, damages, liabilities or expenses in such proportion as is appropriate to
reflect the relative fault of the indemnifying party on the one hand and of the
indemnified person on the other in connection with the statements or omissions
which resulted in the losses, claims, damages, liabilities or expenses as well
as any other relevant equitable considerations.  The relative fault of the
indemnifying party on the one hand and of the indemnified person on the other
shall be determined by reference to, among other things, whether the untrue or
alleged untrue statement of a material fact or the omission or alleged omission
to state a material fact relates to information supplied by the indemnifying
party or by the indemnified person and by these persons' relative intent,
knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or prevent such
statement or omission.  The parties agree that it would not be just and
equitable if contribution pursuant to this Section 3(d) were determined by pro
rata allocation or by any other method of allocation that does not take into
account the equitable considerations referred to in the immediately preceding
sentence.  The amount paid or payable by a person as a result of the losses,
claims, damages, liabilities and expenses shall be deemed to include any legal
or other fees or expenses reasonably incurred by the person in connection with
investigating or defending any action or claim.  Notwithstanding in the
foregoing to the contrary, no Registering Stockholder or underwriter shall be
required to contribute any amount in excess of the amount by which (1) in the
case of any Registering Stockholder, the net proceeds received by the
Registering Stockholder the sale of Registerable Shares or (2) in the case of an
underwriter, the total price at which the Registerable Shares purchased by it
and distributed to the public were offered to the public exceeds, in any such
case, the amount of any damages that the Registering Stockholder or underwriter,
as the case may be, has otherwise been required to pay by reason of any untrue
or alleged untrue statement or omission.  No person guilty of fraudulent
representation (within the meaning of Section 11(f) of the Securities Act) shall
be entitled to contribution from any person who is not guilty of such fraudulent
misrepresentation.

          (e)  Each Registering Stockholder participating in a registration
pursuant to Section 1 shall cause each underwriter of any of the Registrable
Shares owned by the Registering Stockholder to be distributed pursuant to the
registration to agree in writing on terms reasonably satisfactory to the Company
to indemnify and to hold harmless the Company and its officers and directors and
each person, if any, who controls any of them within the meaning of Section 15
(or any successors provision) of the Securities Act, and their respective
successors, against all claims, losses, damages and liabilities to third parties
(or actions in respect thereof) arising out of or based upon any untrue
statement (or alleged untrue statement) of a material fact contained in the
Registration Statement or the Prospectus or other document incident thereto or
any omission (or alleged omission) to state therein a material fact required to
be stated therein or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading,
and to reimburse the Company and each other person indemnified pursuant to the
agreement for any legal or any other expense reasonably


                                      B-12
<PAGE>

incurred in connection with investigating or defending any claim, loss, damage,
liability or action; PROVIDED that the agreement shall apply only if (and only
to the extent that) the statement or omission was made in reliance upon and in
conformity with information furnished to the Company in writing by the
underwriter specifically for use in the Registration Statement or the
Prospectus.

          SECTION 4.  TRANSFER RESTRICTIONS.

               (a)  The Stockholder acknowledges that the Company will issue and
sell the Shares in reliance upon the exemption afforded by Section 4(2) of the
Securities Act for transactions by an issuer not involving any public offering. 
The Stockholder represents that (1) it will acquire the Registrable Shares for
investment and without any view toward distribution of any of the shares to any
other person, (2) it will not sell or otherwise dispose of the Registrable
Shares except in compliance with the registration requirements or exemption
provisions under the Securities Act.

               (b)  Except as provided to the contrary in this Section 4, each
certificate for Registrable Shares, and any certificate issued in exchange
therefor or upon conversion, exchange or transfer thereof, shall bear legends to
the effect stated in clauses (1) and (2) below:

          (1)  "The shares represented by this certificate have not been
     registered under the Securities Act of 1933 and may not be offered, sold,
     transferred or otherwise disposed of except in compliance with said Act."

          (2)  "The shares represented by this certificate are subject to the
     restrictions contained in the Registration Rights Agreement dated as of
     May 29, 1995, a copy of which is on file at the office of the Secretary of
     the Company."

               (c)  The legend stated in Section 4(b)(1) shall be removed by
delivery of one or more substitute certificates without such legend if either
(1) the related certificates are issued in connection with a sale registered
under the Securities Act or (2) the holder thereof shall have delivered to the
Company a copy of a letter from the staff of the Securities and Exchange
Commission or an opinion of counsel, in form and substance reasonably
satisfactory to the Company, to the effect that the legend is not required for
purposes of the Securities Act.

               (d)  The legend stated in Section 4(b)(2) shall be removed by
delivery of one or more substitute certificates without such legend at such time
as the related securities are no longer subject to this Agreement.

          SECTION 5.  FILINGS.  The Company shall make all filings with the
Securities and Exchange Commission required in order to make available to the
holders of Registrable Shares the exemption from the registration requirements
provided by Rule 144 (or any successor regulation) under the Securities Act.


                                      B-13
<PAGE>

          SECTION 6.  MERGER, CONSOLIDATION, EXCHANGE, ETC.  In the event,
directly or indirectly, (1) the Company shall merge with and into, or
consolidate with, or consummate a share exchange pursuant to the Colorado
Business Corporation Act (or successor provisions or statutes) with, any other
person, or (2) any person shall merge with and into, or consolidate, the Company
and the Company shall be the surviving corporation of such merger or
consolidation and, in connection with such merger or consolidation, all or part
of the Registrable Shares shall be changed into or exchanged for stock or other
securities of any other person, then, in each such case, proper provision shall
be made so that such other person shall be bound by the provisions of this
Agreement and the term "Company" shall thereafter be deemed to refer to such
other person.

          SECTION 7.  OTHER AGREEMENTS.

               (a)  The Company, on behalf of itself and its Affiliates (other
than a Registering Stockholder), agrees (1) not to effect any public sale or
distribution of any securities similar to the Registrable Shares being
registered pursuant to this Agreement or any securities convertible into or
exchangeable or exercisable for such Registrable Shares during the 14 days prior
to, and during the 90-day period beginning on, the effective date of the
Registration Statement (except (x) on Form S-4 or Form S-8 (or comparable form)
or (y) as part of the Registration Statement; PROVIDED that with respect to
clause (y) in the case of a registration pursuant to Section 1(a) the
Registering Stockholder initiating the registration consents to such inclusion),
or the commencement of a public distribution of Registrable Shares; (2) not to
enter into any agreement inconsistent with any provision of this Agreement; (3)
that any agreement entered into after the date of this Agreement pursuant to
which the Company issues or agrees to issue any privately placed securities
shall contain a provision under which holders of such securities agree not to
effect any public sale or distribution of any of the securities during the
periods described in clause (1) of this Section 7(a), in each case including a
sale in a Rule 144 Transaction (except as part of any such registration, if
permitted); PROVIDED that the provisions of this Section 7(a) shall not prevent
the conversion or exchange of any securities pursuant to their terms into or for
other securities.

               (b)  If and to the extent requested by the Company in the case of
a non-underwritten public offering and if and to the extent requested by the
managing underwriter in the case of an underwritten public offering, the
Registering Stockholder agrees not to effect any public sale or distribution of
any securities similar to the securities being registered or any securities
convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for such securities during the
14 days prior to, and during the 90-day period beginning on, the effective date
of such registration statement (except as part of such registration agreement).

          SECTION 8.  NOTICES.  All notices, requests and other communications
to any party under this Agreement shall be in writing.  Communications may be
made by telecopy or similar writing.  Each communication shall be given to the
party at its address stated on the signature pages of this Agreement or at any
other address as the party may specify for this purpose by


                                      B-14
<PAGE>

notice to the other party.  Each communication shall be effective (1) if given
by telecopy, when the telecopy is transmitted to the proper address and the
receipt of the transmission is confirmed, (2) if given by mail, 72 hours after
the communication is deposited in the mails properly addressed with first class
postage prepaid or (3) if given by any other means, when delivered to the proper
address and a written acknowledgement of delivery is received.

          SECTION 9.  NO WAIVERS; REMEDIES.  No failure or delay by any party in
exercising any right, power or privilege under this Agreement shall operate as a
waiver of the right, power or privilege.  A single or partial exercise of any
right, power or privilege shall not preclude any other or further exercise of
the right, power or privilege or the exercise of any other right, power or
privilege.  The rights and remedies provided in this Agreement shall be
cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies provided by law.

          SECTION 10.  AMENDMENTS, ETC.  No amendment, modification, termination
or waiver of any provision of this Agreement, and no consent to any departure by
a party to this Agreement from any provision of this Agreement, shall be
effective unless it shall be in writing and signed and delivered by the other
party to this Agreement, and then it shall be effective only in the specific
instance and for the specific purpose for which it is given.

          SECTION 11.  SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS.


          (a)  The Stockholder may assign to any transferee of any principal
amount of the Parent Note or Registrable Shares its rights and delegate its
obligations under this Agreement; provided that such transferee assignee shall
accept those rights and assume those obligations for the benefit of the Company
in writing in form reasonably satisfactory to the Company.  Thereafter, without
any further action by any person, all references in this Agreement to the
"Stockholder", and all comparable references, shall be deemed to be references
to the transferee, and the Stockholder shall be released from any obligation or
liability under this Agreement with respect to the Registrable Shares so
transferred.

          (b)  The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and inure
to the benefit of the parties to this Agreement and their respective successors
and permitted assigns pursuant to Section 11(a).

          SECTION 12.  GOVERNING LAW.  This Agreement shall be governed by and
construed in accordance with the internal laws of the State of Colorado.  All
rights and obligations of the Company and the Stockholder shall be in addition
to and not in limitation of those provided by applicable law.

          SECTION 13.  COUNTERPARTS; EFFECTIVENESS.  This Agreement may be
signed in any number of counterparts, each of which shall be an original, with
the same effect as if all signatures were on the same instrument.


                                      B-15
<PAGE>

          SECTION 14.  SEVERABILITY OF PROVISIONS.  Any provision of this
Agreement that is prohibited or unenforceable in any jurisdiction shall, as to 
that jurisdiction, be ineffective to the extent of the prohibition or
unenforceability without invalidating the remaining provisions of this Agreement
or affecting the validity or enforceability of the provision in any other
jurisdiction.

          SECTION 15.  HEADINGS AND REFERENCES.  Section headings in this
Agreement are included for the convenience of reference only and do not
constitute a part of this Agreement for any other purpose.  References to
parties and sections in this Agreement are references to the parties to or the
sections of this Agreement, as the case may be, unless the context shall require
otherwise.

          SECTION 16.  ENTIRE AGREEMENT.  Except as otherwise specifically
provided in the following sentence, the Transaction Documents embody the entire
agreement and understanding of the respective parties and supersede all prior
agreements or understandings with respect to the subject matters of those
documents.

          SECTION 17.  SURVIVAL.  Except as otherwise specifically provided in
this Agreement, each representation, warranty or covenant of each party to this
Agreement contained in or made pursuant to this Agreement shall survive the
Closing and remain in full force and effect, notwithstanding any investigation
or notice to the contrary or any waiver by any other party of a related
condition precedent to the performance by the other party of an obligation under
this Agreement.

          SECTION 18.  NON-EXCLUSIVE JURISDICTION.  Each party (1) agrees that
any Action with respect to this Agreement may be brought in the courts of the
State of Colorado or of the United States of America for the District of
Colorado, (2) accepts for itself and in respect of its property, generally and
unconditionally, the jurisdiction of those courts and (3) irrevocably waives any
objection, including, without limitation, any objection to the laying of venue
or based on the grounds of FORUM NON  CONVENIENS, which it may now or hereafter
have to the bringing of any Action in those jurisdictions.

          SECTION 19.  WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL.  Each party waives any right to a
trial by jury in any Action to enforce or defend any right under this Agreement
or any amendment, instrument, document or agreement delivered, or which in the
future may be delivered, in connection with this Agreement and agrees that any
Action shall be tried before a court and not before a jury.

          SECTION 20.  AFFILIATE.  Nothing contained in this Agreement shall
constitute the Stockholder an "affiliate" of any of the Company and its
Subsidiaries within the meaning of Rule 13e-3 under the Exchange Act.

                          ____________________________


                                      B-16
<PAGE>

     IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed and delivered this 
Registration Rights Agreement as of the date first written above in Denver,
Colorado.


                              INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION



                              By:                      
                                  --------------------------------------
                                  Name:
                                  Title:


                              Address:  7100 East Belleview Avenue
                                        Suite 201
                                        Englewood, Colorado 80111


                              Telecopy: (303) 770-0588


                              INTERWEST GROUP, INC.


                              By:
                                 ----------------------------------------
                                  Name:
                                  Title:


                              Address:  12201 East Arapahoe Road
                                        Suite C10
                                        Englewood, Colorado 80112


                              Telecopy: (303) 792-0227



                                       S-1


<PAGE>
                                                                      APPENDIX D

                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                        INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                PAGE NO.
                                                                                --------
<S>                                                                             <C>
I.   UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONDENSED COMBINED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     A.   Introduction                                                             D-3

     B.   Pro Forma Combined Condensed Balance Sheet                               D-4

          -   Internet Communications Corporation as of April 30, 1996
          -   Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation as of March 31, 1996

     C.   Pro Forma Interim Combined Condensed Statement of Operations             D-5

          -  Internet Communications Corporation for the Three
             Months Ended April 30, 1996

          -  Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation for the
             Three Months Ended March 31, 1996

     D.   Pro Forma Fiscal Combined Condensed Statement of Operations             D-6

          -  Internet Communications Corporation for the Year
             Ended January 31, 1996

          -  Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation for the
             Year Ended December 31, 1995 (Recasted)

     E.   Notes to Pro Forma Financial Information                                D-7

II.  INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
    (A WHOLLY-OWNED SUBSIDIARY OF  INTERWEST GROUP, INC.)

     A.   Report of Independent Public Accountants                                D-8

     B.   Consolidated Balance Sheets as of March 31, 1996                        D-9
          (Unaudited) and December 31, 1995

     C.   Consolidated  Statements of Operations for the                         D-11
          Three Months Ended March 31, 1996 (Unaudited) and the
          Seven Months Ended December 31, 1995

     D.   Consolidated Statement of Stockholder's Equity                         D-12
          for the Seven-Month Period Ended December 31, 1995 and
          the Three-Month Period Ended March 31, 1996 (Unaudited)

     E.   Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the                          D-13
          Three Months Ended March 31, 1996 (Unaudited) and the
          Seven Months Ended December 31, 1995

     F.   Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements                         D-15
</TABLE>



                                     D-1

<PAGE>

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                              PAGE NO.
                                                                              --------
<S>                                                                           <C>
III.  INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

      A.  Independent Auditor's Report                                           D-25

      B.  Combined Statements of Income and Retained                             D-26
          Earnings for the Two Months Ended May 31, 1995, and
          for the Years Ended March 31, 1995 and 1994

      C.  Combined Statements of Cash Flows for the Two                          D-27
          Months Ended May 31, 1995 and for the Years Ended
          March 31, 1995 and 1994

      D.  Notes to Combined Financial Statements                                 D-28
</TABLE>


    Financial statements of Internet are included in the Company's
    Form 10-KSB and Form 10-QSB which accompany the Proxy document
    as Appendixes E and F, respectively.







                                     D-2

<PAGE>


                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

      INTRODUCTION TO PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
                                 (UNAUDITED)


On May 29, 1996, Internet Communications Corporation (Internet or the 
Company) signed a purchase agreement with Interwest Communications C.S. 
Corporation (Interwest) whereby Internet will issue 2,306,541 shares of 
common stock (49% of the common stock outstanding after the transaction) to 
acquire 100% of Interwest's outstanding common stock, subject to shareholder 
approval.  Interwest is a wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc. 
(Group), a holding company for several diverse enterprises.  Group effectively 
acquired Interwest from its prior shareholder (an individual and his spouse) 
on June 1, 1995 in a monetary purchase transaction. In conjunction with 
Internet's acquisition of Interwest, Group has advanced Internet $900,000 in 
the form of a promissory note, which if not paid when due on December 31, 
1996, is convertible into common stock at $3.00 per share.

The attached pro forma combined condensed balance sheet combines the balance 
sheets of Internet as of April 30, 1996 with Interwest as of March 31, 1996 
(their respective quarter end), as if the merger had occurred on the balance 
sheet dates. This merger will be treated for financial accounting purposes as 
a purchase transaction.

The pro forma combined condensed statement of operations combines Internet's 
and Interwest's three-month interim and year-end operations as if the merger 
has occurred at the beginning of the period presented.  Internet's fiscal 
year-end is January 31, 1996.  Interwest, prior to the acquisition by Group, 
had a March 31 year-end, which changed to a calendar year-end as a result of 
the acquisition by Group.  Therefore, Interwest's operations for the 12 months 
ended December 31, 1995, have been recasted to reflect a full fiscal year.

These statements are not necessarily indicative of future operations or the 
actual results that would have occurred had the transaction been consummated 
at the beginning of the period indicated.  The pro forma combined financial 
statements should be read in conjunction with the historical financial 
statements and notes thereto which for Interwest are accompanying pro forma 
information and for Internet are included in its Form 10-KSB and Form 10-QSB 
accompanying the Proxy document as Appendixes E and F, respectively.







                                     D-3

<PAGE>

                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
          INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

           PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED BALANCE SHEET (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   INTERNET     INTERWEST
                                 -----------    ----------
                                   APRIL 30,    MARCH 31,
                                     1996          1996          ADJUSTMENTS       COMBINED
                                 -----------    ----------       -----------     -----------
<S>                                  <C>           <C>              <C>             <C>
                                         ASSETS
                                         ------
CURRENT ASSETS:
 Cash                            $   266,000    $  842,000       $  900,000 (a)  $ 1,908,000
                                                                   (100,000)(c)
 Receivables                       2,658,000     2,922,000                         5,580,000
 Inventory                         1,182,000     1,085,000                         2,267,000
 Other                               377,000       215,000                           592,000
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
                                   4,483,000     5,064,000          800,000 (a)   10,347,000

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT, net        1,900,000       840,000                         2,740,000

OTHER ASSETS, net                     69,000     2,236,000          100,000 (c)    4,228,000
                                                                  1,823,000 (b)
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
TOTAL ASSETS                     $ 6,452,000    $8,140,000       $2,723,000      $17,315,000
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------

                           LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
                           ------------------------------------
CURRENT LIABILITIES:
 Notes payable                   $ 1,100,000    $  551,000       $      -        $ 1,651,000
 Accounts payable                  1,656,000     1,293,000              -          2,949,000
 Unearned income                     672,000       996,000              -          1,668,000
 Payable to affiliate                    -         356,000          900,000 (a)    1,256,000
 Accrued expenses and other          304,000       644,000              -            948,000
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
                                   3,732,000     3,840,000          900,000        8,472,000
LONG-TERM DEBT                           -         230,000              -            230,000
OTHER                                    -         179,000              -            179,000

MINORITY INTEREST                        -         230,000              -            230,000
                                         -         639,000              -            639,000
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
 Common stock                      5,202,000     3,726,000        1,758,000 (b)   10,686,000

 Accumulated deficit              (2,447,000)      (65,000)          65,000 (b)   (2,447,000)
 Other                               (35,000)          -                -            (35,000)
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
                                   2,720,000     3,661,000        1,823,000        8,204,000
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AND EQUITY     $ 6,452,000    $8,140,000       $2,723,000      $17,315,000
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
                                 -----------    ----------       ----------      -----------
</TABLE>

              SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO THESE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.


                                     D-4

<PAGE>

                      INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
            INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

         PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   INTERNET        INTERWEST
                                -------------    -------------
                                FOR THE THREE    FOR THE THREE
                                 MONTHS ENDED     MONTHS ENDED              PRO FORMA
                                   APRIL 30,        MARCH 31,      --------------------------
                                     1996             1996         ADJUSTMENTS     COMBINED
                                -------------    -------------     -----------    -----------
<S>                                <C>               <C>              <C>            <C>
NET REVENUES                     $ 3,614,000      $ 4,659,000       $    -        $ 8,273,000
 Cost of sales                    (2,548,000)      (2,985,000)           -         (5,533,000)
                                 -----------      -----------       --------      -----------
GROSS MARGIN                       1,066,000        1,674,000            -          2,740,000
OPERATING EXPENSES                 1,234,000        1,745,000         15,000 (d)    2,994,000
                                 -----------      -----------       --------      -----------
LOSS FROM 
  OPERATIONS                        (168,000)         (71,000)       (15,000)        (254,000)
 Other (expense) income              (29,000)          (9,000)           -            (38,000)
                                 -----------      -----------       --------      -----------
LOSS BEFORE
  INCOME TAXES                      (197,000)         (80,000)       (15,000)        (292,000)
 Income tax (expense) benefit                          18,000        (18,000)(e)          -
                                 -----------      -----------       --------      -----------
NET LOSS                         $  (197,000)     $   (62,000)      $(33,000)     $  (292,000)
                                 -----------      -----------       --------      -----------
                                 -----------      -----------       --------      -----------
NET LOSS PER COMMON
  SHARE                          $      (.08)     $       N/A                     $      (.06)
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
AVERAGE NUMBER OF
  SHARES OUTSTANDING               2,401,000              N/A                       4,707,000
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
</TABLE>


               SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO THESE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.


                                      D-5

<PAGE>


                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
           INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

        PRO FORMA COMBINED CONDENSED STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS (UNAUDITED)


<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                   INTERNET        INTERWEST
                                -------------    -------------
                                FOR THE THREE    FOR THE THREE
                                 MONTHS ENDED     MONTHS ENDED              PRO FORMA
                                  JANUARY 31,     DECEMBER 31,     --------------------------
                                     1996             1995         ADJUSTMENTS     COMBINED
                                -------------    -------------     -----------    -----------
                                                  (RECASTED)
<S>                                <C>               <C>              <C>            <C>
NET REVENUES                     $18,526,000      $15,482,000       $     -       $34,008,000
 Cost of sales                    13,502,000       11,384,000             -        24,886,000
                                 -----------      -----------       ---------     -----------
GROSS MARGIN                       5,024,000        4,098,000             -         9,122,000
OPERATING EXPENSES                 6,087,000        4,099,000         150,000 (d)  10,336,000
                                 -----------      -----------       ---------     -----------
LOSS FROM
  OPERATIONS                      (1,063,000)          (1,000)       (150,000)     (1,214,000)
 Other (expense) income              (43,000)          79,000             -            36,000
                                 -----------      -----------       ---------     -----------
INCOME (LOSS) BEFORE
  INCOME TAXES                    (1,106,000)          78,000        (150,000)(d)  (1,178,000)
 Income tax (expense) benefit        128,000          (25,000)         25,000 (e)     128,000
                                 -----------      -----------       ---------     -----------
NET INCOME (LOSS)                $  (978,000)     $    53,000       $(125,000)    $(1,050,000)
                                 -----------      -----------       ---------     -----------
                                 -----------      -----------       ---------     -----------
NET LOSS PER COMMON
  SHARE                          $     (0.41)     $       N/A                     $      (.22)
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
AVERAGE NUMBER OF SHARES
 OUTSTANDING                       2,397,000              N/A                       4,704,000
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
                                 -----------      -----------                     -----------
</TABLE>



               SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO THESE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.


                                     D-6

<PAGE>

                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

                   NOTES TO PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION


a.  To reflect the note payable to Group of $900,000 from Internet made in 
    conjunction with the merger. This advance is for future working capital 
    and was not used to consummate the merger. Therefore, interest expense 
    for prior periods is not adjusted as both Internet and Interwest had 
    adequate lines-of-credit in prior periods.

b.  To reflect the acquisition of Interwest by Internet, which is valued at
    approximately $5,480,000.  As the cost basis  of Interwest assets 
    approximate the market value, an excess amount of  purchase price over 
    net assets acquired (goodwill)  of approximately $1,823,000 will be 
    recorded, plus cost of the share exchange.  This amount is in addition to 
    approximately $1,400,000 of goodwill remaining on Interwest balance sheet 
    from its prior acquisition in June 1995 by Group.

c.  To record estimated additional cost of the acquisition.

d.  To reflect additional amortization of goodwill recorded in the transaction, 
    which will be amortized over 20 years.

e.  To reduce income tax expense (benefit) based on combined pro forma losses.















                                     D-7

<PAGE>


               REPORT OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS




To the Stockholder of Interwest Communications
   C.S. Corporation and Subsidiaries:

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheet of INTERWEST
COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES (a Colorado corporation and
wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.) as of December 31, 1995, and
the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholder's equity and cash
flows for the seven-month period then ended.  These financial statements are the
responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an
opinion on these financial statements based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards.
Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable
assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material
misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting
the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements.  An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. 
We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in
all material respects, the financial position of Interwest Communications C.S.
Corporation and subsidiaries as of December 31, 1995, and the results of their
operations and their cash flows for the seven-month period then ended in
conformity with generally accepted accounting principles.



Denver, Colorado,
  June 18, 1996.


                                     D-8


<PAGE>


                                                                   Page 1 of 2


         INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
             (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

                         CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

<TABLE>
                                                      MARCH 31,  DECEMBER 31,
                        ASSETS                          1996         1995
                        ------                       ----------  ------------
                                                     (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                  <C>          <C>
CURRENT ASSETS:
  Cash and cash equivalents                          $  842,000   $  143,000
  Accounts receivable-
    Unbilled                                          1,580,000    1,401,000
    Trade and other                                   1,438,000    1,715,000
    Allowance                                           (96,000)     (82,000)
  Inventory                                           1,085,000    1,169,000
  Prepaid expenses                                      122,000       86,000
  Deferred tax assets                                    93,000       81,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
         Total current assets                         5,064,000    4,513,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT:
  Machinery, equipment and other                        609,000      555,000
  Furniture and fixtures                                353,000      336,000
  Vehicles                                              290,000      272,000
  Leasehold improvements                                 84,000       82,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
                                                      1,336,000    1,245,000
  Less- Accumulated depreciation                       (496,000)    (436,000)
                                                     ----------   ----------
                                                        840,000      809,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
OTHER ASSETS:                                                     
  Goodwill, net                                       1,383,000    1,408,000
  Noncompete agreements, net                            501,000      531,000
  Other, net                                            352,000      344,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
                                                      2,236,000    2,283,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
                                                     $8,140,000   $7,605,000
                                                     ----------   ----------
                                                     ----------   ----------
</TABLE>

                  The accompanying notes to financial statements
                  are an integral part of these balance sheets.


                                     D-9


<PAGE>


                                                                  Page 2 of 2

            INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
               (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

                           CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

<TABLE>
                                                         MARCH 31,   DECEMBER 31,
         LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY              1996         1995
         ------------------------------------           ----------   ------------
                                                        (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                     <C>          <C>
CURRENT LIABILITIES:                                 
  Accounts payable                                      $1,293,000   $1,428,000
  Accounts payable--parent                                 356,000      422,000
  Deferred revenue and deposits                            996,000      387,000
  Accrued salaries and wages                               101,000      186,000
  Other accrued liabilities                                519,000      297,000
  Income taxes payable                                      24,000       31,000
  Revolving line of credit                                 330,000      272,000
  Current maturities of long-term debt                     221,000      182,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
         Total current liabilities                       3,840,000    3,205,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
LONG-TERM DEBT                                             230,000      293,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
DEFERRED REVENUE                                           135,000      101,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
NET DEFERRED TAX LIABILITIES                                44,000       44,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
MINORITY INTEREST IN CONSOLIDATED SUBSIDIARIES             230,000      239,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Notes 5 and 8)

STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY:
  Common stock, no par value; 100,000 shares 
    authorized, 40,000 shares issued and outstanding     3,635,000    3,635,000
  Common stock, nonvoting, no par value; 10,000 shares
    authorized, 1,000 shares issued and outstanding         91,000       91,000
  Retained deficit                                         (65,000)      (3,000)
                                                        ----------   ----------
         Total stockholder's equity                      3,661,000    3,723,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
                                                        $8,140,000   $7,605,000
                                                        ----------   ----------
                                                        ----------   ----------
</TABLE>

                  The accompanying notes to financial statements
                  are an integral part of these balance sheets.



                                     D-10


<PAGE>


            INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
               (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

<TABLE>
                                                    THREE MONTHS  SEVEN MONTHS
                                                        ENDED         ENDED
                                                      MARCH 31,   DECEMBER 31,
                                                        1996          1995
                                                     ----------   ------------
                                                     (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                  <C>           <C>
REVENUE                                              $4,659,000   $10,284,000

DIRECT LABOR AND MATERIALS                            2,985,000     6,490,000
                                                     ----------   -----------

         Gross profit                                 1,674,000     3,794,000

DEPRECIATION AND AMORTIZATION                           138,000       347,000

SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE                   1,607,000     3,343,000
                                                     ----------   -----------

         Income (loss) from operations                  (71,000)      104,000

INTEREST EXPENSE                                        (21,000)      (62,000)

INTEREST INCOME                                           3,000         3,000

MINORITY INTEREST                                         9,000        (3,000)
                                                     ----------   -----------
INCOME (LOSS) BEFORE INCOME TAXES                       (80,000)       42,000

INCOME TAX (EXPENSE) BENEFIT                             18,000       (45,000)
                                                     ----------   -----------
NET LOSS                                             $  (62,000)  $    (3,000)
                                                     ----------   -----------
                                                     ----------   -----------
</TABLE>

                  The accompanying notes to financial statements
                     are an integral part of these statements.


                                     D-11


<PAGE>

          INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
             (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

               CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDER'S EQUITY

           FOR THE SEVEN-MONTH PERIOD ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND
           THE THREE-MONTH PERIOD ENDED MARCH 31, 1996 (UNAUDITED)

<TABLE>
                                              NONVOTING    
                                            COMMON STOCK           COMMON STOCK           RETAINED         TOTAL
                                        -------------------   -----------------------     EARNINGS      STOCKHOLDER'S
                                         SHARES     AMOUNT     SHARES       AMOUNT        (DEFICIT)        EQUITY
                                        -------   ---------   --------   ------------   -------------   ------------
<S>                                     <C>       <C>         <C>        <C>            <C>             <C>
BALANCES, May 31, 1995                    1,000    $   -        40,000     $   12,000     $ 1,614,000     $1,626,000
                                                                                                        
  Fair value adjustments related to the                                                                 
    acquisition of the Company by                                                                       
    Interwest Group, Inc.:                                                                              
      Retained earnings                     -        39,000        -        1,575,000      (1,614,000)           -
      Purchase accounting adjustments       -        52,000        -        2,048,000             -        2,100,000
                                        -------   ---------   --------   ------------   -------------   ------------
BALANCES, June 1, 1995                    1,000      91,000     40,000      3,635,000             -        3,726,000
  Net loss                                  -           -          -              -            (3,000)        (3,000)
                                        -------   ---------   --------   ------------   -------------   ------------
BALANCES, December 31, 1995               1,000      91,000     40,000      3,635,000          (3,000)     3,723,000
  Net loss                                  -           -          -              -           (62,000)       (62,000)
                                        -------   ---------   --------   ------------   -------------   ------------
BALANCES, March 31, 1996 (unaudited)      1,000     $91,000     40,000     $3,635,000     $   (65,000)    $3,661,000
                                        -------   ---------   --------   ------------   -------------   ------------
                                        -------   ---------   --------   ------------   -------------   ------------
</TABLE>

          The accompanying notes to financial statements
            are an integral part of these statements.



                                     D-12


<PAGE>


                                                                   Page 1 of 2

           INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
              (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

<TABLE>
                                                          THREE        SEVEN
                                                         MONTHS        MONTHS
                                                          ENDED        ENDED
                                                        MARCH 31,    DECEMBER 31,
                                                          1996          1995
                                                       -----------  -------------
                                                       (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                    <C>           <C>
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net loss                                              $ (62,000)   $    (3,000)
  Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash
    provided by (used in) operating activities-                  
      Depreciation and amortization                       138,000        347,000
      Gain on sale of assets and other                     (6,000)       (15,000)
      Deferred income tax benefit                         (12,000)       (27,000)
      Minority interest                                    (9,000)         3,000
      (Increase) decrease in accounts receivable, net     112,000     (1,115,000)
      Decrease in inventory                                84,000        148,000
      (Increase) decrease in prepaid expenses             (36,000)         6,000
      (Increase) decrease in other assets                 (27,000)        78,000
      Increase in accounts payable and
         accrued liabilities                                2,000        161,000
      Increase (decrease) in deferred revenue
         and deposits                                     643,000       (121,000)
      Increase (decrease) in accounts payable--parent     (66,000)       422,000
      Increase (decrease) in income taxes payable          (7,000)        31,000
                                                      ----------- -------------
         Net cash provided by (used in)
            operating activities                          754,000       (85,000)
                                                      ----------- -------------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Purchases of property and equipment                    (100,000)     (398,000)
  Proceeds from sale of property and equipment             11,000        33,000
                                                      ----------- -------------
         Net cash used in investing activities            (89,000)     (365,000)
                                                      ----------- -------------
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Proceeds from long-term debt                             20,000         6,000
  Repayments of long-term debt                            (44,000)     (219,000)
  Borrowings under revolving line of credit               955,000       868,000
  Repayments under revolving line of credit              (897,000)     (632,000)
                                                      ----------- -------------
         Net cash provided by financing activities         34,000        23,000
                                                      ----------- -------------
</TABLE>

                 The accompanying notes to financial statements
                    are an integral part of these statements.


                                     D-13


<PAGE>


                                                                   Page 2 of 2

           INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
              (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

                      CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

<TABLE>
                                                       THREE MONTHS SEVEN MONTHS
                                                           ENDED       ENDED
                                                         MARCH 31,  DECEMBER 31,
                                                           1996         1995
                                                       -----------  -----------
                                                        (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                    <C>           <C>
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND
  CASH EQUIVALENTS                                        $699,000    $(427,000)

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, beginning of period             143,000      570,000
                                                       -----------  -----------

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS, end of period                  $842,000    $ 143,000
                                                       -----------  -----------
                                                       -----------  -----------

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES OF CASH FLOW
  INFORMATION:
    Cash paid during the period for interest              $ 23,000    $  58,000
                                                       -----------  -----------
                                                       -----------  -----------

    Cash paid during the period for income taxes          $  4,000    $ 427,000
                                                       -----------  -----------
                                                       -----------  -----------
</TABLE>

SUPPLEMENTAL SCHEDULE OF NONCASH INVESTING
  AND FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

    Effective June 1, 1995, Interwest Group, Inc. (formerly known as West Hazmat
      Companies, Inc.) acquired all of the outstanding common stock of Interwest
      Communications C.S. Corporation and its related entities (see Note 1). 
      The cost of the purchase has been pushed down to the accompanying
      financial statements and as a result of purchase accounting adjustments
      there was a noncash increase in assets and stockholder's equity of
      $2,100,000.

    During the seven-month period ended December 31, 1995, the Company
      transferred approximately $100,000 from inventory to property and
      equipment.

                 The accompanying notes to financial statements
                   are an integral part of these statements. 


                                     D-14

<PAGE>

           INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES
              (A wholly owned subsidiary of Interwest Group, Inc.)

                          NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                DECEMBER 31, 1995 AND MARCH 31, 1996 (UNAUDITED)

(1) OPERATIONS AND ACQUISITION

    OPERATIONS

Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation ("Interwest C.S.") and subsidiaries
(the "Company") are engaged primarily in the business of selling, leasing,
installing, and maintaining telephone communication systems for various
customers primarily in the state of Colorado.

    ACQUISITION

Effective June 1, 1995, Interwest Group, Inc. ("Interwest Group") (formerly
known as West Hazmat Companies, Inc.), a wholly owned subsidiary of the Anschutz
Company ("Anschutz"), purchased 100% of the common stock of the Company.  The
purchase price, including acquisition costs, was approximately $3,726,000 and
consisted of cash of approximately $1,482,000 and a note payable issued to the
seller of approximately $2,244,000 which is reflected as a liability of
Interwest Group.

This acquisition was accounted for using the purchase method of accounting. 
Goodwill of approximately $1,470,000 and noncompete agreements of $600,000 were
recorded in connection with the purchase and are being amortized on a straight-
line basis over fifteen and five years, respectively.


                                     D-15

<PAGE>

(2) SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

    PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Interwest C.S.;
its 58.2% subsidiary, Work Telcom Services, Inc.; its 97% subsidiary, Interwest
Cable Network Systems, Inc.; its 51% subsidiary, Interwest Communications Pueblo
Corporation; and its 50% subsidiary, Omega Business Communications Services,
Inc.  The minority interests of the above subsidiaries are owned by the
respective managers of each company.  All material intercompany transactions and
amounts have been eliminated in consolidation.



    INTERIM FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

The consolidated financial statements of the Company as of March 31, 1996,
presented herein have been prepared by the Company without audit, pursuant to
the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission.  The
financial statements reflect all adjustments (consisting of only normal
recurring accruals) which, in the opinion of management, are necessary to
present fairly the financial position, results of operations and cash flows of
the Company as of March 31, 1996, and for the period then ended.

    ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

Preparation of financial statements in conformity with generally accepted
accounting principles requires that management make certain estimates and
assumptions.  These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of
assets and liabilities and the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities
as of the balance sheet date and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses
during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from these estimates.



    REVENUE RECOGNITION

The Company utilizes the percentage-of-completion method under which revenues
from long-term contracts are recognized by measuring the percentage of costs
incurred to date to estimated total 


                                     D-16

<PAGE>

costs for each contract.  Contract costs include direct material and labor 
costs and those indirect costs related to contract performance, such as 
indirect labor, supplies, tools, repairs, and depreciation costs.  Operating 
costs are charged to expense as incurred. Provisions for estimated losses on 
incomplete contracts are made in the period in which such losses are 
determined.  Changes in job performance, job conditions, and estimated 
profitability, may result in revisions to costs and income and are recognized 
in the period in which the revisions are determined.

    DEFERRED REVENUE AND DEPOSITS

The Company has entered into maintenance and extended warranty contracts with
customers which require payment in advance.  Revenue received in advance is
deferred and recognized on a straight-line basis over the lives of the
maintenance and extended warranty contracts which are one and five years,
respectively.

Deposits represent advance payments received from customers which are required
prior to the commencement of an installation project.  At December 31, 1995 and
March 31, 1996, the Company has received and deferred approximately $255,000 and
$153,000, respectively, of unearned deposits from customers.  In addition,
deposits at March 31, 1996 include a payment from a subcontractor for a
performance bond of $850,000 which was refunded subsequent to March 31, 1996
upon notification that the Company was not awarded a project they were proposing
on.

    PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT

Significant additions and improvements are capitalized at cost, while
maintenance and repairs which do not improve or extend the life of the
respective assets are charged to operations as incurred.


                                     D-17

<PAGE>

Depreciation and amortization is provided using the straight-line method over
the estimated useful lives of the related assets as follows:

            Machinery, equipment and other                  3-7 years
            Furniture and fixtures                          3-5 years
            Vehicles                                        3-5 years
            Leasehold improvements                            5 years

    CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

All highly liquid cash investments with original maturity dates of three months
or less are classified as cash equivalents.

    INTANGIBLES

Goodwill is being amortized on a straight-line basis over a period of 15 years. 
Accumulated amortization at December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996, is
approximately $62,000 and $87,000, respectively.

The Company is amortizing noncompete agreements on a straight-line basis over
the five year life of the agreements.  At December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996,
the related accumulated amortization is approximately $69,000 and $99,000,
respectively.

Other assets is comprised primarily of purchased customer lists which are being
amortized on a straight-line basis over five years.  At December 31, 1995 and
March 31, 1996, the related accumulated amortization is approximately $56,000
and $74,000, respectively.


                                     D-18

<PAGE>

The amortization expense for the seven months ended December 31, 1995 and the
three months ended March 31, 1996, for the above intangibles was approximately
$173,000 and $74,000, respectively.

    INVENTORY

Inventory is stated at the lower of cost or market using the weighted average
cost method and is comprised primarily of telephone systems and related parts.

    INCOME TAXES

Interwest C.S. and Interwest Cable Network Systems, Inc. are included in the
consolidated federal income tax return of Anschutz and the other subsidiaries
file their own federal income tax return.  The income taxes of the Company are
computed by applying the asset and liability method to the Company as if it were
a separate taxpayer.  The Company receives or makes cash payments to Anschutz
based upon the benefits or liabilities it generates.

The current provision for income taxes represents actual or estimated amounts
payable or refundable on tax returns filed or to be filed for each year. 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recorded for the estimated future tax
effects of:  (a) temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and
liabilities and amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets, and (b)
operating loss and tax credit carryforwards.  The overall change in deferred tax
assets and liabilities for the period measures the deferred tax expense or
benefit for the period.  Effects of changes in enacted tax laws on deferred tax
assets and liabilities are reflected as adjustments to tax expense in the period
of enactment.  The measurement of deferred tax assets may be reduced by a
valuation 


                                     D-19

<PAGE>

allowance based on judgmental assessment of available evidence if deemed more 
likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be 
realized.

(3) DEBT

Long-term debt at March 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995 consists of the
following:

<TABLE>
                                                                             MARCH 31,   DECEMBER 31,
                                                                               1996          1995
                                                                             ---------    ---------
                                                                            (UNAUDITED)
<S>                                                                         <C>           <C>
Note payable, due in 48 monthly installments of $4,751 including
   interest at 9.25%, final payment due on May 1, 2000, unsecured            $ 144,000    $ 145,000

Installment note for purchase of equipment, interest accrues at the
   bank's prime rate, plus 1.5% (10.00% at December 31, 1995), payable
   in 60 monthly payments of $4,167 plus interest, final payment due on
   January 1, 1998, secured by equipment with a carrying value of
   $59,000 at December 31, 1995                                                 90,000      102,000

Note payable, due in 36 monthly installments of $3,000, including
   interest at 6.66%, final payment due on November 1, 1997, unsecured          54,000       62,000

Note payable, due in 36 monthly installments of $2,059, including
   interest at 8.00%, final payment due on June 1, 1998, unsecured              49,000       54,000

Note payable to a bank, due in 36 monthly installments of $3,051,
   including interest at 9.75% rate, final payment due on February 1,
   1998, unsecured                                                              53,000       61,000

Notes payable, due in monthly installments from $216 to $854, including
   interest from 8.00% to 14.06%, final payments due from August 12,
   1996 to April 27, 1998, secured by vehicles with a carrying value of
   $52,000 at December 31, 1995                                                 61,000       51,000
                                                                             ---------    ---------
                                                                               451,000      475,000
Less current maturities of long-term debt                                     (221,000)    (182,000)
                                                                             ---------    ---------
Long-term debt                                                               $ 230,000    $ 293,000
                                                                             ---------    ---------
                                                                             ---------    ---------
</TABLE>

                                     D-20

<PAGE>


Annual maturities of long-term debt are as follows:


         Year ending December 31-
            1996                                             $182,000
            1997                                              174,000
            1998                                               57,000
            1999                                               44,000
            2000                                               18,000
                                                           ----------
                                                             $475,000
                                                           ----------
                                                           ----------

The Company has outstanding borrowings of $272,000 and $330,000 under a $500,000
revolving line of credit with a bank at December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996,
respectively.  Interest accrues at the bank's prime rate plus 1% (9.5% at
December 31, 1995), and is payable monthly.  All outstanding principal and
accrued interest is due on July 11, 1996.  The line of credit is secured by all
funds in the bank's custody and the Company's accounts receivable and inventory
balances.

In June 1996, the Company paid the outstanding balance and terminated this line
of credit agreement.

In April 1996, the Company along with Interwest Group and affiliates entered
into a $4.3 million revolving line of credit agreement and the Company is
jointly and severally liable under the agreement.  This agreement includes a
provision that should the Company's ownership change by more than 49%, it will
be considered an event of default.

Under the provisions of certain debt agreements, the Company is required to
maintain compliance with certain financial covenants, among other restrictions,
including a trading ratio which is based on the ratio of various fixed assets to
accounts payable, accrued expenses and principal outstanding on the loan, and a
maximum borrowings ratio based on accounts receivable and inventory.


                                     D-21

<PAGE>

(4) INCOME TAXES

Deferred income tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 1995, are as follows:

      Current:
        Allowance for doubtful accounts                    $   31,000
        Deferred revenue                                       50,000
                                                          -----------
              Current deferred tax asset                   $   81,000
                                                          -----------
                                                          -----------
      Noncurrent:
        Amortization of noncompetes                        $   18,000
        Deferred revenue                                       38,000
        Customer lists                                         38,000
        Accelerated depreciation for tax and other           (138,000)
                                                          -----------
              Noncurrent deferred tax liabilities, net     $  (44,000)
                                                          -----------
                                                          -----------

Components of the income tax expense are as follows:

                                                             SEVEN
                                                             MONTHS
                                                             ENDED
                                                           DECEMBER 31,
                                                              1995
                                                            --------
        Current expense                                     $ 72,000
        Deferred benefit                                     (27,000)
                                                          ----------
        Income tax expense                                  $ 45,000
                                                          ----------
                                                          ----------

The income tax expense for the seven month period ended December 31, 1995 is
reconciled to the amount computed by applying the statutory federal tax rate to
income as follows:

    Income tax expense per federal statutory rate       $15,000       35%
    State income taxes, net of federal deduction          1,000        3%
    Goodwill amortization                                22,000       52%
    Nondeductible meals and entertainment                 5,000       12%
    Other nondeductible expenses                          2,000        5%
                                                      ---------   -------
                                                        $45,000      107%
                                                      ---------   -------
                                                      ---------   -------

                                     D-22

<PAGE>

(5) COMMITMENTS

The Company has several operating leases for office space, vehicles and
equipment, which expire at various times through 2001.  In addition, the Company
leases its Colorado Springs office and operations facility from a related party
under an operating lease agreement which expires on May 31, 2000.  Rent expense,
related to the operating leases, for the seven months ended December 31, 1995
was $141,000.  Aggregate minimum annual rentals under such leases are as
follows:

         Year ending December 31-
           1996                                          $  337,000
           1997                                             300,000
           1998                                             260,000
           1999                                             235,000
           2000                                             182,000
           Thereafter                                        80,000
                                                       ------------
                                                         $1,394,000
                                                       ------------
                                                       ------------

(6) RETIREMENT AND BONUS PLANS

The Company has established a 401(k) retirement plan covering substantially all
of their employees who have been employed with the Company for one year and who
are at least 21 years of age.  Each employee's contribution up to a maximum of
10% is matched 50% by the Company.  The Company may also make additional cash
contributions at the discretion of the Board of Directors.  Employees are fully
vested in employer contributions after they complete six years of service. 
Contributions of $38,000 were made for the seven months ended December 31, 1995.

The Company awards bonuses to certain management personnel which are based on
various performance factors and are awarded at the discretion of the Company's
management.  Subsequent to March 31, 1996, the Company awarded and paid bonuses
of approximately $35,000 which will be expensed over the remaining nine months
of 1996.


                                     D-23

<PAGE>

(7) RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

At December 31, 1995 and March 31, 1996, the Company owed approximately $422,000
and $356,000 to Interwest Group primarily for cash draws and for its share of
insurance which is provided by Anschutz and allocated to the Company.

(8) CONTINGENCIES

The Company is a party to three employment related legal and or administrative
proceedings which have arisen out of the ordinary course of business.  Although
the ultimate resolution of these matters is uncertain, management believes that
the actions are without merit and that the outcome will not have a material
adverse effect on the Company's financial position or results of operations. 
The Company has not recorded any liability amounts related to these matters.

(9) FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

Financial instruments include cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable,
accounts payable and other accrued liabilities.  The carrying amounts for these
financial instruments approximate fair value due to the short-term maturity of
these instruments.  Debt is also a financial instrument and based upon the
difference in prevailing interest rates when the debt was issued and the
prevailing interest rates at December 31, 1995, the carrying values approximate
fair values.


                                     D-24



<PAGE>



                        INDEPENDENT AUDITOR'S REPORT







To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of
Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation
Colorado Springs, CO



We have audited the combined balance sheets (not separately included herein) 
of Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation and affiliates as of May 31, 
1995, March 31, 1995 and 1994 and the accompanying related combined 
statements of income, retained earnings, and cash flows for the two months 
ended May 31, 1995 and the years ended March 31, 1995 and 1994. These 
combined financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's 
management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial 
statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing 
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to 
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the combined financial statements 
are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test 
basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the combined 
financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting 
principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as 
evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our 
audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the combined balance sheets referred to above present fairly, 
in all material respects, the combined financial position of Interwest 
Communications C.S. Corporation and affiliates as of May 31, 1995, March 31, 
1995 and March 31, 1994 and the results of their operations and their cash 
flows for the two months ended May 31, 1995 and the years ended March 31, 
1995 and March 31, 1994 in conformity with generally accepted accounting 
principles.




Hilderbrand & Associates, P.C.
Certified Public Accountants


Colorado Springs, Colorado
August 11, 1995


                                     D-25 

<PAGE>

         INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

            COMBINED STATEMENTS OF INCOME AND RETAINED EARNINGS


                                      TWO MONTHS 
                                        ENDED           FOR THE YEARS ENDED
                                        MAY 31,               MARCH 31,
                                      ----------     --------------------------
                                         1995           1995           1994    
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------
NET SALES                             $1,966,000     $12,075,000    $12,219,000
  Cost of Sales                        1,102,000       7,011,000      7,189,000
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------
GROSS PROFIT                             864,000       5,064,000      5,030,000

SELLING, GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE      865,000       4,212,000      3,912,000
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------

INCOME (LOSS) FROM OPERATIONS             (1,000)        852,000      1,118,000

  Other Income (Expense), net             29,000             -          (23,000)
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------

INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES AND 
 MINORITY INTERESTS                       28,000         852,000      1,095,000

  Provision (Benefit) for Income Taxes 
    Current                               17,000         344,000        379,000
    Deferred                              (9,000)        (30,000)         5,000
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------
                                           8,000         314,000        384,000
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------

INCOME BEFORE MINORITY INTERESTS          20,000         538,000        711,000

  Minority Interests in Income           (10,000)        (71,000)       (84,000)
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------

NET INCOME                                10,000         467,000        627,000

RETAINED EARNINGS AT BEGINNING PERIOD  1,603,000       1,136,000        509,000
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------

RETAINED EARNINGS AT END OF PERIOD    $1,613,000     $ 1,603,000    $ 1,136,000
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------
                                      ----------     -----------    -----------



              SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO THESE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.


                                     D-26 

<PAGE>

             INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

                        COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS


                                      TWO MONTHS                               
                                        ENDED            FOR THE YEARS ENDED   
                                       MAY 31,               MARCH 31,         
                                      ----------     ------------------------- 
                                        1995            1995          1994     
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES: 
  Net income                          $  10,000       $ 467,000    $   627,000 
  Adjustments to reconcile net income 
   to net cash provided by operating
   activities:
    Minority interests in net income 
     of consolidated subsidiary and 
     combined affiliates                 10,000          71,000         84,000 
    Depreciation and amortization        40,000         118,000        157,000 
    Provision for bad debts               5,000          83,000         94,000 
    Deferred tax expense (benefit)       (9,000)        (31,000)         5,000 
    (Increase) decrease in: 
      Receivables                       100,000        (134,000)    (1,452,000)
      Inventories                      (524,000)       (194,000)        59,000
      Prepaid expenses                  (20,000)        (48,000)       (21,000)
      Deposits and other                (10,000)          1,000         (3,000)
    Increase (decrease) in: 
      Accounts payable                  318,000         228,000         88,000
      Accrued liabilities               (89,000)          7,000        414,000
      Billings in excess of costs        (2,000)          2,000        (49,000)
      Deposits on uncompleted 
       contracts                         45,000         211,000        (26,000)
      Deferred revenues                  29,000          22,000        (62,000)
      Warranty reserves                  18,000          69,000            -   
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 
NET CASH PROVIDED BY (USED IN) 
 OPERATING ACTIVITIES                   (79,000)        872,000        (85,000)

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES: 
  Collection on installment sales         9,000          16,000         15,000 
  Purchase of property and equipment    (36,000)       (157,000)       (49,000)
  Proceeds from sales of property 
   and equipment                            -             9,000            -   
  Loans to minority interest 
   shareholder                              -               -          (37,000)
  Purchases of intangible assets        (42,000)        (30,000)           -   
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 

NET CASH USED IN INVESTING ACTIVITIES   (69,000)       (162,000)       (71,000)

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITY: 
  Proceeds from short term debt             -               -          480,000 
  Payments on short term debt               -               -         (507,000)
  Proceeds from long term debt              -            91,000            -   
  Payments on long term debt            (36,000)       (150,000)      (114,000)
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 

NET CASH USED IN FINANCING ACTIVITIES   (36,000)        (59,000)      (141,000)
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 

NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH        (184,000)        651,000       (297,000)

CASH, at beginning of year              754,000         103,000        400,000 
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 

CASH, at end of year                  $ 570,000       $ 754,000    $   103,000 
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 
                                      ---------       ---------    ----------- 




         SEE ACCOMPANYING NOTES TO THESE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.

                                   D-27 

<PAGE>

         INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

                  NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 



1.   ORGANIZATION AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES:

     ORGANIZATION - Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation (Interwest 
     C.S.), Work Telcom Services, Inc. (Work Telcom), Interwest Communications 
     Pueblo Corporation (Interwest Pueblo), and Interwest Sound Communications,
     Inc. (Interwest Sound) are incorporated under the laws of the Sate of 
     Colorado. The companies are affiliated through common ownership and 
     management and are engaged primarily in the business of selling, leasing, 
     installing, and maintaining telephone communication systems.

     PRINCIPLES OF COMBINATION - The combined financial statements include 
     the consolidated accounts of Interwest C.S. and its 58.2% subsidiary, Work
     Telcom and the affiliated companies of Interwest Pueblo and Interwest 
     Sound. The sole shareholder of Interwest C.S. owns 51% of the outstanding
     common stock of Interwest Pueblo and his spouse owns 75% of the outstanding
     common stock of Interwest Sound. The minority interests of Work Telcom, 
     Interwest Pueblo, and Interwest Sound are owned by the respective manager 
     of each company. All material intercompany transactions and balances have 
     been eliminated.

     REVENUE RECOGNITION - Interwest C.S., Work Telcom, and Interwest Pueblo 
     are on the completed contract method under which revenues and costs are 
     recognized at the time a contract is completed, unless it becomes apparent 
     that a contract will result in a loss, then such loss is provided for 
     currently. Accordingly, inventory and labor costs are deferred along with 
     related billings until such time as the contract is complete. Interwest 
     C.S., Work Telcom, and Interwest Pueblo also have maintenance agreements
     with customers. Revenue received in advance is deferred and recognized over
     the terms of the maintenance agreements.

     Interwest Sound is on the percentage-of-completion method under which 
     revenues from contracts are recognized by measuring the percentage of costs
     incurred to date to estimated total costs for each contract. That method is
     used because management considers total cost to be the best available 
     measure of progress on the contracts. Contract costs include direct 
     material and labor costs and those indirect costs related to contract 
     performance, such as indirect labor, supplies, tools, repairs, and 
     depreciation costs. Operating costs are charged to expense as incurred. 
     Provisions for estimated losses on incomplete contracts are made in the 
     period in which such losses are determined. Changes in job performance, 
     job conditions, and estimated profitability, may result in revisions to 
     costs and income and are recognized in the period in which the revisions 
     are determined.

     ALLOWANCE FOR DOUBTFUL ACCOUNTS - Bad debts are recognized by the 
     establishment of an allowance for expected losses on receivables that may 
     become uncollectible.

     PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT - Depreciation for property and equipment owned 
     by the companies is computed on a straight-line basis over the estimated 
     life of the related asset, which range from three to ten years. 
     Expenditures for major renewals and betterments that extend the useful 
     lives of property and equipment are capitalized. Expenditures for 
     maintenance and repairs are charged to expense as incurred.


                                   D-28 

<PAGE>

         INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

                  NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 



     INCOME TAXES - The Company accounts for income taxes under the liability 
     method, which requires recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities
     for the expected future tax consequences of events that have been included
     in the financial statements or tax returns. Under this method, deferred tax
     assets and liabilities are determined based on the difference between the 
     financial statements and tax bases of assets and liabilities using enacted
     tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to 
     reverse.

     RECLASSIFICATION - Certain reclassifications have been made to the combined
     financial statements to present them on a consistent basis between periods.
     Such reclassifications had no material effect on net income.


2.   CASH FLOW INFORMATION:

     Cash paid for interest and income taxes consisted of:

                                  TWO MONTHS         FOR THE        
                                    ENDED          YEARS ENDED      
                                   MAY 31,           MARCH 31,      
                                  ----------   -------------------- 
                                     1995        1995        1994   
                                  ----------   --------     ------- 
           Interest                 $2,000     $ 24,000     $31,000 
                                    ------     --------     ------- 
                                    ------     --------     ------- 
           Income Taxes             $   -      $375,000     $24,000 
                                    ------     --------     ------- 
                                    ------     --------     ------- 

     Non-cash investing and financing activities consisted of:

           Two Months Ended May 31, 1995:

             Purchase of vehicles and equipment with financing through bank 
             loans of $156,000. Purchase of inventory and customer lists through
             notes payable for $261,000.

           Year Ended March 31, 1995:

             Purchase of vehicles and equipment with financing through bank 
             loans and capital lease arrangements of $66,000.

           Year Ended March 31, 1994:

             Purchase of customer list through note payable for $98,000.


                                   D-29 

<PAGE>

         INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

                  NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 




3.   INCOME TAX PROVISION:

     The provisions for incomes taxes for the years ended March 31, 1995 and 
     1994 approximate the expected statutory rate for Federal income taxes after
     considering the effects of the surtax exemption and state taxes. Also, in 
     fiscal 1994, the Company realized a tax benefit of approximately $23,000 
     from the utilization of a net operation loss carryforward.


4.   PROFIT SHARING PLAN:

     The Companies have established a profit-sharing plan covering substantially
     all of their employees. The plan is a defined contribution plan that 
     qualifies under Internal Revenue Code Section 401(k). The companies will 
     match an employee's contribution $.50 for every dollar contributed, and 
     will also make additional contributions as cash flows permit. The 
     employers' matching contribution expenses were as follows:


                                           TWO MONTHS         FOR THE        
                                             ENDED          YEARS ENDED      
                                            MAY 31,           MARCH 31,      
                                           ----------   -------------------- 
                                              1995        1995        1994   
                                           ----------   --------     ------- 
           Interwest C.S. and Work Telcom    $7,000      $37,000     $34,000 
           
           Interwest Pueblo                   1,000        8,000       7,000 
           Interwest Sound                    1,000        3,000       4,000 
                                             ------      -------     ------- 
                                             $9,000      $48,000     $45,000 
                                             ------      -------     ------- 
                                             ------      -------     ------- 

     The Companies also made profit sharing contributions for the years ending
     March 31, 1995 and 1994 of $-0- and $75,000, respectively.


5.   LEASES:

     PROPERTY LEASED TO OTHERS - Interwest C.S. lease various equipment, to 
     others, with various terms and renewal options. The operating method is 
     used to report revenue from those leasing activities and the cost of those
     leased assets, less related accumulated depreciation is carried on the 
     Company's balance sheet.

     PROPERTY LEASED FROM OTHERS - Interwest C.S. leases its corporate offices
     and operations facilities in Colorado Springs under operating leases 
     expiring on March 31, 1996 from its sole shareholder. Interwest C.S. is 
     responsible for all taxes, maintenance and insurance on the property. Rent
     expense for both years ending March 31, 1995 and 1995 was $48,000 each year
     and $8,000 for the two months ended May 31, 1995. Interwest C.S. also 
     leases its operations facility in Denver under an operating lease which 
     expires 

                                   D-30 

<PAGE>

         INTERWEST COMMUNICATIONS C.S. CORPORATION AND AFFILIATES

                  NOTES TO COMBINED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 




     September 30, 1995. Interwest Pueblo leases its operations facility in 
     Pueblo under a three year operating lease expiring March 1, 1997.

     At March 31, 1995, future minimum lease payments by year were as follows:

                                                         CAPITAL   OPERATING 
          YEAR ENDED MARCH 31,                            LEASES     LEASES  
          --------------------                           -------   --------- 
                 1996                                    $15,000    $74,000 
                 1997                                     14,000     10,000 
                                                         -------    ------- 

           Total future minimum lease payments           $29,000    $84,000 
                                                         -------    ------- 
                                                         -------    ------- 


6.   SUBSEQUENT EVENTS:

     On June 1, 1995, the sole shareholder of Interwest C.S. and 51% shareholder
     of Interwest Pueblo sold his common stock in those companies to Interwest 
     Group, Inc. (formerly West Hazmat Companies, Inc.).














                                   D-31 

<PAGE>
                                                                      APPENDIX E

                     U.S. SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D.C. 20549

                                  FORM  10-KSB

[X]  Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 OR 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
     Act of 1934 [Fee Required]

For Fiscal year ended            JANUARY 31, 1996                             
                      ------------------------------------------------------- 
                                       or
[ ]  Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities
     Exchange Act of 1934 [No Fee Required]

For the transition period from       N/A        to         N/A       
                               ----------------    ----------------- 
Commission file number               0-19578                         
                       --------------------------------------------- 

                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
           (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

         COLORADO                                84-1095516           
- --------------------------------    ---------------------------------
State or other jurisdiction of               (I.R.S. Employer   
incorporation or organization             Identification Number)

 7100 E. BELLEVIEW AVE., SUITE 201, GREENWOOD VILLAGE, COLORADO 80111   
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------- 
 (Address of principal executive offices)                    (Zip Code) 

Registrant's telephone number, including area code   (303) 770-7600
                                                   -------------------- 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:  NONE

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

                           COMMON STOCK, NO PAR VALUE 
                           -------------------------- 
                                (Title of Class)

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports 
required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the 
registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to 
such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  [X] Yes   [ ] No  

At April 22, 1996, 2,400,686 shares of Common Stock, no par value, were 
outstanding.  The aggregate market value of the Common Stock held by 
non-affiliates of the Registrant on that date was approximately $6,184,528.

Total revenues for the fiscal year ended January 31, 1996 is $18,528,000  
                                                             ------------ 

Documents incorporated by reference: May 3,1996 Proxy Statement (Part III) 
                                     ------------------------------------- 

<PAGE>

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 
405 of Regulation S-K (S 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, 
and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant's knowledge, in 
definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part 
III of this Form 10-KSB or any amendment to this Form 10-KSB.   [ X ]

Page 1 of  32  pages.           Exhibits are indexed on page 18.
         -----                                                  
(Complete Copy)


                                   APPENDIX E



<PAGE>

                                     PART I


Item 1.   DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS

THE COMPANY

     Internet Communications Corporation ("Internet" or "the Company") is a 
multi-faceted telecommunications company providing a broad range of data 
communications equipment, services and carrier circuits to business and 
individual clients.  These clients are engaged in the fields of retail, 
banking, education, insurance, libraries, health care and other business 
enterprises.  To meet its purpose of being a single source supplier of all 
necessary products and services, the Company maintains three divisions.  
These divisions include the design and monitoring of communication networks; 
the resale, installation and maintenance of telecommunications equipment; 
and the lease and sale of dedicated, high speed fiber optic circuits.

     Network design services include the customized design and monitoring of 
a communications network which allows the high speed transmission of data, 
voice, fax and video within a defined geographical area.  This division also 
provides the technical support necessary to effectively install and maintain 
the efficient operation of the network and its individualized component 
parts. As each customer is unique in their requirements for data transmission 
and requires the integration of a wide range of complex technologies, 
Internet seeks to create a telecommunications network which is unique to that 
customer and their industry.

     As an integral part of providing data communications services, Internet, 
by contractual agreement, resells, installs, maintains, and repairs data 
communications equipment manufactured by such companies as Tellabs 
Operations, Inc. ("Tellabs"), 3Com Corporation, Cisco, Wellfleet, Network 
Equipment Technologies (NET), Premisys, Motorola ICG (formerly Codex Corp.), 
Gandalf Technologies, Inc., Racal-Datacom, Inc., and Scitec. This division 
enables Internet to directly provide the customers with equipment which it 
feels is the most compatible to operate within their 


                                                                            3 
<PAGE>

individually designed systems and most economical for their communications 
needs.  These products consist of modems, multiplexers, network control and 
interchange devices, and frame relay and ISDN access devices.

Internet has non-exclusive agreements with long distance carriers such as 
WilTel, Inc., Sprint, QWEST, ICG, MCI and AT&T.  Pursuant to the agreements 
with these companies, Internet resells and/or leases these fiber optic 
carrier circuits to its customers for the local and long distance 
transmission of voice, data, fax, and video communications.  These circuits, 
also known as dedicated lines, provide the means by which data transmissions 
are carried throughout the United States and the various locations within a 
customer's communications network.

     In the past, Internet maintained a software development division which 
developed various software products related to its core business of 
communication networks.  Sales of the Company's software products have not 
been significant during the past two years, nor are they expected to be in 
the future.  As further discussed in  Software Design and Development 
included elsewhere herein, the Company experienced a substantial write-down 
of software development costs in fiscal 1995.  As a result, the Company 
intends to refocus its efforts towards its core business of selling and 
supporting telecommunications products.  The Company currently does not have 
definitive commitments for software development, however, it may on a limited 
basis develop software if it can be done with reasonable assurance that such 
development can be done profitably.  The Company will also continue to 
provide software maintenance and support for its customers, based on contract 
terms discussed later in this section.

     The Company's headquarters and principal offices are located at 7100 
East Belleview Avenue, Suite 201, Greenwood Village, Colorado  80111.  Its 
telephone number is (303) 770-7600.

INDUSTRY OVERVIEW AND MARKET NICHE

     Formerly, the telecommunications industry was a monopoly controlled by 
AT&T which required consumers to use a single 
                                                                            4 
<PAGE>

provider for a wide range of communications needs for the transmission over 
phone lines of voice, data, fax, and video information.  Such transmissions 
require the use of data circuits which are telephone lines engineered to 
allow data transmission and specialized communications equipment which are 
commonly referred to as modems, data service units, pads, switches, and 
multiplexers.

     In addition, AT&T provided all long distance telephone line service, 
dedicated data and voice circuits and local exchange service through a series 
of wholly-owned or majority-owned local monopolies.  After years of 
anti-trust litigation with the Department of Justice, AT&T divested itself, 
in January 1984, of 22 Bell Operating Companies which now provide only local 
exchange service.  AT&T was permitted to continue as a supplier of both 
intrastate and interstate long distance service and dedicated lines.
 
Recent legal and business decisions have introduced elements of significant 
change into the telecommunications industry.  Major access providers 
(telephone service providers, cable providers, wireless providers, and 
others) have undertaken significant investment programs resulting in mergers 
and consolidations, new service offerings from traditional access providers, 
and in general confusion in the marketplace.  While these firms may not be 
direct competitors, their actions do introduce an element of uncertainty and 
opportunity into the industry environment.

     The industry in which Internet competes is comprised primarily of 
single-source, one dimensional equipment suppliers and/or resellers.  These 
companies typically resell data communications equipment to customers based 
on price discounts not matched by the manufacturer.  Unlike the Company, they 
frequently do not provide the range of "value-added" services such as design, 
installation, maintenance, repair or related services such as network 
management or carrier circuits.

     Internet, being a multiple-source provider, is able to approach each 
customer's communications needs from a network design perspective.  Internet 
begins by evaluating a customer's individual business information requirements,
and then designs a comprehensive 

                                                                            5 
<PAGE>

communications network that best meets those requirements. Internet 
thereafter recommends and supplies the necessary equipment, software and 
dedicated circuits that best perform within their overall network design.

PRINCIPAL DIVISIONS

     NETWORK MANAGEMENT SERVICES

     The design of a customer's communications network is provided as part of 
the sales proposal at no additional cost and it is this aspect of the 
Company's business that gives it the ability to provide a value-added service 
within the telecommunications industry.  Because communications networks 
require the integration and installation of a wide range of complex 
technologies, the Company's customers which include commercial enterprises, 
government agencies, banks, educational institutions, insurance companies 
and others are increasingly turning to outside firms which have the expertise 
and experience to design and create a customized data communication network.

     To meet this demand, Internet offers network system analysis, network 
system design, and network management services.  Network analysis involves 
providing customers with technical communications system consulting services. 
Network design involves providing a comprehensive, customized, communications 
system based on each customer's specific needs.  Network management involves 
providing trained communications technicians who monitor and evaluate both 
the overall performance of a customer's entire network as well as each 
individual component of the system.  Network management also assists in the 
future reconfiguration and the addition of new equipment to a network as well 
as tracking performance for long-term network growth.  Internet's network 
management facilities operate 24 hours a day, seven days a week at the 
Company's office in the Denver metropolitan area.  A trained communications 
technician is present at Internet's facilities at all times.

     COMMUNICATIONS EQUIPMENT:  DIRECT SALES 

     Internet's management and engineers are constantly evaluating 

                                                                            6 
<PAGE>

products, services, and newly available industry technology.  In order to 
supply the best performing communications equipment to its customers, 
negotiations with potential suppliers are continually in process.  Internet 
believes it is able to provide technologically advanced products at a cost 
below its competitors because it is a value-added reseller and has 
non-exclusive dealer agreements with suppliers.   This enables the Company to 
offer products below the manufacturer's list price by offering discounts and 
making up any lost margins by selling other services such as data circuits 
and equipment maintenance and installation.

     By offering a selection of equipment from a variety of sources Internet 
can provide customers with the best communications equipment to fit their 
particular needs and their specially designed communications network.

     The multiplexers, modems and switching devices manufactured by 
Internet's suppliers are utilized within a communications network to 
interface signal transmissions within the network; convert digital signals 
into analog and visa versa for transmission over dedicated circuits between 
two or more user locations, and allocate and breakdown various signals 
between user locations and within the overall network.

     Pursuant to Internet's agreements with its suppliers, Internet receives 
preferential pricing, credit and delivery terms by virtue of being a 
value-added integrator/reseller and maintaining certain inventory levels.  
Typically, the agreements are for a twelve month period and are automatically 
renewed annually unless an earlier termination occurs by either party on 30 
to 60 days notice. The agreements are non-exclusive and allow Internet the 
right to sell the manufacturers' products throughout the United States.

     In February, 1994, the Company formed a joint venture with Inacom Corp., 
Omaha, Nebraska, for the purpose of opening an office in Minneapolis, 
Minnesota for direct sales of both companies' products and services. Late in 
1994, the joint venture expanded its operations into Milwaukee, Wisconsin and 
Omaha, Nebraska. The joint venture proved to be an unprofitable undertaking 
for the Company. Effective June 1, 1995, the joint venture was dissolved, and 
the 

                                                                            7 
<PAGE>

Company integrated the joint venture's remaining operation (the Minneapolis 
office) into Internet.

COMMUNICATIONS EQUIPMENT:  INDIRECT SALES

     Internet signed a one-year agreement in early 1992 with Tellabs which 
granted the Company master distribution rights to sell Tellabs 300 Series 
products to other distributors located in the Western United States.  In 
January 1993, Tellabs and Internet entered into a subsequent agreement which 
replaced and expanded the 1992 agreement in the area of technological 
development.  In the Product Development, Supply and License Agreement (the 
"Agreement"), Tellabs granted Internet primary responsibility for ongoing 
development of the 300 Series packet-switching products in exchange for 
near-exclusive domestic distribution rights for the reseller channel.  
Pursuant to the Agreement, all value-added resellers located in the United 
States purchasing the Tellabs 300 Series products must now order and purchase 
these products directly from Internet.  Internet maintains sufficient 
quantities of inventory to deliver the product as it is ordered by these 
resellers.  The Agreement is for a period of four years, expiring in late 
1996. Under this agreement, the Company was to make a substantial financial 
commitment in the development and maintenance of software for Tellabs' 
products.  As discussed under Software Design and Development, included 
elsewhere herein, the Company completed development in early 1995 of the 
software development, but realized in late 1994 that the market for the 
product had deteriorated substantially.  This resulted in a substantial 
write-down of the software development by the Company in 1994 resulting in a 
significant fiscal 1995 loss. The Company retains the existing distribution 
rights and will provide software support and maintenance for the 300 Series 
products at a level requiring a significantly lower financial obligation to 
the Company.

     The Company added several new product lines into the Indirect Sales 
channel in fiscal 1995 and fiscal 1996.  Those products are manufactured by 
such companies as Premisys, Cisco, Scitec, Gandalf and N E T.

COMMUNICATIONS EQUIPMENT:  INSTALLATION, MAINTENANCE AND REPAIR

                                                                            8 
<PAGE>

     In addition to merely reselling communications equipment, Internet 
offers its customers installation, maintenance, and repair services.   The 
Company's field engineers perform all equipment installations whether on site 
in Colorado or elsewhere in the United States.  Equipment maintenance is 
provided on site in Colorado and other locations throughout the United States 
by Internet technicians or by way of subcontracts with Codex, Tellabs, AT&T 
and other independent service companies.  Internet also fulfills warranty 
requirements on products sold by the Company (which generally involve 
replacement of defective parts), as well as offering extended maintenance 
agreements during and after expiration of the manufacturer's original 
warranty.

DEDICATED LINE SERVICES

     Internet provides to its customers, at reduced rates, circuits for long 
distance data transmissions to and from cities throughout the United States. 
Internet purchases high speed T1-Fiber Optic circuits from major carriers 
such as WilTel which run to major cities and carry up to 24 data circuits per 
line. T1 circuits are an AT&T developed standard for digital transmission of 
voice, data and video at an extremely high speed rate of transmission. 
Internet presently has installed T1 circuits in Colorado Springs, Dallas, 
Chicago, Kansas City, Houston, Los Angeles, San Francisco, Las Vegas, 
Phoenix, Detroit, Washington D.C., Casper, Billings, Salt Lake City, Omaha, 
Oklahoma City, Eau Claire, Atlanta, Orlando, Charlotte, Seattle, Minneapolis, 
Helena, Cheyenne, New York City, Boise, Portland, and Albuquerque.

SOFTWARE DESIGN AND DEVELOPMENT

     As previously discussed, effective January 1993, the Company signed the 
Agreement with Tellabs, a manufacturer of data communications equipment, 
whereby the Company became a national distributor of the Tellabs 300 Series 
packet-switching products and has granted the Company a non-exclusive license 
for the use of its technology during the four-year term of the Agreement. The 
Company is obligated to provide technical development and enhancements of the 
manufacturer's products in the form of sustaining engineering. The Company is 
obligated to spend each year 12% of the total 

                                                                            9 
<PAGE>

revenues from sales of the manufacturer's products for the prior year. Due to 
declining sales of this technology, this is not considered to be a 
significant continuing obligation.

     During the past two years the Company has met this commitment and 
capitalized significant costs related to software development. During the 
fourth quarter of fiscal 1995 the Company re-evaluated the net realizability 
of its capitalized software.  At that time it was determined that due to 
technological changes in the market as well as delays in completing 
development, the projected market for its software product was substantially 
lower than previously anticipated.  While the Company completed the software 
development subsequent to year-end, the related capitalized costs were in 
excess of the anticipated future profit from the sale of the product.  In 
conjunction with the completion of the software, the Company has closed its 
software development office and written down certain specialized computer 
equipment to its estimated net realizable value.  This has resulted in a 
write-off of $1,475,000 of cost in fiscal 1995, a substantial portion of 
which had previously been capitalized during that year.

     The Company may, as some future time, determine to develop new software 
products.  However, such development efforts would expect to be on a limited 
basis.

SALES AND MARKETING

     Internet's sales and marketing functions are currently staffed by four 
(4) sales managers and seventeen (17) account executives. Internet's direct 
sales account executives initially contact potential customers from referrals 
from other customers or by direct mail or telephone.  Follow-up meetings are 
then scheduled to evaluate and provide recommendations as to system design 
and equipment necessary to effectively operate within their network.

     Indirect sales representatives work directly with resellers located in a 
defined geographic region.  Many of these resellers have been referred to 
Internet as a result of their past association with the product manufacturer. 
New resellers are solicited by the sales representatives in areas where the 
product 

                                                                            10 
<PAGE>

is not currently available.  Internet has indirect account executives located 
in Los Angeles and New Jersey.

RECENT DEVELOPMENTS

     In January, 1996, Internet established two new product groups - LAN 
(Local Area Network) and Internet Services. The LAN group was formed to 
address customer needs in local area network design, consulting, 
installation, and maintenance.  The Internet Services group was formed to 
take advantage of customer requests for access and services related to the 
"internet". Both product offerings are considered to be complimentary 
offering which further leverage Internet's relationship with its customers.

CUSTOMERS
 
     No single customer accounted for more than 10% of sales in the fiscal 
year ended January 31, 1996.

SEASONALITY

     The sales of the Company are not seasonal to any significant extent.  
Sales may decrease or increase at various times throughout a year due to 
customers delaying purchases while waiting for new product announcements and 
increasing purchases subsequent to such announcements.

BACKLOG

     The Company receives orders and is awarded contracts for the sale and 
installation of network systems to be installed in the future.  As of January 
31, 1996, there were fifty-three (53) orders received from various customers 
which will account for approximately $315,000 in future sales.  Substantially 
all of these orders are expected to be shipped and installed before April 30, 
1996.

     In addition, the Company has on-going contracts with customers that 
range from one (1) to five (5) years for network management, 

                                                                            11 
<PAGE>

maintenance service and data circuits which provides monthly recurring 
revenue to the Company.  The total monthly revenue provided by these 
contracts was $673,000 per month as of January 31, 1996.

COMPETITION

     The Company competes with numerous dealers and distributors in the Rocky 
Mountain Region and the United States for the original sale of data 
communications products.  The Company's management believes that these 
distributors and dealers do not pose serious competition to Internet's 
business because management knows of no other competitor providing 
comprehensive, value-added services such as network analysis, design, and 
management, as well as providing dedicated lines.  However, it is possible 
that larger companies with more capital and technical personnel available to 
it will in the future come into direct competition with the Company.  Also, 
the Company competes with the direct manufacturers' local sales 
representatives.  However, these sales representatives typically focus on 
larger accounts and sell only products of the manufacturers they represent, 
prohibiting the flexibility and cost savings of combining products of 
numerous manufacturers.

     With respect to the sale and lease of dedicated lines, several major 
carriers presently represent the Company's greatest competition--including 
AT&T, MCI, and Sprint.  Heavily regulated by the Federal Communications 
Commission ("FCC"), these companies derive most of their revenues through 
long distance dial tone services to businesses and residences.  These 
companies also actively market dedicated data and voice circuits.  In 
addition, WilTel, ACI, ITT, and WTCI, offer dedicated circuits in both the 
voice and data environments. These carriers typically offer their circuits at 
a price below AT&T, MCI, and Sprint, and closer to the Company's pricing, 
representing intense competition. However, management believes these carriers 
do not offer products and services such as network management, equipment or 
training.

GOVERNMENT REGULATION

     The Company's operations are subject to regulation by the 

                                                                            12 
<PAGE>

Federal Communications Commission ("FCC") under the Communications Act of 
1934, as amended.  The FCC establishes the prices that the Company and the 
other intercity carriers competing with AT&T are able to charge customers.  
In August 1982, the FCC substantially deregulated non-facilities-based, 
territorial resale carriers such as the Company, and no longer requires 
certification of these type of carriers or the filing of tariffs.  The 
Company and other such carriers will, however, still be subject to the duty 
to provide service upon reasonable request, as well as not to engage in 
discriminatory activities.  While the FCC has elected not to exercise its 
authority to regulate the rates and services of the Company, the FCC may 
elect to do so in the future.  To the extent the FCC should elect to regulate 
territorial resale carriers, the Company's rates and the services it could 
render would be established and controlled by the FCC. This could have the 
effect of reducing the rates the Company could charge and therefore reduce 
operating revenues as well as limiting the services it currently offers to 
its customers.

     The Company's ability to provide intrastate dedicated line service is 
also subject to regulation in each state by the appropriate state regulatory 
agency. Colorado's and other states' publicly utility commissions permit 
certain re-sellers and certified carriers such as Internet to carry 
intrastate long distance and dedicated line traffic without regulation.  Only 
the local exchange companies such as U.S. West are permitted to carry 
intrastate (local) traffic.

EMPLOYEES

     On March 31, 1996, the Company employed seventy (70) full-time 
employees, including three (3) executive officers, twenty-one (21) in sales 
and marketing, thirty (30) in network operations and technical services, 
twenty (21) in accounting and administration and three (3) in product 
development.  The Company has non-compete and confidentiality agreements with 
its sales account executives and engineers.



                                                                            13 

<PAGE>

Item 2.   DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTIES

     The Company leases approximately 26,000 square foot facility located at 
7100 East Belleview Avenue, Suite 201, Greenwood Village, Colorado 80111.  
The Company currently pays rental of approximately $31,000 per month. The 
Company also leases 2,000 square feet of general office space in Edina, 
Minnesota at a cost of $900 per month.

     Internet's software development office in Boulder, Colorado was closed 
in March, 1995.  A sub-lease agreement with another tenant was negotiated 
which offset the majority of the cost of Internet's lease. Both the lease and 
the related sub-lease expired in March, 1996.

Item 3.   LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

     Internet is not a party to, nor is any of Internet's property subject 
to, any material legal proceedings.  Internet knows of no legal proceedings 
contemplated or threatened against it.

Item 4.   SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS

     There were no matters submitted to a vote of security holders during the 
quarter ending January 31, 1996.


                                                                             14

<PAGE>

                                    PART II

Item 5.   MARKET FOR COMMON EQUITY AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

(a) PRINCIPAL MARKET OR MARKETS.  Internet's Common Stock is traded on the 
NASDAQ Small-Cap Market under the symbol INCC.  In the previous years and 
prior to June 13, 1994, Warrants to purchase Common Stock were traded under 
the symbol INCCW.  All Warrants not exercised by June 13, 1994 expired under 
their own terms on that date.

     The following table represents the range of high and low bid prices for 
the Common Stock and Warrants for the eight fiscal quarters ended January 31, 
1996.

                                     QUARTER ENDED
               ----------------------------------------------------------- 
               APR. 30, 94     JUL. 31, 94     OCT. 31, 94     JAN. 31, 95 
               -----------     -----------     -----------     ----------- 
     Security  High    Low     High    Low     High    Low     High    Low 

     Common    9.88   5.63     6.00   3.13     6.63   3.88     8.25   3.63 

     Warrants  4.13    .44      .63    .03      N/A    N/A      N/A    N/A 


                                     QUARTER ENDED
               ----------------------------------------------------------- 
               APR. 30, 95     JUL. 31, 95     OCT. 31, 95     JAN. 31, 95 
               -----------     -----------     -----------     ----------- 
     Security  High    Low     High    Low     High    Low     High    Low 

     Common    6.75   4.25     6.50   3.90     7.75   4.12     6.50   3.50

     Warrants   N/A    N/A      N/A    N/A      N/A    N/A      N/A    N/A


(b) APPROXIMATE NUMBER OF HOLDERS OF COMMON STOCK AND WARRANTS. As of April 
15, 1996, there were 174 record holders and an additional estimated 2,500 
beneficial holders of Internet's Common Stock.

(c) DIVIDENDS. Internet has paid no cash dividends on its Common Stock and has
no present intention of paying cash dividends in the foreseeable future,
although there exists no restrictions that limit Internet's ability to pay
dividends.  It is the present policy of the Board of Directors to retain all
earnings to provide 



                                                                             15

<PAGE>


for the growth of the Company.  Payment of cash dividends in the future will 
depend upon, among other things, the Company's future earnings, requirements 
for capital improvements and financial condition.
























                                                                             16

<PAGE>


Item 6.   MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
          RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

     The following is management's discussion and analysis of certain 
significant factors which have affected the Company's financial condition and 
results of operations during the periods included in the accompanying 
financial statements.

FINANCIAL CONDITION

     The financial condition of the Company at January 31, 1996 as compared 
to the previous year is discussed below.  All known significant trends and 
events in financial condition, liquidity and capital resources are also 
discussed below.

The company's cash position has decreased by $256,000 (including the decline 
in marketable securities) from the prior year.  The current ratio was 1.20 as 
of January 31, 1996 as compared to 1.64 for the prior year. Working capital 
was $892,000 as of January 31, 1996 and had declined from $2,052,000 for the 
prior year.  While revenues increased by 13.3% over the prior year, the 
balance of net trade receivables declined by 1.8% due to collection efforts 
by Company personnel.

Inventory increased from $738,000 as January 31, 1995 to $1,398,000 at 
January 31, 1996.  This increase was due to stocking of new equipment lines, 
extended manufacturer lead times, and delays in customer delivery. Trade 
accounts payable increased by $495,000 over the prior fiscal year to 
$2,523,000 as of January 31, 1996. This resulted from increased activity from 
a 13.3% increase in revenues, increased inventory balances, and a dispute 
with a vendor over the accuracy of its billings to the company.  Deferred 
revenues increased by 23.3% to $662,000. This balance reflected one month of 
advanced billings on the company's multi-year customer services and circuits 
contracts.

During fiscal year ended January 31, 1996, working capital was most 
significantly affected by the current year's operating loss of $977,000 and 
expenditures for capital equipment of $873,000 and leasehold improvements of 
$141,000. The Company increased its use 


                                                                             17

<PAGE>


of its lines of credit during the fiscal year.  The balance drawn as of 
January 31, 1996 was $1,000,000 up from $350,000 at the previous year-end.  
The total credit facility is $1,750,000 of which $450,000 is held as 
collateral for a performance bond on a significant customer contract.  During 
the year, the Company was in violation of loan agreement covenants. However, 
the lender has waived those violations and extended the line of credit to 
June 30, 1996.  It is management's opinion that the Company has adequate 
working capital and bank credit to fund its on-going operations.

During the fiscal year, the Company elected to dissolve its joint venture 
with Inacom by buying the joint venture's operations.  All customers were 
transferred to the Company; all offices except for Minneapolis were closed, 
and operations were streamlined.  The results of the joint venture increased 
the Company's operating loss by $209,000 over the life of the joint venture.

RESULTS FROM OPERATIONS

Revenues for the year ended January 31, 1996 ("1995") increased by 13.3% over 
the prior year.  The table below shows revenue results by categories:

                                     1995     1994      % CHANGE
                                   -------  -------     --------
     Equipment revenues            $ 9,899  $ 9,532        3.9%
     Data circuit revenues           5,585    4,546       22.9%
     Equipment services revenues     2,328    1,871       24.4%
     Network management revenues       630      378       66.7%
     Other revenues                     86       23      273.9%
                                   -------  -------
     Total Revenues                $18,528  $16,350       13.3%

The growth in services revenues which include data circuit revenues, 
equipment services revenues, and network management revenues results from an 
increasing emphasis on the sale of services by the Company. These revenues 
grew to $8,543,000 during 


                                                                             18

<PAGE>

the current fiscal year, an increase of 25.7% over the prior fiscal year.  
29% of customers buying services in 1995 increased their purchase of services 
in 1996.

During Fiscal Year 1996, the Company was organized into two main sales 
organizations - a direct sales force focusing on selling equipment and 
services to direct end-user sales and an indirect sales force focusing on 
equipment-only sales to resellers. During the fiscal year, the Company's 
direct sales group generated equipment and services revenues of $15,064,000, 
an increase of 16.9% over the prior year.  The indirect sales force generated 
equipment-only revenues of $3,033,000, a decrease of 12.5%. The decrease in 
indirect sales force revenue is attributable to increased price pressure from 
resellers and competition in the marketplace.

In Fiscal 1995, the Company formed a strategic sales group targeting 
complimentary product relationships with system integrators and a national 
accounts program. Neither the strategic sales nor the national accounts sales 
groups provided sufficient revenues to justify continued investment, and as a 
result those groups were disbanded during the fourth quarter.  

Cost of Sales increased by 12.6% over the prior year.  This was due to 
increased revenue activity.  Overall gross margin percentage increased to 
27.1% for fiscal year 1996 as compared to 26.6% for fiscal year 1995.  This 
results from the increase in services revenues which generally have a higher 
gross margin. 

Selling expenses increased  by $340,000 or 18.6% from the prior fiscal year. 
The expense growth resulted from increased headcount relating to a number of 
sales programs which were begun early in the fiscal year and subsequently 
shut down due to lack of revenue generation.  Expense levels also increased 
due to normal commissions expenses related to higher revenue levels.

General and Administrative expenses increased by 28.5% or $680,000 to 
$3,066,000 for fiscal year ended January 31, 1996.  The expense growth 
related a number of factors including higher headcount and salary costs of 
$353,000 incurred in anticipation of higher revenue 


                                                                             19

<PAGE>


levels and increased depreciation and amortization relating to capital 
equipment purchases and office space remodeling and rent ($79,000). 
Additional increases were reported in professional services and insurance 
costs ($53,000), public company expenses ($36,000), and bad debt expense 
($42,000).  Expenses increased in numerous other categories due to increased 
levels of revenue and general operations activities.

The Company recorded a $61,000 loss for its share of the joint venture 
operations during the fiscal year just ended.  The joint venture was 
dissolved on May 31, 1995 with Internet Communications taking control of all 
operations. All offices, except for Minneapolis, were closed.  All customer 
contracts and relationships were transferred to Internet Communications. 

Software Development and Maintenance expenses included the write- off of 
capitalized software expenses and the down-sizing of the Company's software 
development program. In the prior fiscal year, the Company re-evaluated the 
net realizability of its capitalized software in light of product development 
schedules and changing market requirements and wrote down its investment by 
$1,475,000 to $50,000. During the fiscal year ended January 31, 1996, the 
Company determined that there were no distinguishable revenues which could be 
attributed to the capitalized software and that the remaining asset which 
then totaled $137,000 should be written off to expense. The Company continues 
to provide technical support for specific product lines of Tellabs equipment 
with targeted resources.

In the third and fourth quarter, the Company took steps to reduce the growth 
of operating expenses.  Total headcount of the company was reduced from a 
high of 96 employees (including the Inacom joint venture) to 73 employees on 
January 31, 1996. Non-productive programs were canceled.  The organizational 
structure was simplified and focused on key tasks.

OUTLOOK

Company management believes that Internet Communications is in a high growth 
marketplace in which data, voice, and video networks are of strategic 
importance to commercial and governmental 


                                                                             20

<PAGE>


enterprises. The Company recognizes the significant impact on the 
marketplace, customer satisfaction, and on the Company statement of 
operations of value-added services.  In Fiscal Year 1997 (ending January 31, 
1997), marketing and sales programs will be directed at growing the services 
products of the Company. Significant resources will be devoted to consulting, 
training, network management, and network maintenance services. Important 
revenue-generation programs will instituted around local area network (LAN) 
capabilities and internet access services for commercial customers. The sale 
of communications equipment will continue to be an important source of 
revenues, but the Company will emphasize "systems" sales in which a variety 
of long-term services are perceived as the higher value components of the 
system.

The Company will select business opportunities, combining an entrepreneurial 
bias for action with disciplined business planning and an expectation for 
results.  Expenses will be managed aggressively, seeking to optimize the 
balance between growth and profitability.  The Company expects to seek 
outside investment in order to strengthen its working capital and to fund 
geographic and product-line growth.

Item 7.   FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     Information with respect to this item is contained in the financial 
statements appearing on Item 13 in Part IV of this Report.  Such information 
is incorporated herein by reference.

Item 8.   CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND
          FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

     None.


                                                                             21

<PAGE>


                                    PART III

     The information required by Part III, Items 9, 10, 11 and 12 of Form 
10-KSB is incorporated herein by reference to Registrant's definitive Proxy 
Statement to be filed in connection with the Annual Meeting of Shareholders 
to be held in May 1996.

                                     PART IV

Item 13.  EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENTS, AND REPORTS ON FORM 8-K

(a)  1. The following Financial Statements are filed as part of this Report:  

                                                           PAGE
                                                           ----
     Index to Financial Statements                          F-1

     Independent Auditors' Reports                          F-2

     Balance Sheets, January 31, 1996                       F-3

     Statements of Operations, For the
     Years Ended January 31, 1996 and 1995                  F-4

     Statement of Stockholders' Equity, For the Period
     from February 1, 1994 through January 31, 1996         F-5

     Statements of Cash Flows, For the
     Years Ended January 31, 1996 and 1995                  F-6

     Notes to Financial Statements                          F-7


     2. There are no Financial Statement Schedules required to be filed as part
     of this Report.


                                                                             22

<PAGE>

     3. EXHIBITS:

 (a) None

 (b) None

 (c) No reports on Form 8-K were filed during the quarter ending January 31,
     1996.






















                                                                             23

<PAGE>


                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

                        NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


                                   SIGNATURES


Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities 
Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed 
on its behalf by the under-signed, thereunto duly authorized.



                              INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


Date:     April 30, 1996      By:  ----------------------------
                                   Thomas C. Galley, President 
                                   and Principal Executive 
                                   Officer


Date:     April 30, 1996      By:  ----------------------------
                                   Benjamin T. Kelly,
                                   Principal Financial Officer 
                                   and Treasurer




SIGNATURES


Date:     April 30, 1996      By:  ----------------------------
                                   Thomas C. Galley, Director


                                                                             22

<PAGE>

                     INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION

                        NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS




Date:     April 30, 1996      By:  ----------------------------
                                   Arnell J. Galley, Director




Date:     April 30, 1996      By:  ----------------------------
                                   Peter A. Guglielmi, Director




















                                                                             23

<PAGE>
                                                                      APPENDIX F

                                    UNITED STATES
                          SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                               WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549


                                    FORM  10-Q SB


[X] QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE
    ACT  OF 1934

    For the quarterly period ended APRIL 30, 1996
                                   --------------

                                          or

[  ]     TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES
         EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934


    For the transition period from     N/A    to    N/A
                                       ---          ---

                           Commission file number  0-19578
                                                   -------

                            INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                      ------------------------------------------
                (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)


              COLORADO                               84-1095516
              --------                           --------------------
    State or other jurisdiction of                 (I.R.S. Employer
    incorporation or organization                Identification Number)

       7100 E. BELLEVIEW AVENUE, SUITE 201, GREENWOOD VILLAGE, COLORADO  80111
       -----------------------------------------------------------------------
           (Address of principal executive offices)             (Zip Code)

         Registrant's telephone number, including area code   (303) 770-7600
                                                              --------------


Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required
to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during
the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was
required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing
requirements for the past 90 days.           [X] Yes      [ ] No

At April 30, 1996,  2,400,686 shares of Common Stock, no par value were
outstanding

Page 1 of  10 pages.

<PAGE>


                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                                        INDEX

                                                                   PAGE
                                                                   ----

         Form 10-Q SB Cover Page                                     1

         Index Page                                                  2

Part I   Condensed Balance Sheets                                    3
         April 30, 1996 and January 31, 1996

         Condensed Statements of Operations                          4
         Three months ended April 30, 1996 & 1995

         Condensed Statements of Cash Flows                          5
         Three months ended April 30, 1996 & 1995

         Notes to Condensed Financial Statements                     6

         Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial           7 - 8
         Condition and Results of Operations

Part II  Other Information

         Item 1 - Legal Proceedings                                  9

         Item 2 - Changes in Securities                              9

         Item 3 - Defaults upon Senior Securities                    9

         Item 4 - Submission of Matters to a Vote of                 9
         Securities Holders

         Item 5 - Other Information                                  9

         Item 6 - Exhibits and Reports on Form 8-K                   9

         Signature Page                                              10


                                          2

<PAGE>

                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                               CONDENSED BALANCE SHEETS

                                              April 30      January 31,
                                                1996           1996
                                            (Unaudited)

                   ASSETS

CURRENT ASSETS:

    Cash                                       $266,000       $473,000
    Receivables:
         Trade, net of allowance             $2,297,000     $2,757,000
         Other                                 $361,000       $400,000
    Inventory                                $1,182,000     $1,398,000
    Prepaid expenses and other                 $377,000       $397,000
                                            -----------    -----------
         Total current assets                $4,483,000     $5,425,000

FURNITURE AND EQUIPMENT, NET                 $1,900,000     $1,943,000

OTHER ASSETS:                                   $69,000        $82,000

TOTAL ASSETS                                 $6,452,000     $7,450,000
                                            -----------    -----------
                                            -----------    -----------

    LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

CURRENT LIABILITIES:
    Note payable                             $1,100,000     $1,000,000
    Accounts payable                         $1,656,000     $2,523,000
    Unearned income                            $672,000       $662,000
    Accrued expenses and other                 $304,000       $348,000
                                            -----------    -----------
         Total current liabilities           $3,732,000     $4,533,000

STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:
    Common stock, no par value               $5,202,000     $5,202,000
    Stockholders' notes                        ($35,000)      ($35,000)
    Accumulated deficit                     ($2,447,000)   ($2,250,000)
                                            -----------    -----------
         Total stockholders' equity          $2,720,000     $2,917,000
                                            -----------    -----------

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY   $6,452,000     $7,450,000
                                            -----------    -----------
                                            -----------    -----------

            See accompanying notes to these condensed financial statements

                                          3

<PAGE>


                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                          CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS


                                                   For the three months
                                                       ended April 30,
                                                      1996         1995
                                                  (Unaudited)  (Unaudited)


NET SALES:
    Equipment                                     $1,258,000     $2,607,000
    Data communication services                   $2,356,000     $2,110,000
                                                  ----------     ----------
                                                  $3,614,000     $4,717,000


COST OF SALES                                    ($2,548,000)   ($3,248,000)
                                                  ----------     ----------

GROSS MARGIN                                      $1,066,000     $1,469,000

OPERATING EXPENSES:
    Selling                                         $493,000       $524,000
    General and administrative                      $734,000       $676,000
    Software development & maintenance               $36,000       $133,000
    Equity in loss of joint venture                       $0        $39,000
                                                  ----------     ----------
                                                  $1,263,000     $1,372,000
                                                  ----------     ----------

INCOME BEFORE INCOME TAXES                         ($197,000)       $97,000

INCOME TAX EXPENSE                                        $0             $0
                                                  ----------     ----------

NET INCOME (LOSS)                                 ($197,000)       $97,000
                                                  ----------     ----------
                                                  ----------     ----------

NET INCOME PER COMMON SHARE                      $     (0.08)   $      0.04
                                                  ----------     ----------
                                                  ----------     ----------

WEIGHTED AVERAGE COMMON SHARES OUTSTANDING         2,397,000      2,521,000
                                                  ----------     ----------
                                                  ----------     ----------

            See accompanying notes to these condensed financial statements

                                          4

<PAGE>


                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                          CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

                                                        For the three months
                                                             ended April 30,
                                                           1996         1995
                                                       (Unaudited) (Unaudited)

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:
  Net income                                             ($197,000)   $97,000
  Adjustments to reconcile net income to
  net cash from operating activities:
    Depreciation and amortization                          188,000    149,000
    Changes in operating assets and liabilities:
      (Increase) decrease in:
        Receivables - Net                                  499,000   (660,000)
        Inventory                                          216,000   (219,000)
        Prepaid expenses and other                          33,000     74,000
      Increase (decrease) in:
        Accounts payable                                  (887,000)   140,000
        Unearned income                                     10,000     15,000
        Accrued expenses                                   (44,000)    98,000
                                                         ----------  ---------
    Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities   (162,000)  (306,000)

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:
  Software development costs                                    --   (100,000)
  Capital expenditures                                    (145,000)  (118,000)
  Purchase of Marketable securities                             --     (2,000)
                                                         ----------  ---------
    Net cash used in investing activities                 (145,000)  (220,000)


CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:
  Proceeds from debt                                       100,000    765,000
  Repayment of debt                                             --   (550,000)
  Proceeds from notes receivable                                --      2,000
  Purchase of treasury stock                                    --     (2,000)
                                                         ----------  ---------
    Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities    100,000    215,000
                                                         ----------  ---------

INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH                               (207,000)  (311,000)
CASH, beginning of period                                  473,000    572,000
                                                         ----------  ---------

CASH, end of period                                       $266,000   $261,000
                                                         ----------  ---------
                                                         ----------  ---------

           See accompanying notes to these condensed financial statements.

                                          5

<PAGE>

                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                       NOTES TO CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                    APRIL 30, 1996
                                     (Unaudited)


NOTE 1 -- BASIS OF PRESENTATION

The financial statements included herein have been prepared by Internet
Communications Corporation (Internet or the Company), without audit, pursuant to
the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and include
all adjustments which are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair
presentation.  Certain information and footnote disclosures normally included in
the financial statements prepared in accordance with generally accepted
accounting principles have been condensed or omitted pursuant to such rules and
regulations.  The Company believes that the disclosures are adequate to make the
information presented not misleading; however, it is suggested that these
financial statements be read in conjunction with the financial statements and
the notes thereto which are incorporated by reference in the Company's Annual
Report on Form 10-K SB for the fiscal year ended January 31, 1996.  The
financial data for the interim periods may not necessarily be indicative of
results to be expected for the year.

                                          6


<PAGE>

                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION



                       MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
                    FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS


The following is management's discussion and analysis of certain significant
factors which have affected the Company's financial condition and results of
operations during the periods included in the accompanying condensed financial
statements.


FINANCIAL CONDITION

The current ratio as of April 30, 1996 remained  unchanged (1.20) when compared
to January 31, 1996 (1.20), and working capital decreased by $141,000 for the
period from January 31, 1996 to April 30, 1996.  The Company's cash and cash
equivalents at April 30, 1996 were $266,000 compared to $473,000 at January 31,
1996.  Trade accounts receivable decreased $460,000 at April 30, 1996, when
compared to January 31, 1996 primarily due to collection efforts by Company
personnel.  Inventory balances decreased $216,000 compared to January 31, 1996
due to decreased vendor lead time, stock rotation to vendors and improved
customer delivery time. During the three months ending April 30, 1996 the
Company purchased $ 145,000 of capital assets used primarily in technological
services.

The Company increased its use of its line of credit during the first quarter of
fiscal 1997.  The balance drawn on at April 30, 1996 was $1,100,000 an increase
of $100,000 from January 31, 1996.  The total credit facility is $1,750,000 of
which $450,000 is held as collateral for a performance bond on a significant
customer contract.  During the first quarter ending April 30, 1996, the Company
was in violation of  loan agreement covenants.  However, the lender has waived
those violations and extended the line of credit to June 30, 1996.  It is
management's opinion that the Company has adequate working capital and bank
credit to fund its on-going operations.  Accounts Payable decreased $867,000
when compared to January 31, 1996.  This primarily resulted from payment to
vendors with cash generated through operations.

On May 29,1996, the Company entered into a stock exchange agreement with
Interwest Group, Inc. (Group), under which the Company proposes to acquire all
of the issued and outstanding common stock of Interwest Communications C. S.
Corporation in exchange for 2,306,541 shares of the Company's common stock.  The
share exchange agreement is subject to shareholder approval.  In connection with
this agreement, Group advanced the Company $900,000 in the form of a promissory
note due December 31, 1996.  If not paid when due, the Note is convertible into
common stock at $3.00 per share.

                                          7

<PAGE>


RESULTS OF OPERATIONS:

For the three months ended April 30, 1996, the Company reported revenues of
$3.6 million respectively,  resulting in net losses of $197,000  respectively,
compared to revenues of  $4.7 million with net income of $97,000 for the three
months ended April 30, 1995.

Sales for the three months ended April 30, 1996, decreased 23% compared to the
same periods in 1995.  The decrease in sales for the three months of fiscal 1997
was primarily the result of reduced equipment sales generated from the Company's
resale sales channel, partially offset by an increase in data communication
service sales of 12% when compared to the same period last year.  Gross margin
as a percentage of sales was 29.5% for the three months ending April 30, 1996,
compared to 31.2% for the same periods of fiscal 1996.  The decrease in gross
margin percentage during the three months ended April 30, 1996 when compared to
the same period last year was the result of lower margin equipment sales.  The
Company's gross margin percentage can vary significantly from period to period
due to changes in the relative mix of equipment and service sales.

Selling expense as a percentage of revenues increased slightly (13.6%) for the
three months ended April 30, 1996 compared to the same periods of fiscal 1996
(11.1%).  The increase is the result of greater sales force compensation per
revenue dollar for data communication service sales vs equipment sales.

General and Administrative expenses increased $58,000  for the three month
period ending April 30, 1996 when compared to the same periods in fiscal 1996.
These operating expense increases reflect the inclusion of operating expenses of
former Internet-Inacom operations acquired on June 1, 1995, expansion of office
facilities and general increase in expenses due to higher anticipated revenue
activity.

Software development & maintenance expense decreased $97,000 during the quarter
ending April 30, 1996 when compared to the same period last year.  The decrease
is the result of the Company's de-emphasis of software development. See related
discussion in form 10-KSB dated January 31, 1996.

                                          8

<PAGE>



                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION


                                       PART II


ITEM 1.   LEGAL PROCEEDINGS


          NONE


ITEM 2.   CHANGES IN SECURITIES


          NONE


ITEM 3.   DEFAULTS UPON SENIOR SECURITIES


          NONE

ITEM 4.   SUBMISSION OF MATTER TO A VOTE OF SECURITIES HOLDERS


          NONE

ITEM 5.   OTHER INFORMATION


Subsequent to the quarter ended April 30, 1996, the Company filed Form 8K dated
May 14, 1996.



ITEM 6.   EXHIBITS AND REPORTS ON FORM 8-K


          NONE


                                          9

<PAGE>


                                      SIGNATURES



Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.

INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION




By:  /s/   Thomas C. Galley
     -------------------------------------------
     Thomas C. Galley, President

Date:  June 12, 1996





By:  /s/   Benjamin T. Kelly
     -------------------------------------------
     Benjamin T. Kelly, Chief Financial Officer
          and Treasurer

Date:  June 12, 1996

                                          10
<PAGE>


PROXY                                                                      PROXY
                         INTERNET COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION
                    SOLICITED ON BEHALF OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS

The undersigned hereby appoints Thomas C. Galley and Arnell J. Galley, each with
the power to appoint his/her substitute, and hereby authorizes them to represent
and to vote as designated below, all the shares of common stock of Internet
Communications Corporation held of record by the undersigned on June 24, 1996 at
the Special Meeting of Shareholders to be held on July 31, 1996, or any
adjournment thereof.

1.   A proposal to adopt the 1995 Non-Employee Director Stock Option Plan.

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN


2.   A proposal to adopt the 1996 Incentive Stock Plan.

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN


3.   A proposal to approve the Share Exchange Agreement between the Company 
and Interwest Group, Inc. and the transactions and other documents 
contemplated thereby pursuant to which among other things, the Company will 
acquire from Interwest Group, Inc. all the outstanding shares of capital 
stock of Interwest Communications C.S. Corporation in exchange for a number 
of shares of the Company's Common Stock that will in general be equal to 49% 
of the number of shares of the Company's Common Stock that will be issued and 
outstanding after giving effect to the closing of the transaction.

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN


4.   A proposal to amend the Articles of Incorporation to increase the number
of authorized shares of the Company's Common Stock, no par value, from 4,500,000
shares to 20,000,000 shares.

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN


5.   A proposal to amend the Articles of Incorporation to divide the Board of
Directors into three (3) Classes, each of which, after an interim arrangement,
will serve for staggered three (3) year terms.

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN


6.   A proposal to amend the Articles of Incorporation to provide for increased
voting requirements for certain corporate actions including the sale of the
Company's assets and mergers.

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN


<PAGE>

7.   A proposal to elect five (5) Directors.

                                    Dale Morrison

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN

                                  William J. Maxwell

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN

                                   Arnell J. Galley

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN

                                  Peter A. Guglielmi

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN

                                   Thomas C. Galley

     / /  FOR                / /  AGAINST                  / /  ABSTAIN

(INSTRUCTIONS: TO WITHHOLD AUTHORITY TO VOTE FOR ANY INDIVIDUAL NOMINEE, CROSS
OUT THAT NOMINEE'S NAME ABOVE).

8.   Such other business as may properly come before the meeting, or any
adjournment or adjournments thereof.

THIS PROXY WHEN  PROPERLY EXECUTED WILL BE VOTED IN THE MANNER DIRECTED HEREIN
BY THE UNDERSIGNED SHAREHOLDER.  IF NO DIRECTION IS MADE, THIS PROXY WILL BE
VOTED FOR PROPOSALS 1,2, 3,4, 5, 6, 7 AND 8.

SHARES REPRESENTED BY THIS PROXY WILL BE VOTED AT THE MEETING IN ACCORDANCE WITH
THE SHAREHOLDER S SPECIFICATIONS ABOVE.  THE PROXY


<PAGE>

CONFERS DISCRETIONARY AUTHORITY IN RESPECT TO MATTERS NOT KNOWN OR DETERMINED AT
THE TIME OF THE MAILING OF THE NOTICE OF THE SPECIAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS TO
THE UNDERSIGNED.

     The undersigned hereby acknowledges receipt of the Notice of the Annual
Meeting of Shareholders, Proxy Statement and Annual Report on Form 10-KSB
furnished therewith.



Dated:
                                       --------------------------------------


                                       --------------------------------------
                                       Signature(s) of Shareholder(s)

                                       Signature(s) should agree with name(s)
                                       appearing hereon.  Executors,
                                       administrators, trustees, guardians and
                                       attorneys should indicate when signing.
                                       Attorneys should indicate when signing.
                                       Attorneys should submit powers of
                                       attorney.

     THIS PROXY IS SOLICITED ON BEHALF OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS OF INTERNET
COMMUNICATIONS CORPORATION.  PLEASE SIGN AND RETURN THIS PROXY IN THE ENCLOSED
PRE-ADDRESSED ENVELOPE. THE GIVING OF A PROXY WILL NOT AFFECT YOUR RIGHT TO VOTE
IN PERSON IF YOU ATTEND THE MEETING.


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission